Commit Graph

36499 Commits

Author SHA1 Message Date
Johannes Berg
1e359a5de8 Revert "mac80211: Fix accounting of the tailroom-needed counter"
This reverts commit ca34e3b5c8.

It turns out that the p54 and cw2100 drivers assume that there's
tailroom even when they don't say they really need it. However,
there's currently no way for them to explicitly say they do need
it, so for now revert this.

This fixes https://bugzilla.kernel.org/show_bug.cgi?id=90331.

Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org
Fixes: ca34e3b5c8 ("mac80211: Fix accounting of the tailroom-needed counter")
Reported-by: Christopher Chavez <chrischavez@gmx.us>
Bisected-by: Larry Finger <Larry.Finger@lwfinger.net>
Debugged-by: Christian Lamparter <chunkeey@googlemail.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2015-01-05 10:33:46 +01:00
Jesse Gross
46b1e4f911 geneve: Check family when reusing sockets.
When searching for an existing socket to reuse, the address family
is not taken into account - only port number. This means that an
IPv4 socket could be used for IPv6 traffic and vice versa, which
is sure to cause problems when passing packets.

It is not possible to trigger this problem currently because the
only user of Geneve creates just IPv4 sockets. However, that is
likely to change in the near future.

Signed-off-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-04 22:21:33 -05:00
Jesse Gross
df5dba8e52 geneve: Remove socket hash table.
The hash table for open Geneve ports is used only on creation and
deletion time. It is not performance critical and is not likely to
grow to a large number of items. Therefore, this can be changed
to use a simple linked list.

Signed-off-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-04 22:21:33 -05:00
Jesse Gross
829a3ada9c geneve: Simplify locking.
The existing Geneve locking scheme was pulled over directly from
VXLAN. However, VXLAN has a number of built in mechanisms which make
the locking more complex and are unlikely to be necessary with Geneve.
This simplifies the locking to use a basic scheme of a mutex
when doing updates plus RCU on receive.

In addition to making the code easier to read, this also avoids the
possibility of a race when creating or destroying sockets since
UDP sockets and the list of Geneve sockets are protected by different
locks. After this change, the entire operation is atomic.

Signed-off-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-04 22:21:33 -05:00
Jesse Gross
61f3cade76 geneve: Remove workqueue.
The work queue is used only to free the UDP socket upon destruction.
This is not necessary with Geneve and generally makes the code more
difficult to reason about. It also introduces nondeterministic
behavior such as when a socket is rapidly deleted and recreated, which
could fail as the the deletion happens asynchronously.

Signed-off-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-04 22:21:33 -05:00
Marcel Holtmann
043ec9bf7b Bluetooth: Introduce HCI_QUIRK_FIXUP_INQUIRY_MODE option
The HCI_QUIRK_FIXUP_INQUIRY_MODE option allows to force Inquiry Result
with RSSI setting on controllers that do not indicate support for it,
but where it is known to be fully functional.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2015-01-03 22:31:09 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
04422da990 Bluetooth: Remove dead code for manufacturer inquiry mode quirks
There are some old Bluetooth modules from Silicon Wave and Broadcom
which support Inquiry Result with RSSI, but do not advertise it. The
core has quirks in the code to enable that inquiry mode. However as
it stands right now, that code is not even executed since entering
the function to determine which inquiry mode requires that the device
has the feature bit for Inquiry Result with RSSI set in the first
place. So this makes this dead code that hasn't work for a long
time.

In conclusion, just remove these extra quirks and simplify the setup
of the inquiry mode to be inline and with that a lot easier to read
and understand.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2015-01-03 22:31:08 +02:00
Thomas Graf
21e4902aea netlink: Lockless lookup with RCU grace period in socket release
Defers the release of the socket reference using call_rcu() to
allow using an RCU read-side protected call to rhashtable_lookup()

This restores behaviour and performance gains as previously
introduced by e341694 ("netlink: Convert netlink_lookup() to use
RCU protected hash table") without the side effect of severely
delayed socket destruction.

Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-03 14:32:57 -05:00
Thomas Graf
97defe1ecf rhashtable: Per bucket locks & deferred expansion/shrinking
Introduces an array of spinlocks to protect bucket mutations. The number
of spinlocks per CPU is configurable and selected based on the hash of
the bucket. This allows for parallel insertions and removals of entries
which do not share a lock.

The patch also defers expansion and shrinking to a worker queue which
allows insertion and removal from atomic context. Insertions and
deletions may occur in parallel to it and are only held up briefly
while the particular bucket is linked or unzipped.

Mutations of the bucket table pointer is protected by a new mutex, read
access is RCU protected.

In the event of an expansion or shrinking, the new bucket table allocated
is exposed as a so called future table as soon as the resize process
starts.  Lookups, deletions, and insertions will briefly use both tables.
The future table becomes the main table after an RCU grace period and
initial linking of the old to the new table was performed. Optimization
of the chains to make use of the new number of buckets follows only the
new table is in use.

The side effect of this is that during that RCU grace period, a bucket
traversal using any rht_for_each() variant on the main table will not see
any insertions performed during the RCU grace period which would at that
point land in the future table. The lookup will see them as it searches
both tables if needed.

Having multiple insertions and removals occur in parallel requires nelems
to become an atomic counter.

Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-03 14:32:57 -05:00
Thomas Graf
897362e446 nft_hash: Remove rhashtable_remove_pprev()
The removal function of nft_hash currently stores a reference to the
previous element during lookup which is used to optimize removal later
on. This was possible because a lock is held throughout calling
rhashtable_lookup() and rhashtable_remove().

With the introdution of deferred table resizing in parallel to lookups
and insertions, the nftables lock will no longer synchronize all
table mutations and the stored pprev may become invalid.

Removing this optimization makes removal slightly more expensive on
average but allows taking the resize cost out of the insert and
remove path.

Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Cc: netfilter-devel@vger.kernel.org
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-03 14:32:57 -05:00
Thomas Graf
88d6ed15ac rhashtable: Convert bucket iterators to take table and index
This patch is in preparation to introduce per bucket spinlocks. It
extends all iterator macros to take the bucket table and bucket
index. It also introduces a new rht_dereference_bucket() to
handle protected accesses to buckets.

It introduces a barrier() to the RCU iterators to the prevent
the compiler from caching the first element.

The lockdep verifier is introduced as stub which always succeeds
and properly implement in the next patch when the locks are
introduced.

Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-03 14:32:56 -05:00
Thomas Graf
8d24c0b431 rhashtable: Do hashing inside of rhashtable_lookup_compare()
Hash the key inside of rhashtable_lookup_compare() like
rhashtable_lookup() does. This allows to simplify the hashing
functions and keep them private.

Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Cc: netfilter-devel@vger.kernel.org
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-03 14:32:56 -05:00
Alexander Aring
36cf942adf mac802154: fix kbuild test robot warning
This patch fixs the following kbuild test robot warning:

coccinelle warnings: (new ones prefixed by >>)

>> net/mac802154/cfg.c:53:1-3: WARNING: PTR_ERR_OR_ZERO can be used

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2015-01-03 01:51:51 +01:00
Alexander Aring
9dc52d49e2 ieee802154: handle config as menuconfig
This patch handles the IEEE802154 Kconfig entry as menuconfig.
Furthermore we move this entry out of "Network Options" and put it into
"Networking" where the other networking subsystems are. This requires a
menuconfig entry like all other networking subsystems.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2015-01-03 01:49:24 +01:00
Alexander Aring
71e36b1b01 ieee802154: rename af_ieee802154.c to socket.c
This patch renames the "af_ieee802154.c" to "socket.c". This is just a
cleanup to have a short name for it which describes the implementationm
stuff more human understandable.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2015-01-03 01:49:24 +01:00
Alexander Aring
df2f65de4b ieee802154: socket: fix checkpatch issue
This patch solves the following checkpatch issue:

CHECK: Comparison to NULL could be written "skb"
+		if (skb != NULL) {

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2015-01-03 01:49:24 +01:00
Alexander Aring
78f821b648 ieee802154: socket: put handling into one file
This patch puts all related socket handling into one file. This is just
a cleanup to do all socket handling stuff inside of one implementation
file.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2015-01-03 01:49:24 +01:00
Alexander Aring
79300e3a43 ieee802154: socket: change module name
This patch changes the module name of af_802154 to ieee802154_socket.
Just for keeping the name convention according to the 6LoWPAN module
ieee802154_6lowpan.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2015-01-03 01:49:24 +01:00
Alexander Aring
955d7fc93e ieee802154: handle socket functionality as module
This patch makes the ieee802154 socket handling as module. Currently
this is part of ieee802154 module. It pointed out that ieee802154 module
has also two module_init/module_exit functions. One inside of core.c and
the other in af_ieee802154.c. This patch will also solve this issue by
handle the af_802154 as separate module.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2015-01-03 01:49:23 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
ec6cef9cd9 Bluetooth: Fix SMP channel registration for unconfigured controllers
When the Bluetooth controllers requires an unconfigured state (for
example when the BD_ADDR is missing), then it is important to try
to register the SMP channels when the controller transitions to the
configured state.

This also fixes an issue with the debugfs entires that are not present
for controllers that start out as unconfigured.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2015-01-02 22:22:04 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
203de21bf6 Bluetooth: Fix for a leftover debug of pairing credentials
One of the LE Secure Connections security credentials was still using
the BT_DBG instead of SMP_DBG.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2015-01-02 22:22:04 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
cb0d2faeb1 Bluetooth: Fix scope of sc_only_mode debugfs entry
The sc_only_mode debugfs entry is used to read the current state of the
Secure Connections Only mode. Before Bluetooth 4.2 this mode was only
for BR/EDR controllers and with that tight to the support Secure Simple
Pairing. Since Secure Connections is now available for BR/EDR and LE
this debugfs entry is no longer correctly place.

Move it to the common section and enable it when either BR/EDR Secure
Connections feature is supported or when the controller has LE support.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2015-01-02 22:22:04 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
05b3c3e790 Bluetooth: Remove no longer needed force_sc_support debugfs option
The force_sc_support debugfs option was introduced to easily work with
pre-production Bluetooth 4.1 silicon. This option is no longer needed
since controllers supporting BR/EDR Secure Connections feature are now
available.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2015-01-02 22:22:04 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
91389af67c Bluetooth: Remove broken force_lesc_support debugfs option
The force_lesc_support debugfs option never really worked. It has a race
condition between creating the debugfs entry and registering the L2CAP
fixed channel for BR/EDR SMP support.

Also this has been replaced with a working force_bredr_smp debugfs
switch that developers can use now.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2015-01-02 22:22:03 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
300acfdec9 Bluetooth: Introduce force_bredr_smp debugfs option for testing
Testing cross-transport pairing that starts on BR/EDR is only valid when
using a controller with BR/EDR Secure Connections. Devices will indicate
this by providing BR/EDR SMP fixed channel over L2CAP. To allow testing
of this feature on Bluetooth 4.0 controller or controllers without the
BR/EDR Secure Connections features, introduce a force_bredr_smp debugfs
option that allows faking the required AES connection.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2015-01-02 22:22:03 +01:00
Ben Pfaff
24cc59d1eb openvswitch: Consistently include VLAN header in flow and port stats.
Until now, when VLAN acceleration was in use, the bytes of the VLAN header
were not included in port or flow byte counters.  They were however
included when VLAN acceleration was not used.  This commit corrects the
inconsistency, by always including the VLAN header in byte counters.

Previous discussion at
http://openvswitch.org/pipermail/dev/2014-December/049521.html

Reported-by: Motonori Shindo <mshindo@vmware.com>
Signed-off-by: Ben Pfaff <blp@nicira.com>
Reviewed-by: Flavio Leitner <fbl@sysclose.org>
Acked-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-02 16:14:20 -05:00
Herbert Xu
843925f33f tcp: Do not apply TSO segment limit to non-TSO packets
Thomas Jarosch reported IPsec TCP stalls when a PMTU event occurs.

In fact the problem was completely unrelated to IPsec.  The bug is
also reproducible if you just disable TSO/GSO.

The problem is that when the MSS goes down, existing queued packet
on the TX queue that have not been transmitted yet all look like
TSO packets and get treated as such.

This then triggers a bug where tcp_mss_split_point tells us to
generate a zero-sized packet on the TX queue.  Once that happens
we're screwed because the zero-sized packet can never be removed
by ACKs.

Fixes: 1485348d24 ("tcp: Apply device TSO segment limit earlier")
Reported-by: Thomas Jarosch <thomas.jarosch@intra2net.com>
Signed-off-by: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>

Cheers,
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-02 16:13:20 -05:00
Florian Westphal
e8768f9715 net: skbuff: don't zero tc members when freeing skb
Not needed, only four cases:
 - kfree_skb (or one of its aliases).
   Don't need to zero, memory will be freed.
 - kfree_skb_partial and head was stolen:  memory will be freed.
 - skb_morph:  The skb header fields (including tc ones) will be
   copied over from the 'to-be-morphed' skb right after
   skb_release_head_state returns.
 - skb_segment:  Same as before, all the skb header
   fields are copied over from the original skb right away.

Signed-off-by: Florian Westphal <fw@strlen.de>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-02 16:04:29 -05:00
David S. Miller
6c032edc8a Merge branch 'for-upstream' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/bluetooth/bluetooth-next
Johan Hedberg say:

====================
pull request: bluetooth-next 2014-12-31

Here's the first batch of bluetooth patches for 3.20.

 - Cleanups & fixes to ieee802154  drivers
 - Fix synchronization of mgmt commands with respective HCI commands
 - Add self-tests for LE pairing crypto functionality
 - Remove 'BlueFritz!' specific handling from core using a new quirk flag
 - Public address configuration support for ath3012
 - Refactor debugfs support into a dedicated file
 - Initial support for LE Data Length Extension feature from Bluetooth 4.2

Please let me know if there are any issues pulling. Thanks.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-02 15:58:21 -05:00
Joe Stringer
a4c9ea5e8f geneve: Add Geneve GRO support
This results in an approximately 30% increase in throughput
when handling encapsulated bulk traffic.

Signed-off-by: Joe Stringer <joestringer@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-02 15:46:41 -05:00
Jesse Gross
9b174d88c2 net: Add Transparent Ethernet Bridging GRO support.
Currently the only tunnel protocol that supports GRO with encapsulated
Ethernet is VXLAN. This pulls out the Ethernet code into a proper layer
so that it can be used by other tunnel protocols such as GRE and Geneve.

Signed-off-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2015-01-02 15:46:41 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
5405afd1a3 fib_trie: Add tracking value for suffix length
This change adds a tracking value for the maximum suffix length of all
prefixes stored in any given tnode.  With this value we can determine if we
need to backtrace or not based on if the suffix is greater than the pos
value.

By doing this we can reduce the CPU overhead for lookups in the local table
as many of the prefixes there are 32b long and have a suffix length of 0
meaning we can immediately backtrace to the root node without needing to
test any of the nodes between it and where we ended up.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:55 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
21d1f11db0 fib_trie: Remove checks for index >= tnode_child_length from tnode_get_child
For some reason the compiler doesn't seem to understand that when we are in
a loop that runs from tnode_child_length - 1 to 0 we don't expect the value
of tn->bits to change.  As such every call to tnode_get_child was rerunning
tnode_chile_length which ended up consuming quite a bit of space in the
resultant assembly code.

I have gone though and verified that in all cases where tnode_get_child
is used we are either winding though a fixed loop from tnode_child_length -
1 to 0, or are in a fastpath case where we are verifying the value by
either checking for any remaining bits after shifting index by bits and
testing for leaf, or by using tnode_child_length.

size net/ipv4/fib_trie.o
Before:
   text	   data	    bss	    dec	    hex	filename
  15506	    376	      8	  15890	   3e12	net/ipv4/fib_trie.o

After:
   text	   data	    bss	    dec	    hex	filename
  14827	    376	      8	  15211	   3b6b	net/ipv4/fib_trie.o

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:55 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
12c081a5c8 fib_trie: inflate/halve nodes in a more RCU friendly way
This change pulls the node_set_parent functionality out of put_child_reorg
and instead leaves that to the function to take care of as well.  By doing
this we can fully construct the new cluster of tnodes and all of the
pointers out of it before we start routing pointers into it.

I am suspecting this will likely fix some concurency issues though I don't
have a good test to show as such.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:55 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
fc86a93b46 fib_trie: Push tnode flushing down to inflate/halve
This change pushes the tnode freeing down into the inflate and halve
functions.  It makes more sense here as we have a better grasp of what is
going on and when a given cluster of nodes is ready to be freed.

I believe this may address a bug in the freeing logic as well.  For some
reason if the freelist got to a certain size we would call
synchronize_rcu().  I'm assuming that what they meant to do is call
synchronize_rcu() after they had handed off that much memory via
call_rcu().  As such that is what I have updated the behavior to be.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:55 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
ff181ed876 fib_trie: Push assignment of child to parent down into inflate/halve
This change makes it so that the assignment of the tnode to the parent is
handled directly within whatever function is currently handling the node be
it inflate, halve, or resize.  By doing this we can avoid some of the need
to set NULL pointers in the tree while we are resizing the subnodes.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:55 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
f05a48198b fib_trie: Add functions should_inflate and should_halve
This change pulls the logic for if we should inflate/halve the nodes out
into separate functions.  It also addresses what I believe is a bug where 1
full node is all that is needed to keep a node from ever being halved.

Simple script to reproduce the issue:
	modprobe dummy;	ifconfig dummy0 up
	for i in `seq 0 255`; do ifconfig dummy0:$i 10.0.${i}.1/24 up; done
	ifconfig dummy0:256 10.0.255.33/16 up
	for i in `seq 0 254`; do ifconfig dummy0:$i down; done

Results from /proc/net/fib_triestat
Before:
	Local:
		Aver depth:     3.00
		Max depth:      4
		Leaves:         17
		Prefixes:       18
		Internal nodes: 11
		  1: 8  2: 2  10: 1
		Pointers: 1048
	Null ptrs: 1021
	Total size: 11  kB
After:
	Local:
		Aver depth:     3.41
		Max depth:      5
		Leaves:         17
		Prefixes:       18
		Internal nodes: 12
		  1: 8  2: 3  3: 1
		Pointers: 36
	Null ptrs: 8
	Total size: 3  kB

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
cf3637bb8f fib_trie: Move resize to after inflate/halve
This change consists of a cut/paste of resize to behind inflate and halve
so that I could remove the two function prototypes.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
345e9b5426 fib_trie: Push rcu_read_lock/unlock to callers
This change is to start cleaning up some of the rcu_read_lock/unlock
handling.  I realized while reviewing the code there are several spots that
I don't believe are being handled correctly or are masking warnings by
locally calling rcu_read_lock/unlock instead of calling them at the correct
level.

A common example is a call to fib_get_table followed by fib_table_lookup.
The rcu_read_lock/unlock ought to wrap both but there are several spots where
they were not wrapped.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
98293e8d2f fib_trie: Use unsigned long for anything dealing with a shift by bits
This change makes it so that anything that can be shifted by, or compared
to a value shifted by bits is updated to be an unsigned long.  This is
mostly a precaution against an insanely huge address space that somehow
starts coming close to the 2^32 root node size which would require
something like 1.5 billion addresses.

I chose unsigned long instead of unsigned long long since I do not believe
it is possible to allocate a 32 bit tnode on a 32 bit system as the memory
consumed would be 16GB + 28B which exceeds the addressible space for any
one process.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
e9b44019d4 fib_trie: Update meaning of pos to represent unchecked bits
This change moves the pos value to the other side of the "bits" field.  By
doing this it actually simplifies a significant amount of code in the trie.

For example when halving a tree we know that the bit lost exists at
oldnode->pos, and if we inflate the tree the new bit being add is at
tn->pos.  Previously to find those bits you would have to subtract pos and
bits from the keylength or start with a value of (1 << 31) and then shift
that.

There are a number of spots throughout the code that benefit from this.  In
the case of the hot-path searches the main advantage is that we can drop 2
or more operations from the search path as we no longer need to compute the
value for the index to be shifted by and can instead just use the raw pos
value.

In addition the tkey_extract_bits is now defunct and can be replaced by
get_index since the two operations were doing the same thing, but now
get_index does it much more quickly as it is only an xor and shift versus a
pair of shifts and a subtraction.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
836a0123c9 fib_trie: Optimize fib_table_insert
This patch updates the fib_table_insert function to take advantage of the
changes made to improve the performance of fib_table_lookup.  As a result
the code should be smaller and run faster then the original.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
939afb0657 fib_trie: Optimize fib_find_node
This patch makes use of the same features I made use of for
fib_table_lookup to streamline fib_find_node.  The resultant code should be
smaller and run faster than the original.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
9f9e636d4f fib_trie: Optimize fib_table_lookup to avoid wasting time on loops/variables
This patch is meant to reduce the complexity of fib_table_lookup by reducing
the number of variables to the bare minimum while still keeping the same if
not improved functionality versus the original.

Most of this change was started off by the desire to rid the function of
chopped_off and current_prefix_length as they actually added very little to
the function since they only applied when computing the cindex.  I was able
to replace them mostly with just a check for the prefix match.  As long as
the prefix between the key and the node being tested was the same we know
we can search the tnode fully versus just testing cindex 0.

The second portion of the change ended up being a massive reordering.
Originally the calls to check_leaf were up near the start of the loop, and
the backtracing and descending into lower levels of tnodes was later.  This
didn't make much sense as the structure of the tree means the leaves are
always the last thing to be tested.  As such I reordered things so that we
instead have a loop that will delve into the tree and only exit when we
have either found a leaf or we have exhausted the tree.  The advantage of
rearranging things like this is that we can fully inline check_leaf since
there is now only one reference to it in the function.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
adaf981685 fib_trie: Merge leaf into tnode
This change makes it so that leaf and tnode are the same struct.  As a
result there is no need for rt_trie_node anymore since everyting can be
merged into tnode.

On 32b systems this results in the leaf being 4 bytes larger, however I
don't know if that is really an issue as this and an eariler patch that
added bits & pos have increased the size from 20 to 28.  If I am not
mistaken slub/slab allocate on power of 2 sizes so 20 was likely being
rounded up to 32 anyway.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
37fd30f2da fib_trie: Merge tnode_free and leaf_free into node_free
Both the leaf and the tnode had an rcu_head in them, but they had them in
slightly different places.  Since we now have them in the same spot and
know that any node with bits == 0 is a leaf and the rest are either vmalloc
or kmalloc tnodes depending on the value of bits it makes it easy to combine
the functions and reduce overhead.

In addition I have taken advantage of the rcu_head pointer to go ahead and
put together a simple linked list instead of using the tnode pointer as
this way we can merge either type of structure for freeing.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
64c9b6fb26 fib_trie: Make leaf and tnode more uniform
This change makes some fundamental changes to the way leaves and tnodes are
constructed.  The big differences are:
1.  Leaves now populate pos and bits indicating their full key size.
2.  Trie nodes now mask out their lower bits to be consistent with the leaf
3.  Both structures have been reordered so that rt_trie_node now consisists
    of a much larger region including the pos, bits, and rcu portions of
    the tnode structure.

On 32b systems this will result in the leaf being 4B larger as the pos and
bits values were added to a hole created by the key as it was only 4B in
length.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:54 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
8274a97aa4 fib_trie: Update usage stats to be percpu instead of global variables
The trie usage stats were currently being shared by all threads that were
calling fib_table_lookup.  As a result when multiple threads were
performing lookups simultaneously the trie would begin to cache bounce
between those threads.

In order to prevent this I have updated the usage stats to use a set of
percpu variables.  By doing this we should be able to avoid the cache
bouncing and still make use of these stats.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 18:25:53 -05:00
stephen hemminger
bec94d430f gre: allow live address change
The GRE tap device supports Ethernet over GRE, but doesn't
care about the source address of the tunnel, therefore it
can be changed without bring device down.

Signed-off-by: Stephen Hemminger <stephen@networkplumber.org>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 14:18:28 -05:00
Bill Hong
33f72e6f0c l2tp : multicast notification to the registered listeners
Previously l2tp module did not provide any means for the user space to
get notified when tunnels/sessions are added/modified/deleted.
This change contains the following
- create a multicast group for the listeners to register.
- notify the registered listeners when the tunnels/sessions are
  created/modified/deleted.

Signed-off-by: Bill Hong <bhong@brocade.com>
Reviewed-by: Stephen Hemminger <stephen@networkplumber.org>
Reviewed-by: Sven-Thorsten Dietrich <sven@brocade.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 14:17:20 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
886eaa1fe6 tipc: replace 0 by NULL for pointers
Fix sparse warning:
net/tipc/link.c:1924:40: warning: Using plain integer as NULL pointer

Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-31 13:11:39 -05:00
Jiri Kosina
831a39c241 Revert "cfg80211: make WEXT compatibility unselectable"
This reverts commit 24a0aa212e.

It's causing severe userspace breakage.  Namely, all the utilities from
wireless-utils which are relying on CONFIG_WEXT (which means tools like
'iwconfig', 'iwlist', etc) are not working anymore.  There is a 'iw'
utility in newer wireless-tools, which is supposed to be a replacement
for all the "deprecated" binaries, but it's far away from being
massively adopted.

Please see [1] for example of the userspace breakage this is causing.

In addition to that, Larry Finger reports [2] that this patch is also
causing ipw2200 driver being impossible to build.

To me this clearly shows that CONFIG_WEXT is far, far away from being
"deprecated enough" to be removed.

[1] http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.linux.kernel/1857010
[2] http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.linux.network/343688

Signed-off-by: Jiri Kosina <jkosina@suse.cz>
Signed-off-by: Linus Torvalds <torvalds@linux-foundation.org>
2014-12-30 16:42:29 -08:00
Linus Torvalds
2c90331cf5 Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net
Pull networking fixes from David Miller:

 1) Fix double SKB free in bluetooth 6lowpan layer, from Jukka Rissanen.

 2) Fix receive checksum handling in enic driver, from Govindarajulu
    Varadarajan.

 3) Fix NAPI poll list corruption in virtio_net and caif_virtio, from
    Herbert Xu.  Also, add code to detect drivers that have this mistake
    in the future.

 4) Fix doorbell endianness handling in mlx4 driver, from Amir Vadai.

 5) Don't clobber IP6CB() before xfrm6_policy_check() is called in TCP
    input path,f rom Nicolas Dichtel.

 6) Fix MPLS action validation in openvswitch, from Pravin B Shelar.

 7) Fix double SKB free in vxlan driver, also from Pravin.

 8) When we scrub a packet, which happens when we are switching the
    context of the packet (namespace, etc.), we should reset the
    secmark.  From Thomas Graf.

 9) ->ndo_gso_check() needs to do more than return true/false, it also
    has to allow the driver to clear netdev feature bits in order for
    the caller to be able to proceed properly.  From Jesse Gross.

* git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net: (62 commits)
  genetlink: A genl_bind() to an out-of-range multicast group should not WARN().
  netlink/genetlink: pass network namespace to bind/unbind
  ne2k-pci: Add pci_disable_device in error handling
  bonding: change error message to debug message in __bond_release_one()
  genetlink: pass multicast bind/unbind to families
  netlink: call unbind when releasing socket
  netlink: update listeners directly when removing socket
  genetlink: pass only network namespace to genl_has_listeners()
  netlink: rename netlink_unbind() to netlink_undo_bind()
  net: Generalize ndo_gso_check to ndo_features_check
  net: incorrect use of init_completion fixup
  neigh: remove next ptr from struct neigh_table
  net: xilinx: Remove unnecessary temac_property in the driver
  net: phy: micrel: use generic config_init for KSZ8021/KSZ8031
  net/core: Handle csum for CHECKSUM_COMPLETE VXLAN forwarding
  openvswitch: fix odd_ptr_err.cocci warnings
  Bluetooth: Fix accepting connections when not using mgmt
  Bluetooth: Fix controller configuration with HCI_QUIRK_INVALID_BDADDR
  brcmfmac: Do not crash if platform data is not populated
  ipw2200: select CFG80211_WEXT
  ...
2014-12-30 10:45:47 -08:00
Marcel Holtmann
e64b4fb66c Bluetooth: Add timing information to ECDH test case runs
After successful completion of the ECDH test cases, print the time it
took to run them.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-30 10:32:11 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
255047b0dc Bluetooth: Add timing information to SMP test case runs
After successful completion of the SMP test cases, print the time it
took to run them.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-30 10:32:08 +02:00
Johan Hedberg
fb2969a3a9 Bluetooth: Add LE Secure Connections tests for SMP
This patch adds SMP self-tests for the Secure Connections crypto
functions. The sample data has been taken from the core specification.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-30 08:54:34 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
cfc4198e71 Bluetooth: Add legacy SMP tests
This patch adds self-tests for legacy SMP crypto functions. The sample
data has been taken from the core specification.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-30 08:54:33 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
0a2b0f0452 Bluetooth: Add skeleton for SMP self-tests
This patch adds the initial skeleton and kernel config option for SMP
self-tests.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-30 08:54:33 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
0b6415b652 Bluetooth: Add support for ECDH test cases
This patch adds the test cases for ECDH cryptographic functionality
used by Bluetooth Low Energy Secure Connections feature.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-30 09:46:57 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
ee485290c6 Bluetooth: Add support for self testing framework
This add support for the Bluetooth self testing framework that allows
running certain test cases of sample data to ensure correctness of its
basic functionality.

With this patch only the basic framework will be added. It contains
the build magic that allows running this at module loading time or
at late_initcall stage when built into the kernel image.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-30 08:53:55 +02:00
Johan Hedberg
4da50de895 Bluetooth: Fix const declarations for smp_f5 and smp_f6
These SMP crypto functions should have all their input parameters
declared as const. This patch fixes the parameters that were missing the
const declaration.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-30 07:30:18 +01:00
David S. Miller
dc97a1a947 genetlink: A genl_bind() to an out-of-range multicast group should not WARN().
Users can request to bind to arbitrary multicast groups, so warning
when the requested group number is out of range is not appropriate.

And with the warning removed, and the 'err' variable properly given
an initial value, we can remove 'found' altogether.

Reported-by: Sedat Dilek <sedat.dilek@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-29 16:31:49 -05:00
Johannes Berg
023e2cfa36 netlink/genetlink: pass network namespace to bind/unbind
Netlink families can exist in multiple namespaces, and for the most
part multicast subscriptions are per network namespace. Thus it only
makes sense to have bind/unbind notifications per network namespace.

To achieve this, pass the network namespace of a given client socket
to the bind/unbind functions.

Also do this in generic netlink, and there also make sure that any
bind for multicast groups that only exist in init_net is rejected.
This isn't really a problem if it is accepted since a client in a
different namespace will never receive any notifications from such
a group, but it can confuse the family if not rejected (it's also
possible to silently (without telling the family) accept it, but it
would also have to be ignored on unbind so families that take any
kind of action on bind/unbind won't do unnecessary work for invalid
clients like that.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-27 03:07:50 -05:00
Johannes Berg
c380d9a7af genetlink: pass multicast bind/unbind to families
In order to make the newly fixed multicast bind/unbind
functionality in generic netlink, pass them down to the
appropriate family.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-27 02:20:23 -05:00
Johannes Berg
7d68536bed netlink: call unbind when releasing socket
Currently, netlink_unbind() is only called when the socket
explicitly unbinds, which limits its usefulness (luckily
there are no users of it yet anyway.)

Call netlink_unbind() also when a socket is released, so it
becomes possible to track listeners with this callback and
without also implementing a netlink notifier (and checking
netlink_has_listeners() in there.)

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-27 02:20:23 -05:00
Johannes Berg
b10dcb3b94 netlink: update listeners directly when removing socket
The code is now confusing to read - first in one function down
(netlink_remove) any group subscriptions are implicitly removed
by calling __sk_del_bind_node(), but the subscriber database is
only updated far later by calling netlink_update_listeners().

Move the latter call to just after removal from the list so it
is easier to follow the code.

This also enables moving the locking inside the kernel-socket
conditional, which improves the normal socket destruction path.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-27 02:20:23 -05:00
Johannes Berg
f8403a2e47 genetlink: pass only network namespace to genl_has_listeners()
There's no point to force the caller to know about the internal
genl_sock to use inside struct net, just have them pass the network
namespace. This doesn't really change code generation since it's
an inline, but makes the caller less magic - there's never any
reason to pass another socket.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-27 02:20:23 -05:00
Johannes Berg
02c81ab95d netlink: rename netlink_unbind() to netlink_undo_bind()
The new name is more expressive - this isn't a generic unbind
function but rather only a little undo helper for use only in
netlink_bind().

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-27 02:20:23 -05:00
David S. Miller
eb46e2215f Merge branch 'for-upstream' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/bluetooth/bluetooth
Johan Hedberg says:

====================
Here's one more bluetooth pull request for 3.19. We've got two fixes:

 - Fix for accepting connections with old user space versions of BlueZ
 - Fix for Bluetooth controllers that don't have a public address

Both of these are regressions that were introduced in 3.17, so the
appropriate Cc: stable annotations are provided.

Please let me know if there are any issues pulling. Thanks.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-26 18:23:37 -05:00
Jesse Gross
5f35227ea3 net: Generalize ndo_gso_check to ndo_features_check
GSO isn't the only offload feature with restrictions that
potentially can't be expressed with the current features mechanism.
Checksum is another although it's a general issue that could in
theory apply to anything. Even if it may be possible to
implement these restrictions in other ways, it can result in
duplicate code or inefficient per-packet behavior.

This generalizes ndo_gso_check so that drivers can remove any
features that don't make sense for a given packet, similar to
netif_skb_features(). It also converts existing driver
restrictions to the new format, completing the work that was
done to support tunnel protocols since the issues apply to
checksums as well.

By actually removing features from the set that are used to do
offloading, it solves another problem with the existing
interface. In these cases, GSO would run with the original set
of features and not do anything because it appears that
segmentation is not required.

CC: Tom Herbert <therbert@google.com>
CC: Joe Stringer <joestringer@nicira.com>
CC: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
CC: Hayes Wang <hayeswang@realtek.com>
Signed-off-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Acked-by:  Tom Herbert <therbert@google.com>
Fixes: 04ffcb255f ("net: Add ndo_gso_check")
Tested-by: Hayes Wang <hayeswang@realtek.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-26 17:20:56 -05:00
Jay Vosburgh
2c26d34bbc net/core: Handle csum for CHECKSUM_COMPLETE VXLAN forwarding
When using VXLAN tunnels and a sky2 device, I have experienced
checksum failures of the following type:

[ 4297.761899] eth0: hw csum failure
[...]
[ 4297.765223] Call Trace:
[ 4297.765224]  <IRQ>  [<ffffffff8172f026>] dump_stack+0x46/0x58
[ 4297.765235]  [<ffffffff8162ba52>] netdev_rx_csum_fault+0x42/0x50
[ 4297.765238]  [<ffffffff8161c1a0>] ? skb_push+0x40/0x40
[ 4297.765240]  [<ffffffff8162325c>] __skb_checksum_complete+0xbc/0xd0
[ 4297.765243]  [<ffffffff8168c602>] tcp_v4_rcv+0x2e2/0x950
[ 4297.765246]  [<ffffffff81666ca0>] ? ip_rcv_finish+0x360/0x360

	These are reliably reproduced in a network topology of:

container:eth0 == host(OVS VXLAN on VLAN) == bond0 == eth0 (sky2) -> switch

	When VXLAN encapsulated traffic is received from a similarly
configured peer, the above warning is generated in the receive
processing of the encapsulated packet.  Note that the warning is
associated with the container eth0.

        The skbs from sky2 have ip_summed set to CHECKSUM_COMPLETE, and
because the packet is an encapsulated Ethernet frame, the checksum
generated by the hardware includes the inner protocol and Ethernet
headers.

	The receive code is careful to update the skb->csum, except in
__dev_forward_skb, as called by dev_forward_skb.  __dev_forward_skb
calls eth_type_trans, which in turn calls skb_pull_inline(skb, ETH_HLEN)
to skip over the Ethernet header, but does not update skb->csum when
doing so.

	This patch resolves the problem by adding a call to
skb_postpull_rcsum to update the skb->csum after the call to
eth_type_trans.

Signed-off-by: Jay Vosburgh <jay.vosburgh@canonical.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-26 16:16:51 -05:00
Marcel Holtmann
0f3adeae60 Bluetooth: Remove BlueFritz! specific check from initialization
The AVM BlueFritz! USB controllers had a special handling in the
Bluetooth core when it comes to reading the supported commands.

Both drivers now set the HCI_QUIRK_BROKEN_LOCAL_COMMANDS and with
that it is no longer needed to look for vendor specific details.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-26 20:16:14 +02:00
Wu Fengguang
4aa6118811 openvswitch: fix odd_ptr_err.cocci warnings
net/openvswitch/vport-gre.c:188:5-11: inconsistent IS_ERR and PTR_ERR, PTR_ERR on line 189

 PTR_ERR should access the value just tested by IS_ERR

Semantic patch information:
 There can be false positives in the patch case, where it is the call
 IS_ERR that is wrong.

Generated by: scripts/coccinelle/tests/odd_ptr_err.cocci

CC: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: Fengguang Wu <fengguang.wu@intel.com>
Acked-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-24 15:18:09 -05:00
Johan Hedberg
6a8fc95c87 Bluetooth: Fix accepting connections when not using mgmt
When connectable mode is enabled (page scan on) through some non-mgmt
method the HCI_CONNECTABLE flag will not be set. For backwards
compatibility with user space versions not using mgmt we should not
require HCI_CONNECTABLE to be set if HCI_MGMT is not set.

Reported-by: Pali Rohár <pali.rohar@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Pali Rohár <pali.rohar@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org # 3.17+
2014-12-24 20:02:00 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
8bfe8442ff Bluetooth: Fix controller configuration with HCI_QUIRK_INVALID_BDADDR
When controllers set the HCI_QUIRK_INVALID_BDADDR flag, it is required
by userspace to program a valid public Bluetooth device address into
the controller before it can be used.

After successful address configuration, the internal state changes and
the controller runs the complete initialization procedure. However one
small difference is that this is no longer the HCI_SETUP stage. The
HCI_SETUP stage is only valid during initial controller setup. In this
case the stack runs the initialization as part of the HCI_CONFIG stage.

The controller version information, default name and supported commands
are only stored during HCI_SETUP. While these information are static,
they are not read initially when HCI_QUIRK_INVALID_BDADDR is set. So
when running in HCI_CONFIG state, these information need to be updated
as well.

This especially impacts Bluetooth 4.1 and later controllers using
extended feature pages and second event mask page.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org # 3.17+
2014-12-24 20:35:46 +02:00
Thomas Graf
b8fb4e0648 net: Reset secmark when scrubbing packet
skb_scrub_packet() is called when a packet switches between a context
such as between underlay and overlay, between namespaces, or between
L3 subnets.

While we already scrub the packet mark, connection tracking entry,
and cached destination, the security mark/context is left intact.

It seems wrong to inherit the security context of a packet when going
from overlay to underlay or across forwarding paths.

Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Acked-by: Flavio Leitner <fbl@sysclose.org>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-24 00:21:43 -05:00
Toshiaki Makita
796f2da81b net: Fix stacked vlan offload features computation
When vlan tags are stacked, it is very likely that the outer tag is stored
in skb->vlan_tci and skb->protocol shows the inner tag's vlan_proto.
Currently netif_skb_features() first looks at skb->protocol even if there
is the outer tag in vlan_tci, thus it incorrectly retrieves the protocol
encapsulated by the inner vlan instead of the inner vlan protocol.
This allows GSO packets to be passed to HW and they end up being
corrupted.

Fixes: 58e998c6d2 ("offloading: Force software GSO for multiple vlan tags.")
Signed-off-by: Toshiaki Makita <makita.toshiaki@lab.ntt.co.jp>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-24 00:08:33 -05:00
Pravin B Shelar
997e068ebc openvswitch: Fix vport_send double free
Today vport-send has complex error handling because it involves
freeing skb and updating stats depending on return value from
vport send implementation.
This can be simplified by delegating responsibility of freeing
skb to the vport implementation for all cases. So that
vport-send needs just update stats.

Fixes: 91b7514cdf ("openvswitch: Unify vport error stats
handling")
Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:57:31 -05:00
Pravin B Shelar
cbe7e76d94 openvswitch: Fix GSO with multiple MPLS label.
MPLS GSO needs to know inner most protocol to process GSO packets.

Fixes: 25cd9ba0ab ("openvswitch: Add basic MPLS support to
kernel").

Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:57:31 -05:00
Pravin B Shelar
ec449f40bb openvswitch: Fix MPLS action validation.
Linux stack does not implement GSO for packet with multiple
encapsulations.  Therefore there was check in MPLS action
validation to detect such case, But this check introduced
bug which deleted one or more actions from actions list.
Following patch removes this check to fix the validation.

Fixes: 25cd9ba0ab ("openvswitch: Add basic MPLS support to
kernel").

Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Reported-by: Srinivas Neginhal <sneginha@vmware.com>
Acked-by: Jarno Rajahalme <jrajahalme@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:57:31 -05:00
Pravin B Shelar
4cc1beca30 mpls: Fix allowed protocols for mpls gso
MPLS and Tunnel GSO does not work together.  Reject packet which
request such GSO.

Fixes: 0d89d2035f ("MPLS: Add limited GSO support").
Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:57:31 -05:00
Pravin B Shelar
d0edc7bf39 mpls: Fix config check for mpls.
Fixes MPLS GSO for case when mpls is compiled as kernel module.

Fixes: 0d89d2035f ("MPLS: Add limited GSO support").
Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:57:30 -05:00
Herbert Xu
ceb8d5bf17 net: Rearrange loop in net_rx_action
This patch rearranges the loop in net_rx_action to reduce the
amount of jumping back and forth when reading the code.

Signed-off-by: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:20:21 -05:00
Herbert Xu
6bd373ebba net: Always poll at least one device in net_rx_action
We should only perform the softnet_break check after we have polled
at least one device in net_rx_action.  Otherwise a zero or negative
setting of netdev_budget can lock up the whole system.

Signed-off-by: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:20:21 -05:00
Herbert Xu
001ce546bb net: Detect drivers that reschedule NAPI and exhaust budget
The commit d75b1ade56 (net: less
interrupt masking in NAPI) required drivers to leave poll_list
empty if the entire budget is consumed.

We have already had two broken drivers so let's add a check for
this.

Signed-off-by: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:20:21 -05:00
Herbert Xu
726ce70e9e net: Move napi polling code out of net_rx_action
This patch creates a new function napi_poll and moves the napi
polling code from net_rx_action into it.

Signed-off-by: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:20:21 -05:00
Antonio Quartulli
0d16449195 batman-adv: avoid NULL dereferences and fix if check
Gateway having bandwidth_down equal to zero are not accepted
at all and so never added to the Gateway list.
For this reason checking the bandwidth_down member in
batadv_gw_out_of_range() is useless.

This is probably a copy/paste error and this check was supposed
to be "!gw_node" only. Moreover, the way the check is written
now may also lead to a NULL dereference.

Fix this by rewriting the if-condition properly.

Introduced by 414254e342
("batman-adv: tvlv - gateway download/upload bandwidth container")

Signed-off-by: Antonio Quartulli <antonio@meshcoding.com>
Reported-by: David Binderman <dcb314@hotmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Lindner <mareklindner@neomailbox.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:13:37 -05:00
Sven Eckelmann
0402e444cd batman-adv: Unify fragment size calculation
The fragmentation code was replaced in 610bfc6bc9
("batman-adv: Receive fragmented packets and merge") by an implementation which
can handle up to 16 fragments of a packet. The packet is prepared for the split
in fragments by the function batadv_frag_send_packet and the actual split is
done by batadv_frag_create.

Both functions calculate the size of a fragment themself. But their calculation
differs because batadv_frag_send_packet also subtracts ETH_HLEN. Therefore,
the check in batadv_frag_send_packet "can a full fragment can be created?" may
return true even when batadv_frag_create cannot create a full fragment.

The function batadv_frag_create doesn't check the size of the skb before
splitting it and therefore might try to create a larger fragment than the
remaining buffer. This creates an integer underflow and an invalid len is given
to skb_split.

Signed-off-by: Sven Eckelmann <sven@narfation.org>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:13:37 -05:00
Sven Eckelmann
5b6698b0e4 batman-adv: Calculate extra tail size based on queued fragments
The fragmentation code was replaced in 610bfc6bc9
("batman-adv: Receive fragmented packets and merge"). The new code provided a
mostly unused parameter skb for the merging function. It is used inside the
function to calculate the additionally needed skb tailroom. But instead of
increasing its own tailroom, it is only increasing the tailroom of the first
queued skb. This is not correct in some situations because the first queued
entry can be a different one than the parameter.

An observed problem was:

1. packet with size 104, total_size 1464, fragno 1 was received
   - packet is queued
2. packet with size 1400, total_size 1464, fragno 0 was received
   - packet is queued at the end of the list
3. enough data was received and can be given to the merge function
   (1464 == (1400 - 20) + (104 - 20))
   - merge functions gets 1400 byte large packet as skb argument
4. merge function gets first entry in queue (104 byte)
   - stored as skb_out
5. merge function calculates the required extra tail as total_size - skb->len
   - pskb_expand_head tail of skb_out with 64 bytes
6. merge function tries to squeeze the extra 1380 bytes from the second queued
   skb (1400 byte aka skb parameter) in the 64 extra tail bytes of skb_out

Instead calculate the extra required tail bytes for skb_out also using skb_out
instead of using the parameter skb. The skb parameter is only used to get the
total_size from the last received packet. This is also the total_size used to
decide that all fragments were received.

Reported-by: Philipp Psurek <philipp.psurek@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Sven Eckelmann <sven@narfation.org>
Acked-by: Martin Hundebøll <martin@hundeboll.net>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:13:37 -05:00
Jason Wang
af6dabc9c7 net: drop the packet when fails to do software segmentation or header check
Commit cecda693a9 ("net: keep original skb
which only needs header checking during software GSO") keeps the original
skb for packets that only needs header check, but it doesn't drop the
packet if software segmentation or header check were failed.

Fixes cecda693a9 ("net: keep original skb which only needs header checking during software GSO")
Cc: Eric Dumazet <eric.dumazet@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Wang <jasowang@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-23 23:12:11 -05:00
leroy christophe
7b5bca4676 netfilter: nf_tables: fix port natting in little endian archs
Make sure this fetches 16-bits port data from the register.
Remove casting to make sparse happy, not needed anymore.

Signed-off-by: leroy christophe <christophe.leroy@c-s.fr>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-23 15:34:28 +01:00
Fabian Frederick
8aefc4d1c6 netfilter: log: remove unnecessary sizeof(char)
sizeof(char) is always 1.

Suggested-by: Joe Perches <joe@perches.com>
Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-23 14:33:58 +01:00
Joe Perches
372e28661a netfilter: xt_osf: Use continue to reduce indentation
Invert logic in test to use continue.

This routine already uses continue, use it a bit more to
minimize > 80 column long lines and unnecessary indentation.

No change in compiled object file.

Other miscellanea:

o Remove trailing whitespace
o Realign arguments to multiline statement

Signed-off-by: Joe Perches <joe@perches.com>
Acked-by: Evgeniy Polyakov <zbr@ioremap.net>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-23 14:20:10 +01:00
Marcelo Leitner
88eab472ec netfilter: conntrack: adjust nf_conntrack_buckets default value
Manually bumping either nf_conntrack_buckets or nf_conntrack_max has
become a common task as our Linux servers tend to serve more and more
clients/applications, so let's adjust nf_conntrack_buckets this to a
more updated value.

Now for systems with more than 4GB of memory, nf_conntrack_buckets
becomes 65536 instead of 16384, resulting in nf_conntrack_max=256k
entries.

Signed-off-by: Marcelo Ricardo Leitner <mleitner@redhat.com>
Acked-by: Jesper Dangaard Brouer <brouer@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-23 14:20:10 +01:00
Eliad Peller
85b89af07d mac80211: fix dot11MulticastTransmittedFrameCount tested address
dot11MulticastTransmittedFrameCount should be updated according
to the DA, which might be different from A1. Checking A1 results
in the counter being 0 in case of station, as to-DS data frames
use A1 for the BSSID.

This behaviour is defined in state machines, specifically in the
sta_tx_dcf_3.1d(10) description of 802.11-2012.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
[rewrite commit message]
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-23 10:16:43 +01:00
Nicolas Dichtel
2dc49d1680 tcp6: don't move IP6CB before xfrm6_policy_check()
When xfrm6_policy_check() is used, _decode_session6() is called after some
intermediate functions. This function uses IP6CB(), thus TCP_SKB_CB() must be
prepared after the call of xfrm6_policy_check().

Before this patch, scenarii with IPv6 + TCP + IPsec Transport are broken.

Fixes: 971f10eca1 ("tcp: better TCP_SKB_CB layout to reduce cache line misses")
Reported-by: Huaibin Wang <huaibin.wang@6wind.com>
Suggested-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Dichtel <nicolas.dichtel@6wind.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-22 16:48:01 -05:00
Dan Collins
da413eec72 packet: Fixed TPACKET V3 to signal poll when block is closed rather than every packet
Make TPACKET_V3 signal poll when block is closed rather than for every
packet. Side effect is that poll will be signaled when block retire
timer expires which didn't previously happen. Issue was visible when
sending packets at a very low frequency such that all blocks are retired
before packets are received by TPACKET_V3. This caused avoidable packet
loss. The fix ensures that the signal is sent when blocks are closed
which covers the normal path where the block is filled as well as the
path where the timer expires. The case where a block is filled without
moving to the next block (ie. all blocks are full) will still cause poll
to be signaled.

Signed-off-by: Dan Collins <dan@dcollins.co.nz>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-22 15:41:15 -05:00
Marcel Holtmann
72e4a6bd02 Bluetooth: Remove duplicate constant for RFCOMM PSM
The RFCOMM_PSM constant is actually a duplicate. So remove it and
use the L2CAP_PSM_RFCOMM constant instead.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-20 19:55:04 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
23b9ceb74f Bluetooth: Create debugfs directory for each connection handle
For every internal representation of a Bluetooth connection which is
identified by hci_conn, create a debugfs directory with the handle
number as directory name.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-20 19:54:24 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
a8e1bfaa55 Bluetooth: Store default and maximum LE data length settings
When the controller supports the LE Data Length Extension feature, the
default and maximum data length are read and now stored.

For backwards compatibility all values are initialized to the data
length values from Bluetooth 4.1 and earlier specifications.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-20 17:52:21 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
a9f6068e00 Bluetooth: Enable basics for LE Data Length Extension feature
When the controller supports the new LE Data Length Extension feature
from Bluetooth 4.2 specification, enable the new events and read the
values for default and maxmimum data length supported by the controller.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-20 17:52:01 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
3a5c82b78f Bluetooth: Move LE debugfs file creation into hci_debugfs.c
This patch moves the creation of the debugs files for LE controllers
into hci_debugfs.c file.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-20 17:51:23 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
71c3b60ec6 Bluetooth: Move BR/EDR debugfs file creation into hci_debugfs.c
This patch moves the creation of the debugs files for BR/EDR controllers
into hci_debugfs.c file.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-20 17:51:07 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
40ce72b195 Bluetooth: Move common debugfs file creation into hci_debugfs.c
This patch moves the creation of the debugs files common for all
controllers into hci_debugfs.c file.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-20 17:51:01 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
60c5f5fb1f Bluetooth: Add skeleton functions for debugfs creation
The debugfs file creation has been part of the core initialization
handling of controllers. With the introduction of Bluetooth 4.2 core
specification, the number of debugfs files is increasing even further.

To avoid cluttering the core controller handling, create a separate
file hci_debugfs.c to centralize all debugfs file creation. For now
leave the current files in the core, but in the future all debugfs
file creation will be moved.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-20 17:50:34 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
50b5b952b7 Bluetooth: Support static address when BR/EDR has been disabled
Every BR/EDR/LE dual-mode controller requires to have a public address
and so far that has become the identity address and own address. The
only way to change that behavior was with a force_static_address
debugfs option.

However the host can actually disable the BR/EDR part of a dual-mode
controller and turn into a single mode LE controller. In that case
it makes perfect sense for a host to use a chosen static address
instead of the public address.

So if the host disables BR/EDR and configures a static address, then
that static address is used as identity address and own address. If
the host does not configure a static address, then the public address
is used as before.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-20 09:29:49 +02:00
Linus Torvalds
ecb5ec044a Merge branch 'for-linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/viro/vfs
Pull vfs pile #3 from Al Viro:
 "Assorted fixes and patches from the last cycle"

* 'for-linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/viro/vfs:
  [regression] chunk lost from bd9b51
  vfs: make mounts and mountstats honor root dir like mountinfo does
  vfs: cleanup show_mountinfo
  init: fix read-write root mount
  unfuck binfmt_misc.c (broken by commit e6084d4)
  vm_area_operations: kill ->migrate()
  new helper: iter_is_iovec()
  move_extent_per_page(): get rid of unused w_flags
  lustre: get rid of playing with ->fs
  btrfs: filp_open() returns ERR_PTR() on failure, not NULL...
2014-12-19 18:19:19 -08:00
Alexander Aring
cd1c56653a ieee802154: iface: move multiple node type check
This patch moves the handling for checking on multiple node type
interface to the corresponding concurrent iface check function.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-20 00:06:55 +01:00
Alexander Aring
bd37a78de9 mac802154: iface: check concurrent ifaces
This patch adds a check for concurrent interfaces while calling
interface up. This avoids to have different mac parameters on one phy.
Otherwise it could be that a interface can overwrite current phy mac
settings which is set by an another interface.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-20 00:06:55 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
405a26110a Bluetooth: Move hci_update_page_scan to hci_request.c
This is a left-over from the patch that created hci_request.c. The
hci_update_page_scan functions should have been moved from hci_core.c
there.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 22:23:19 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
9df7465351 Bluetooth: Add return parameter to cmd_complete callbacks
The cmd_complete callbacks for pending mgmt commands may fail e.g. in
the case of memory allocation. Previously this error would be caught and
returned to user space in the form of a failed write on the mgmt socket
(when the error happened in the mgmt command handler) but with the
introduction of the generic cmd_complete callback this information was
lost. This patch returns the feature by making cmd_complete callbacks
return int instead of void.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 22:06:37 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
5a154e6f71 Bluetooth: Fix Add Device to wait for HCI before sending cmd_complete
This patch updates the Add Device mgmt command handler to use a
hci_request to wait for HCI command completion before notifying user
space of the mgmt command completion. To do this we need to add an extra
hci_request parameter to the hci_conn_params_set function. Since this
function has no other users besides mgmt.c it's moved there as a static
function.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 22:06:37 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
51ef3ebe7b Bluetooth: Fix Remove Device to wait for HCI before sending cmd_complete
This patch updates the Remove Device mgmt command handler to use a
hci_request to wait for HCI command completion before notifying user
space of the mgmt command completion. This way we ensure that once the
mgmt command returns all HCI commands triggered by it have also
completed.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 22:06:37 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
2cf22218b0 Bluetooth: Add hci_request support for hci_update_background_scan
Many places using hci_update_background_scan() try to synchronize
whatever they're doing with the help of hci_request callbacks. However,
since the hci_update_background_scan() function hasn't so far accepted a
hci_request pointer any commands triggered by it have been left out by
the synchronization. This patch modifies the API in a similar way as was
done for hci_update_page_scan, i.e. there's a variant that takes a
hci_request and another one that takes a hci_dev.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 22:06:37 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
8d819a92cc mac80211: minstrel: reduce size of struct minstrel_rate_stats
On minstrel_ht, the size of the per-sta struct is almost 18k, making it
an order-3 allocation.
A few fields inside the per-rate statistics are bigger than they need to
be. This patch reduces the size enough to cut down the per-sta struct to
about 13k (order-2 allocation).

Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-19 21:34:22 +01:00
Al Viro
71bb99a02b Bluetooth: bnep: bnep_add_connection() should verify that it's dealing with l2cap socket
same story as cmtp

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 13:48:27 +01:00
Al Viro
96c26653ce Bluetooth: cmtp: cmtp_add_connection() should verify that it's dealing with l2cap socket
... rather than relying on ciptool(8) never passing it anything else.  Give
it e.g. an AF_UNIX connected socket (from socketpair(2)) and it'll oops,
trying to evaluate &l2cap_pi(sock->sk)->chan->dst...

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 13:48:21 +01:00
Al Viro
51bda2bca5 Bluetooth: hidp_connection_add() unsafe use of l2cap_pi()
it's OK after we'd verified the sockets, but not before that.

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 13:40:07 +01:00
Jukka Rissanen
004fa5ed08 Bluetooth: 6lowpan: Do not free skb when packet is dropped
If we need to drop the message because of some error in the
compression etc, then do not free the skb as that is done
automatically in other part of networking stack.

Signed-off-by: Jukka Rissanen <jukka.rissanen@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 13:39:50 +01:00
Al Viro
e3bb504efd [regression] chunk lost from bd9b51
Reported-by: Pavel Emelyanov <xemul@parallels.com>
Acked-by: Pavel Emelyanov <xemul@parallels.com>
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-19 07:13:21 -05:00
Johan Hedberg
0857dd3bed Bluetooth: Split hci_request helpers to hci_request.[ch]
None of the hci_request related things in net/bluetooth/hci_core.h are
needed anywhere outside of the core bluetooth module. This patch creates
a new net/bluetooth/hci_request.c file with its corresponding h-file and
moves the functionality there from hci_core.c and hci_core.h.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 13:04:42 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
1d2dc5b7b3 Bluetooth: Split hci_update_page_scan into two functions
To keep the parameter list and its semantics clear it makes sense to
split the hci_update_page_scan function into two separate functions: one
taking a hci_dev and another taking a hci_request. The one taking a
hci_dev constructs its own hci_request and then calls the other
function.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 12:52:18 +01:00
Linus Torvalds
00c845dbfe Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net
Pull networking fixes from David Miller:

 1) Fix NBMA tunnel mac header handling in GRE, from Timo Teräs.

 2) Fix a NAPI race in the fec driver, from Nimrod Andy.

 3) The new IFF_VNET_LE bit is outside the size of the flags member it
    is stored in (which is 16-bits), store the state locally in the
    drivers.  From Michael S Tsirkin.

 4) We are kicking the tires with the new wireless maintainership
    situation.  Bluetooth fixes via Johan Hedberg, and mac80211 fixes
    from Johannes Berg.

 5) Fix locking and leaks in geneve driver, from Jesse Gross.

 6) Make netlink TX mmap code always copy, so we don't have to be
    potentially exposed to the user changing the underlying contents
    from underneath us.

* git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net: (63 commits)
  be2net: Fix incorrect setting of tunnel offload flag in netdev features
  bnx2x: fix typos in "configure"
  xen-netback: support frontends without feature-rx-notify again
  MAINTAINERS: changes for wireless
  cxgb4: Fix decoding QSA module for ethtool get settings
  geneve: Fix races between socket add and release.
  geneve: Remove socket and offload handlers at destruction.
  netlink: Don't reorder loads/stores before marking mmap netlink frame as available
  netlink: Always copy on mmap TX.
  Bluetooth: Fix bug with filter in service discovery optimization
  mac80211: free management frame keys when removing station
  net: Disallow providing non zero VLAN ID for NIC drivers FDB add flow
  net/mlx4: Cache line CQE/EQE stride fixes
  net: fec: Fix NAPI race
  xen-netfront: use napi_complete() correctly to prevent Rx stalling
  ip_tunnel: Add missing validation of encap type to ip_tunnel_encap_setup()
  ip_tunnel: Add sanity checks to ip_tunnel_encap_add_ops()
  net: Allow FIXED_PHY to be modular.
  if_tun: drop broken IFF_VNET_LE
  macvtap: drop broken IFF_VNET_LE
  ...
2014-12-18 16:41:13 -08:00
Alexander Aring
ba2a9506a7 nl802154: introduce support for cca settings
This patch adds support for setting cca parameters via nl802154.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 00:19:23 +01:00
Alexander Aring
7fe9a3882b ieee802154: rework cca setting
The current cca setting handle is a driver specific call. We need to
introduce some 802.15.4 specific layer and mapping 802.15.4 cca modes to
driver specific ones inside the 802.15.4 driver. This patch will add
such 802.15.4 layer and mapping the cca settings to driver specific ones.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-19 00:19:23 +01:00
David S. Miller
86c8fc4bbe This relatively large collection of fixes is all over - from things
that were broken a long time ago (the management key issue) but not
 noticed yet, to small issues that were only introduced into 3.19
 (like the multicast issue). At least one issue is old but can crash
 the kernel based on invalid userspace requests (the nl80211 matches
 array one.)
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 
 iQIbBAABCAAGBQJUkt82AAoJEDBSmw7B7bqrk5YP+NN821jzWqTPZy7mS1NgwRrN
 4VjPw1J6ba5LRCfS8cYOcG5zPq4i88DdiRzsFe7TW1g3ayy5tXNp0FzcgJ4lBV5T
 cWpXybtCYwnJxlaRBNmS9H7ZOCSjVJH8B1U75t5jmY8ondZ7mRUpN6Od2b6rKfq6
 8HDZ+I7fr+tPeb/1tj9iq0XaJAPvZOpoJzA5Hgjvs6UOURAxIxRrU4l9LZ/bd6Uf
 jz0Kg0u59d9YNDn9MPX2KmMOyjbJ2t5MYHsAfxOB9usnaq8Toq1ZEszApiIXuyz/
 GsgLBYL9gVpIUU95Us7lDv+sqT7cFflNvE9JtgcB5dkSxjZrRNLnJM09NggkOI9a
 A1BGReZODj2UPEKdXgWMC4Jr63xLZW5vr7mX9c8egQu2U/eqLACcz0ewMxMxaoEO
 bXEjegDv6FaGuGU1ul8D03cvgznLjoMUtnkcu5UIFLIt7uf0Ohrn8bFovrpo0DX2
 wQt8VkOIrRBHXkvTDIZCyTbfZn9LI9M50q8YEZWX84wrA7gDkFQ6ByNrxdFET4zA
 Hjpjkwi9CbpaJ66Xp0WFbWJ6AMAfVJHYBTHnRU36nfbNb82qD6O+1nZVH7xGjbHB
 7zk+nrXKjhdnCBhhIZBku+Fkug6+wBdZNkTFSch6Q1ZO+aLb4Z02j+yb1fylAzjf
 ar3E7Ssx+jtGfJ9RQAk=
 =iSDP
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'mac80211-for-davem-2014-12-18' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/jberg/mac80211

Johannes Berg says:

====================
pull-request: mac80211 2014-12-18

Also from me a first pull request - we have a number of really old
issues that happened to crop up now with new work (or just more testing)
in the right areas as well as some small bugs newly introduced in 3.19.

Let me know if there are any problems.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-18 15:33:49 -05:00
David S. Miller
7dce675b28 Merge branch 'for-upstream' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/bluetooth/bluetooth
Johan Hedberg says:

====================
pull request: bluetooth 2014-12-17

Here's the first direct (i.e. skipping the wireless tree) bluetooth pull
request for you, intended for 3.19. It's just one patch: a fix from
Marcel for for remote service discovery filtering which also fixes a
'used uninitialized' compiler warning.

Please let me know if there are any issues pulling. Thanks.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-18 15:32:27 -05:00
Pablo Neira Ayuso
70314fc684 Merge tag 'ipvs2-for-v3.19' of https://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/horms/ipvs-next into ipvs-next
Simon Horman says:

====================
Second round of IPVS Updates for v3.19

please consider these IPVS updates for v3.19 or alternatively v3.20.

The single patch in this series fixes a long standing bug that
has not caused any trouble and thus is not being prioritised as a fix.
====================

Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-18 20:54:26 +01:00
Jesse Gross
12069401d8 geneve: Fix races between socket add and release.
Currently, searching for a socket to add a reference to is not
synchronized with deletion of sockets. This can result in use
after free if there is another operation that is removing a
socket at the same time. Solving this requires both holding the
appropriate lock and checking the refcount to ensure that it
has not already hit zero.

Inspired by a related (but not exactly the same) issue in the
VXLAN driver.

Fixes: 0b5e8b8e ("net: Add Geneve tunneling protocol driver")
CC: Andy Zhou <azhou@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Acked-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-18 12:38:13 -05:00
Jesse Gross
7ed767f731 geneve: Remove socket and offload handlers at destruction.
Sockets aren't currently removed from the the global list when
they are destroyed. In addition, offload handlers need to be cleaned
up as well.

Fixes: 0b5e8b8e ("net: Add Geneve tunneling protocol driver")
CC: Andy Zhou <azhou@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Acked-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-18 12:38:13 -05:00
Thomas Graf
a18e6a186f netlink: Don't reorder loads/stores before marking mmap netlink frame as available
Each mmap Netlink frame contains a status field which indicates
whether the frame is unused, reserved, contains data or needs to
be skipped. Both loads and stores may not be reordeded and must
complete before the status field is changed and another CPU might
pick up the frame for use. Use an smp_mb() to cover needs of both
types of callers to netlink_set_status(), callers which have been
reading data frame from the frame, and callers which have been
filling or releasing and thus writing to the frame.

- Example code path requiring a smp_rmb():
  memcpy(skb->data, (void *)hdr + NL_MMAP_HDRLEN, hdr->nm_len);
  netlink_set_status(hdr, NL_MMAP_STATUS_UNUSED);

- Example code path requiring a smp_wmb():
  hdr->nm_uid	= from_kuid(sk_user_ns(sk), NETLINK_CB(skb).creds.uid);
  hdr->nm_gid	= from_kgid(sk_user_ns(sk), NETLINK_CB(skb).creds.gid);
  netlink_frame_flush_dcache(hdr);
  netlink_set_status(hdr, NL_MMAP_STATUS_VALID);

Fixes: f9c228 ("netlink: implement memory mapped recvmsg()")
Reported-by: Eric Dumazet <eric.dumazet@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-18 12:35:55 -05:00
David Miller
4682a03586 netlink: Always copy on mmap TX.
Checking the file f_count and the nlk->mapped count is not completely
sufficient to prevent the mmap'd area contents from changing from
under us during netlink mmap sendmsg() operations.

Be careful to sample the header's length field only once, because this
could change from under us as well.

Fixes: 5fd96123ee ("netlink: implement memory mapped sendmsg()")
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
Acked-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Acked-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
2014-12-18 12:35:23 -05:00
Jukka Rissanen
93a1e86ce1 nl80211: Stop scheduled scan if netlink client disappears
An attribute NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER can be set by the scan initiator.
If present, the attribute will cause the scan to be stopped if the client
dies.

Signed-off-by: Jukka Rissanen <jukka.rissanen@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-18 14:38:44 +01:00
Jukka Rissanen
31a60ed1e9 nl80211: Convert sched_scan_req pointer to RCU pointer
Because of possible races when accessing sched_scan_req pointer in
rdev, the sched_scan_req is converted to RCU pointer.

Signed-off-by: Jukka Rissanen <jukka.rissanen@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-18 14:38:09 +01:00
Linus Torvalds
57666509b7 Merge branch 'for-linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/sage/ceph-client
Pull ceph updates from Sage Weil:
 "The big item here is support for inline data for CephFS and for
  message signatures from Zheng.  There are also several bug fixes,
  including interrupted flock request handling, 0-length xattrs, mksnap,
  cached readdir results, and a message version compat field.  Finally
  there are several cleanups from Ilya, Dan, and Markus.

  Note that there is another series coming soon that fixes some bugs in
  the RBD 'lingering' requests, but it isn't quite ready yet"

* 'for-linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/sage/ceph-client: (27 commits)
  ceph: fix setting empty extended attribute
  ceph: fix mksnap crash
  ceph: do_sync is never initialized
  libceph: fixup includes in pagelist.h
  ceph: support inline data feature
  ceph: flush inline version
  ceph: convert inline data to normal data before data write
  ceph: sync read inline data
  ceph: fetch inline data when getting Fcr cap refs
  ceph: use getattr request to fetch inline data
  ceph: add inline data to pagecache
  ceph: parse inline data in MClientReply and MClientCaps
  libceph: specify position of extent operation
  libceph: add CREATE osd operation support
  libceph: add SETXATTR/CMPXATTR osd operations support
  rbd: don't treat CEPH_OSD_OP_DELETE as extent op
  ceph: remove unused stringification macros
  libceph: require cephx message signature by default
  ceph: introduce global empty snap context
  ceph: message versioning fixes
  ...
2014-12-17 16:03:12 -08:00
Marcel Holtmann
ea8ae2516a Bluetooth: Fix bug with filter in service discovery optimization
The optimization for filtering out extended inquiry results, advertising
reports or scan response data based on provided UUID list has a logic
bug. In case no match is found in the advertising data, the scan
response is ignored and not checked against the filter. This will lead
to events being filtered wrongly.

Change the code to actually only drop the events when the scan response
data is not present. If it is present, it needs to be checked against
the provided filter.

The patch is a bit more complex than it needs to be. That is because
it also fixes this compiler warning that some gcc versions produce.

  CC      net/bluetooth/mgmt.o
net/bluetooth/mgmt.c: In function ‘mgmt_device_found’:
net/bluetooth/mgmt.c:7028:7: warning: ‘match’ may be used uninitialized in this function [-Wmaybe-uninitialized]
  bool match;
       ^

It seems that gcc can not clearly figure out the context of the match
variable. So just change the branches for the extended inquiry response
and advertising data around so that it is clear.

Reported-by: Geert Uytterhoeven <geert@linux-m68k.org>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 22:03:49 +02:00
Yan, Zheng
715e4cd405 libceph: specify position of extent operation
allow specifying position of extent operation in multi-operations
osd request. This is required for cephfs to convert inline data to
normal data (compare xattr, then write object).

Signed-off-by: Yan, Zheng <zyan@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilya Dryomov <idryomov@redhat.com>
2014-12-17 20:09:52 +03:00
Yan, Zheng
864e9197f1 libceph: add CREATE osd operation support
Add CEPH_OSD_OP_CREATE support.  Also change libceph to not treat
CEPH_OSD_OP_DELETE as an extent op and add an assert to that end.

Signed-off-by: Yan, Zheng <zyan@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilya Dryomov <idryomov@redhat.com>
2014-12-17 20:09:51 +03:00
Yan, Zheng
d74b50bed0 libceph: add SETXATTR/CMPXATTR osd operations support
Signed-off-by: Yan, Zheng <zyan@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilya Dryomov <idryomov@redhat.com>
2014-12-17 20:09:51 +03:00
Yan, Zheng
a3fc98005c libceph: require cephx message signature by default
Signed-off-by: Yan, Zheng <zyan@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilya Dryomov <idryomov@redhat.com>
2014-12-17 20:09:51 +03:00
Yan, Zheng
33d0733796 libceph: message signature support
Signed-off-by: Yan, Zheng <zyan@redhat.com>
2014-12-17 20:09:50 +03:00
Yan, Zheng
ae385eaf24 libceph: store session key in cephx authorizer
Session key is required when calculating message signature. Save the session
key in authorizer, this avoid lookup ticket handler for each message

Signed-off-by: Yan, Zheng <zyan@redhat.com>
2014-12-17 20:09:50 +03:00
Ilya Dryomov
4965fc38c4 libceph: nuke ceph_kvfree()
Use kvfree() from linux/mm.h instead, which is identical.  Also fix the
ceph_buffer comment: we will allocate with kmalloc() up to 32k - the
value of PAGE_ALLOC_COSTLY_ORDER, but that really is just an
implementation detail so don't mention it at all.

Signed-off-by: Ilya Dryomov <idryomov@redhat.com>
2014-12-17 20:09:50 +03:00
Eliad Peller
0f8b824561 mac80211: avoid reconfig if no interfaces are up
If there are no interfaces up, there is no reason
to continue the reconfig flow.

The current code might end up calling driver
callbacks (e.g. resume(), reconfig_complete())
while the driver is already stopped.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Emmanuel Grumbach <emmanuel.grumbach@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 15:45:17 +01:00
Luciano Coelho
1a952c94b5 mac80211: remove unused variable in ieee80211_parse_ch_switch_ie()
The ht_oper variable is assigned a value, but never used in
ieee80211_parse_ch_switch_ie().  Remove it.

Signed-off-by: Luciano Coelho <luciano.coelho@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Emmanuel Grumbach <emmanuel.grumbach@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 15:45:17 +01:00
Eliad Peller
1c45c5ce32 mac80211: update sta bw on ht chanwidth action frame
Commit e1a0c6b ("mac80211: stop toggling IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40")
mistakenly removed the actual update of sta->sta.bandwidth.

Refactor ieee80211_sta_cur_vht_bw() into multiple functions
(calculate caps-bw and chandef-bw separately, and min them
with cur_max_bandwidth).

On ht chanwidth action frame set only cur_max_bandwidth
(according to the sta capabilities) and recalc the sta bw.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Emmanuel Grumbach <emmanuel.grumbach@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 15:45:16 +01:00
Moshe Benji
a5fee9cb62 mac80211: handle power constraint and country IEs in RRM
In beacons, handle the Country IE even if no Power Constraint IE
is present, and, capability wise, also in case that the Radio
Measurements capability is enabled.

In cases where the Country IE should be handled and that the
Power Constraint IE is not present, the Country IE alone will
set the power limit (and not both Country and Power Constraint
IEs).

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Emmanuel Grumbach <emmanuel.grumbach@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 15:45:16 +01:00
Chaya Rachel Ivgi
179b8fc7fb mac80211: Fix ignored HT override configurations
HT override configurations was ignored when choosing the channel
(until now, the override configuration affected only the
capabilities shown in the IEs).

The override configurations received only on association time,
so in this case we should determine the channel again.

Signed-off-by: Chaya Rachel Ivgi <chaya.rachel.ivgi@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Emmanuel Grumbach <emmanuel.grumbach@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 15:45:06 +01:00
Johannes Berg
28a9bc6812 mac80211: free management frame keys when removing station
When writing the code to allow per-station GTKs, I neglected to
take into account the management frame keys (index 4 and 5) when
freeing the station and only added code to free the first four
data frame keys.

Fix this by iterating the array of keys over the right length.

Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org
Fixes: e31b82136d ("cfg80211/mac80211: allow per-station GTKs")
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 14:00:17 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
db8dfee57d cfg80211: avoid intersection when applying self-managed reg
The custom-reg handling function can currently only add flags to a given
channel. This results in stale flags being left applied. In some cases
a channel was disabled and even the orig_flags were changed to reflect
this.

Previously the API was designed for a single invocation before wiphy
registration, so this didn't matter. The previous approach doesn't scale
well to self-managed regulatory devices, particularly when a more
permissive regdom is applied after a restrictive one.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 11:49:55 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
1bdd716cbc cfg80211: return private regdom for self-managed devices
If a device has self-managed regulatory, insist on returning the wiphy
specific regdomain if a wiphy-idx is specified. The global regdomain is
meaningless for such devices.

Also add an attribute for self-managed devices, so usermode can
distinguish them as such.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Luis R. Rodriguez <mcgrof@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 11:49:55 +01:00
Jonathan Doron
b0d7aa5959 cfg80211: allow wiphy specific regdomain management
Add a new regulatory flag that allows a driver to manage regdomain
changes/updates for its own wiphy.
A self-managed wiphys only employs regulatory information obtained from
the FW and driver and does not use other cfg80211 sources like
beacon-hints, country-code IEs and hints from other devices on the same
system. Conversely, a self-managed wiphy does not share its regulatory
hints with other devices in the system. If a system contains several
devices, one or more of which are self-managed, there might be
contradictory regulatory settings between them. Usage of flag is
generally discouraged. Only use it if the FW/driver is incompatible
with non-locally originated hints.

A new API lets the driver send a complete regdomain, to be applied on
its wiphy only.

After a wiphy-specific regdomain change takes place, usermode will get
a new type of change notification. The regulatory core also takes care
enforce regulatory restrictions, in case some interfaces are on
forbidden channels.

Signed-off-by: Jonathan Doron <jonathanx.doron@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Luis R. Rodriguez <mcgrof@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 11:49:55 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
ad30ca2c03 cfg80211: allow usermode to query wiphy specific regdom
If a wiphy-idx is specified, the kernel will return the wiphy specific
regdomain, if such exists. Otherwise return the global regdom.

When no wiphy-idx is specified, return the global regdomain as well as
all wiphy-specific regulatory domains in the system, via a new nested
list of attributes.

Add a new attribute for each wiphy-specific regdomain, for usermode to
identify it as such.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 11:49:55 +01:00
Nishikawa, Kenzoh
2ae70efcea mac80211: keep sending peer candidate events while in listen state
Instead of sending peer candidate events just once, send them as long
as the peer remains in the LISTEN state in the peering state machine,
when userspace is implementing the peering manager.
Userspace may silence the events from a peer by progressing the state
machine or by setting the link state to BLOCKED.

Fixes the problem that a mesh peering process won't be fired again after
the previous first peering trial fails due to like air propagation error
if the peering is managed by user space such as wpa_supplicant.

This patch works with another patch for wpa_supplicant described here
which fires a peering process again triggered by the notice from kernel.
http://lists.shmoo.com/pipermail/hostap/2014-November/031235.html

Signed-off-by: Kenzoh Nishikawa <Kenzoh.Nishikawa@jp.sony.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 11:49:24 +01:00
Luciano Coelho
688b1ecfb9 mac80211: notify channel switch at the end of ieee80211_chswitch_post_beacon()
The call to cfg80211_ch_switch_notify() should be at the end of the
ieee80211_chswitch_post_beacon() function, because it should only be
sent if everything succeeded.

Fixes: d04b5ac9e7 ("cfg80211/mac80211: allow any interface to send channel switch notifications")
Signed-off-by: Luciano Coelho <luciano.coelho@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Emmanuel Grumbach <emmanuel.grumbach@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 11:47:42 +01:00
Janusz Dziedzic
d295445715 mac80211: notify NSS changed when IBSS and HT
When using IBSS in HT mode, we always get NSS=1
in rc_update callback. Force NSS recalculation when
rates updated and notify driver that NSS changed.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-17 11:47:26 +01:00
Linus Torvalds
603ba7e41b Merge branch 'for-linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/viro/vfs
Pull vfs pile #2 from Al Viro:
 "Next pile (and there'll be one or two more).

  The large piece in this one is getting rid of /proc/*/ns/* weirdness;
  among other things, it allows to (finally) make nameidata completely
  opaque outside of fs/namei.c, making for easier further cleanups in
  there"

* 'for-linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/viro/vfs:
  coda_venus_readdir(): use file_inode()
  fs/namei.c: fold link_path_walk() call into path_init()
  path_init(): don't bother with LOOKUP_PARENT in argument
  fs/namei.c: new helper (path_cleanup())
  path_init(): store the "base" pointer to file in nameidata itself
  make default ->i_fop have ->open() fail with ENXIO
  make nameidata completely opaque outside of fs/namei.c
  kill proc_ns completely
  take the targets of /proc/*/ns/* symlinks to separate fs
  bury struct proc_ns in fs/proc
  copy address of proc_ns_ops into ns_common
  new helpers: ns_alloc_inum/ns_free_inum
  make proc_ns_operations work with struct ns_common * instead of void *
  switch the rest of proc_ns_operations to working with &...->ns
  netns: switch ->get()/->put()/->install()/->inum() to working with &net->ns
  make mntns ->get()/->put()/->install()/->inum() work with &mnt_ns->ns
  common object embedded into various struct ....ns
2014-12-16 15:53:03 -08:00
Linus Torvalds
0b233b7c79 Merge branch 'for-3.19' of git://linux-nfs.org/~bfields/linux
Pull nfsd updates from Bruce Fields:
 "A comparatively quieter cycle for nfsd this time, but still with two
  larger changes:

   - RPC server scalability improvements from Jeff Layton (using RCU
     instead of a spinlock to find idle threads).

   - server-side NFSv4.2 ALLOCATE/DEALLOCATE support from Anna
     Schumaker, enabling fallocate on new clients"

* 'for-3.19' of git://linux-nfs.org/~bfields/linux: (32 commits)
  nfsd4: fix xdr4 count of server in fs_location4
  nfsd4: fix xdr4 inclusion of escaped char
  sunrpc/cache: convert to use string_escape_str()
  sunrpc: only call test_bit once in svc_xprt_received
  fs: nfsd: Fix signedness bug in compare_blob
  sunrpc: add some tracepoints around enqueue and dequeue of svc_xprt
  sunrpc: convert to lockless lookup of queued server threads
  sunrpc: fix potential races in pool_stats collection
  sunrpc: add a rcu_head to svc_rqst and use kfree_rcu to free it
  sunrpc: require svc_create callers to pass in meaningful shutdown routine
  sunrpc: have svc_wake_up only deal with pool 0
  sunrpc: convert sp_task_pending flag to use atomic bitops
  sunrpc: move rq_cachetype field to better optimize space
  sunrpc: move rq_splice_ok flag into rq_flags
  sunrpc: move rq_dropme flag into rq_flags
  sunrpc: move rq_usedeferral flag to rq_flags
  sunrpc: move rq_local field to rq_flags
  sunrpc: add a generic rq_flags field to svc_rqst and move rq_secure to it
  nfsd: minor off by one checks in __write_versions()
  sunrpc: release svc_pool_map reference when serv allocation fails
  ...
2014-12-16 15:25:31 -08:00
Or Gerlitz
65891feac2 net: Disallow providing non zero VLAN ID for NIC drivers FDB add flow
The current implementations all use dev_uc_add_excl() and such whose API
doesn't support vlans, so we can't make it with NICs HW for now.

Fixes: f6f6424ba7 ('net: make vid as a parameter for ndo_fdb_add/ndo_fdb_del')
Signed-off-by: Or Gerlitz <ogerlitz@mellanox.com>
Reviewed-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Jeff Kirsher <jeffrey.t.kirsher@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-16 15:41:19 -05:00
Thomas Graf
f1fb521f7d ip_tunnel: Add missing validation of encap type to ip_tunnel_encap_setup()
The encap->type comes straight from Netlink. Validate it against
max supported encap types just like ip_encap_hlen() already does.

Fixes: a8c5f9 ("ip_tunnel: Ops registration for secondary encap (fou, gue)")
Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-16 15:20:41 -05:00
Thomas Graf
bb1553c800 ip_tunnel: Add sanity checks to ip_tunnel_encap_add_ops()
The symbols are exported and could be used by external modules.

Fixes: a8c5f9 ("ip_tunnel: Ops registration for secondary encap (fou, gue)")
Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-16 15:20:41 -05:00
David S. Miller
c9f2c3d36c Merge tag 'master-2014-12-15' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/linville/wireless
John W. Linville says:

====================
pull request: wireless 2014-12-16

Please pull this batch of fixes intended for the 3.19 stream!

For the Bluetooth bits, Johan says:

"The patches consist of:

 - Coccinelle warning fix
 - hci_dev_lock/unlock fixes
 - Fixes for pending mgmt command handling
 - Fixes for properly following the force_lesc_support switch
 - Fix for a Microsoft branded Broadcom adapter
 - New device id for Atheros AR3012
 - Fix for BR/EDR Secure Connections enabling"

Along with that...

Brian Norris avoids leaking some kernel memory contents via printk in brcmsmac.

Julia Lawall corrects some misspellings in a few drivers.

Larry Finger gives us one more rtlwifi fix to correct a porting oversight.

Wei Yongjun fixes a sparse warning in rtlwifi.

Please let me know if there are problems!
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-16 15:16:48 -05:00
John W. Linville
a463e9c57a Merge branch 'for-upstream' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/bluetooth/bluetooth-next 2014-12-15 13:23:09 -05:00
Geert Uytterhoeven
6ff4a8ad4b rds: Fix min() warning in rds_message_inc_copy_to_user()
net/rds/message.c: In function ‘rds_message_inc_copy_to_user’:
net/rds/message.c:328: warning: comparison of distinct pointer types lacks a cast

Use min_t(unsigned long, ...) like is done in
rds_message_copy_from_user().

Signed-off-by: Geert Uytterhoeven <geert@linux-m68k.org>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-15 11:49:09 -05:00
Timo Teräs
8a0033a947 gre: fix the inner mac header in nbma tunnel xmit path
The NBMA GRE tunnels temporarily push GRE header that contain the
per-packet NBMA destination on the skb via header ops early in xmit
path. It is the later pulled before the real GRE header is constructed.

The inner mac was thus set differently in nbma case: the GRE header
has been pushed by neighbor layer, and mac header points to beginning
of the temporary gre header (set by dev_queue_xmit).

Now that the offloads expect mac header to point to the gre payload,
fix the xmit patch to:
 - pull first the temporary gre header away
 - and reset mac header to point to gre payload

This fixes tso to work again with nbma tunnels.

Fixes: 14051f0452 ("gre: Use inner mac length when computing tunnel length")
Signed-off-by: Timo Teräs <timo.teras@iki.fi>
Cc: Tom Herbert <therbert@google.com>
Cc: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-15 11:46:04 -05:00
Johannes Berg
848955ccf0 mac80211: move U-APSD enablement to vif flags
In order to let drivers have more dynamic U-APSD support,
move the enablement flag to the virtual interface driver
flags. This lets drivers not only set it up differently
for different interfaces, but also enable/disable on the
fly if needed.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-15 12:34:45 +01:00
Johannes Berg
4bcc56bb3a mac80211: ask driver to look at power level when starting AP
The power level might have been set, but as the interface was idle
it might not have taken effect yet. Ask the driver to check the
power level when starting up an AP so that in this case the correct
power level is used in case the device/driver can only set it when
the interface is actually active.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-15 12:27:02 +01:00
Linus Torvalds
e6b5be2be4 Driver core patches for 3.19-rc1
Here's the set of driver core patches for 3.19-rc1.
 
 They are dominated by the removal of the .owner field in platform
 drivers.  They touch a lot of files, but they are "simple" changes, just
 removing a line in a structure.
 
 Other than that, a few minor driver core and debugfs changes.  There are
 some ath9k patches coming in through this tree that have been acked by
 the wireless maintainers as they relied on the debugfs changes.
 
 Everything has been in linux-next for a while.
 
 Signed-off-by: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@linuxfoundation.org>
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 Version: GnuPG v2
 
 iEYEABECAAYFAlSOD20ACgkQMUfUDdst+ylLPACg2QrW1oHhdTMT9WI8jihlHVRM
 53kAoLeteByQ3iVwWurwwseRPiWa8+MI
 =OVRS
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'driver-core-3.19-rc1' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/gregkh/driver-core

Pull driver core update from Greg KH:
 "Here's the set of driver core patches for 3.19-rc1.

  They are dominated by the removal of the .owner field in platform
  drivers.  They touch a lot of files, but they are "simple" changes,
  just removing a line in a structure.

  Other than that, a few minor driver core and debugfs changes.  There
  are some ath9k patches coming in through this tree that have been
  acked by the wireless maintainers as they relied on the debugfs
  changes.

  Everything has been in linux-next for a while"

* tag 'driver-core-3.19-rc1' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/gregkh/driver-core: (324 commits)
  Revert "ath: ath9k: use debugfs_create_devm_seqfile() helper for seq_file entries"
  fs: debugfs: add forward declaration for struct device type
  firmware class: Deletion of an unnecessary check before the function call "vunmap"
  firmware loader: fix hung task warning dump
  devcoredump: provide a one-way disable function
  device: Add dev_<level>_once variants
  ath: ath9k: use debugfs_create_devm_seqfile() helper for seq_file entries
  ath: use seq_file api for ath9k debugfs files
  debugfs: add helper function to create device related seq_file
  drivers/base: cacheinfo: remove noisy error boot message
  Revert "core: platform: add warning if driver has no owner"
  drivers: base: support cpu cache information interface to userspace via sysfs
  drivers: base: add cpu_device_create to support per-cpu devices
  topology: replace custom attribute macros with standard DEVICE_ATTR*
  cpumask: factor out show_cpumap into separate helper function
  driver core: Fix unbalanced device reference in drivers_probe
  driver core: fix race with userland in device_add()
  sysfs/kernfs: make read requests on pre-alloc files use the buffer.
  sysfs/kernfs: allow attributes to request write buffer be pre-allocated.
  fs: sysfs: return EGBIG on write if offset is larger than file size
  ...
2014-12-14 16:10:09 -08:00
Linus Torvalds
e3aa91a7cb Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/herbert/crypto-2.6
Pull crypto update from Herbert Xu:
 - The crypto API is now documented :)
 - Disallow arbitrary module loading through crypto API.
 - Allow get request with empty driver name through crypto_user.
 - Allow speed testing of arbitrary hash functions.
 - Add caam support for ctr(aes), gcm(aes) and their derivatives.
 - nx now supports concurrent hashing properly.
 - Add sahara support for SHA1/256.
 - Add ARM64 version of CRC32.
 - Misc fixes.

* git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/herbert/crypto-2.6: (77 commits)
  crypto: tcrypt - Allow speed testing of arbitrary hash functions
  crypto: af_alg - add user space interface for AEAD
  crypto: qat - fix problem with coalescing enable logic
  crypto: sahara - add support for SHA1/256
  crypto: sahara - replace tasklets with kthread
  crypto: sahara - add support for i.MX53
  crypto: sahara - fix spinlock initialization
  crypto: arm - replace memset by memzero_explicit
  crypto: powerpc - replace memset by memzero_explicit
  crypto: sha - replace memset by memzero_explicit
  crypto: sparc - replace memset by memzero_explicit
  crypto: algif_skcipher - initialize upon init request
  crypto: algif_skcipher - removed unneeded code
  crypto: algif_skcipher - Fixed blocking recvmsg
  crypto: drbg - use memzero_explicit() for clearing sensitive data
  crypto: drbg - use MODULE_ALIAS_CRYPTO
  crypto: include crypto- module prefix in template
  crypto: user - add MODULE_ALIAS
  crypto: sha-mb - remove a bogus NULL check
  crytpo: qat - Fix 64 bytes requests
  ...
2014-12-13 13:33:26 -08:00
Alexander Duyck
e962f30297 fib_trie: Fix trie balancing issue if new node pushes down existing node
This patch addresses an issue with the level compression of the fib_trie.
Specifically in the case of adding a new leaf that triggers a new node to
be added that takes the place of the old node.  The result is a trie where
the 1 child tnode is on one side and one leaf is on the other which gives
you a very deep trie.  Below is the script I used to generate a trie on
dummy0 with a 10.X.X.X family of addresses.

  ip link add type dummy
  ipval=184549374
  bit=2
  for i in `seq 1 23`
  do
    ifconfig dummy0:$bit $ipval/8
    ipval=`expr $ipval - $bit`
    bit=`expr $bit \* 2`
  done
  cat /proc/net/fib_triestat

Running the script before the patch:

	Local:
		Aver depth:     10.82
		Max depth:      23
		Leaves:         29
		Prefixes:       30
		Internal nodes: 27
		  1: 26  2: 1
		Pointers: 56
	Null ptrs: 1
	Total size: 5  kB

After applying the patch and repeating:

	Local:
		Aver depth:     4.72
		Max depth:      9
		Leaves:         29
		Prefixes:       30
		Internal nodes: 12
		  1: 3  2: 2  3: 7
		Pointers: 70
	Null ptrs: 30
	Total size: 4  kB

What this fix does is start the rebalance at the newly created tnode
instead of at the parent tnode.  This way if there is a gap between the
parent and the new node it doesn't prevent the new tnode from being
coalesced with any pre-existing nodes that may have been pushed into one
of the new nodes child branches.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-12 10:58:53 -05:00
Toshiaki Makita
53f6b708f8 vlan: Add ability to always enable TSO/UFO
Since the real device can segment packets by software, a vlan device
can set TSO/UFO even when the real device doesn't have those features.
Unlike GSO, this allows packets to be segmented after Qdisc.

Signed-off-by: Toshiaki Makita <makita.toshiaki@lab.ntt.co.jp>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-12 10:58:53 -05:00
Sujith Manoharan
5cf16616e1 mac80211: Fix accounting of multicast frames
Since multicast frames are marked as no-ack, using
IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK to check if they have been
successfully transmitted by the driver is incorrect
since a driver can choose to ignore transmission status
for no-ack frames. This results in incorrect accounting
for such frames.

To fix this issue, this patch introduces a new flag
that can be used by drivers to indicate error-free
transmission of no-ack frames.

Signed-off-by: Sujith Manoharan <c_manoha@qca.qualcomm.com>
[add a note about not setting the flag for non-no-ack frames]
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 13:48:43 +01:00
Sujith Manoharan
6b127c71fb mac80211: Move IEEE80211_TX_CTL_PS_RESPONSE
Move IEEE80211_TX_CTL_PS_RESPONSE to info->control.flags since
this is used only in the TX path (by ath9k). This frees up
a bit which can be used for other purposes.

Signed-off-by: Sujith Manoharan <c_manoha@qca.qualcomm.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 13:48:26 +01:00
Vadim Kochan
ba1debdfed wireless: Support of IFLA_INFO_KIND rtnl attribute
It allows to identify the wlan kind of device for the user application,
e.g.:

    # ip -d link

    1: lo: <LOOPBACK,UP,LOWER_UP> mtu 65536 qdisc noqueue state UNKNOWN mode DEFAULT group default
        link/loopback 00:00:00:00:00:00 brd 00:00:00:00:00:00 promiscuity 0
    2: enp0s25: <NO-CARRIER,BROADCAST,MULTICAST,UP> mtu 1500 qdisc pfifo_fast state DOWN mode DEFAULT group default qlen 1000
        link/ether XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX brd ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff promiscuity 0
    3: wlp3s0: <BROADCAST,MULTICAST,UP,LOWER_UP> mtu 1500 qdisc mq state UP mode DEFAULT group default qlen 1000
        link/ether XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX brd ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff promiscuity 0
        wlan

Signed-off-by: Vadim Kochan <vadim4j@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
[make wireless_link_ops const]
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 13:48:25 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
185076d6db cfg80211: correctly check ad-hoc channels
Ad-hoc requires beaconing for regulatory purposes. Validate that the
channel is valid for beaconing, and not only enabled.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Luis R. Rodriguez <mcgrof@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 13:40:38 +01:00
Emmanuel Grumbach
70dcec5a48 cfg80211: don't WARN about two consecutive Country IE hint
This can happen and there is no point in added more
detection code lower in the stack. Catching these in one
single point (cfg80211) is enough. Stop WARNING about this
case.

This fixes:
https://bugzilla.kernel.org/show_bug.cgi?id=89001

Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org
Fixes: 2f1c6c572d ("cfg80211: process non country IE conflicting first")
Signed-off-by: Emmanuel Grumbach <emmanuel.grumbach@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 13:29:02 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
9845904fd4 Bluetooth: Fix mgmt response status when removing adapter
When an adapter is removed (hci_unregister_dev) any pending mgmt
commands for that adapter should get the appropriate INVALID_INDEX
response. Since hci_unregister_dev() calls hci_dev_do_close() first
that'd so far have caused "not powered" responses to be sent.

Skipping the HCI_UNREGISTER case in mgmt_powered() is also not a
solution since before reaching the mgmt_index_removed() stage any
hci_conn callbacks (e.g. used by pairing) will get called, thereby
causing "disconnected" status responses to be sent.

The fix that covers all scenarios is to handle both INVALID_INDEX and
NOT_POWERED responses through the mgmt_powered() function. The
INVALID_INDEX response sending from mgmt_index_removed() is left
untouched since there are a couple of places not related to powering off
or removing an adapter that call it (e.g. configuring a new bdaddr).

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-12 13:20:12 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
ec6f99b807 Bluetooth: Fix enabling BR/EDR SC when powering on
If we're in the AUTO_OFF stage the powered_update_hci() function is
responsible for doing the updates to the HCI state that were not done
during the actual mgmt command handlers. One of the updates needing done
is for BR/EDR SC support. This patch adds the missing HCI command for SC
support to the powered_update_hci() function.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-12 13:17:41 +01:00
Emmanuel Grumbach
722ddb0dab mac80211: update the channel context after channel switch
When the channel switch has been made, a vif is now using
the channel context which was reserved. When that happens,
we need to update the channel context since its parameters
may change.

I hit a case in which I switched to a 40Mhz channel but the
reserved channel context was still on 20Mhz. The rate control
would try to send 40Mhz packets on a 20Mhz channel context and
that made iwlwifi's firmware unhappy.

Signed-off-by: Emmanuel Grumbach <emmanuel.grumbach@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 12:35:38 +01:00
Luciano Coelho
f89f46cf3a nl80211: check matches array length before acessing it
If the userspace passes a malformed sched scan request (or a net
detect wowlan configuration) by adding a NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH
attribute without any nested matchsets, a NULL pointer dereference
will occur.  Fix this by checking that we do have matchsets in our
array before trying to access it.

BUG: unable to handle kernel NULL pointer dereference at 0000000000000024
IP: [<ffffffffa002fd69>] nl80211_parse_sched_scan.part.67+0x6e9/0x900 [cfg80211]
PGD 865c067 PUD 865b067 PMD 0
Oops: 0002 [#1] SMP
Modules linked in: iwlmvm(O) iwlwifi(O) mac80211(O) cfg80211(O) compat(O) [last unloaded: compat]
CPU: 2 PID: 2442 Comm: iw Tainted: G           O   3.17.2 #31
Hardware name: Bochs Bochs, BIOS Bochs 01/01/2011
task: ffff880013800790 ti: ffff880008d80000 task.ti: ffff880008d80000
RIP: 0010:[<ffffffffa002fd69>]  [<ffffffffa002fd69>] nl80211_parse_sched_scan.part.67+0x6e9/0x900 [cfg80211]
RSP: 0018:ffff880008d838d0  EFLAGS: 00010293
RAX: 0000000000000000 RBX: 0000000000000000 RCX: 0000000000000000
RDX: 000000000000143c RSI: 0000000000000000 RDI: ffff880008ee8dd0
RBP: ffff880008d83948 R08: 0000000000000002 R09: 0000000000000019
R10: ffff88001d1b3c40 R11: 0000000000000002 R12: ffff880019e85e00
R13: 00000000fffffed4 R14: ffff880009757800 R15: 0000000000001388
FS:  00007fa3b6d13700(0000) GS:ffff88003e200000(0000) knlGS:0000000000000000
CS:  0010 DS: 0000 ES: 0000 CR0: 0000000080050033
CR2: 0000000000000024 CR3: 0000000008670000 CR4: 00000000000006e0
Stack:
 ffff880009757800 ffff880000000001 0000000000000000 ffff880008ee84e0
 0000000000000000 ffff880009757800 00000000fffffed4 ffff880008d83948
 ffffffff814689c9 ffff880009757800 ffff880008ee8000 0000000000000000
Call Trace:
 [<ffffffff814689c9>] ? nla_parse+0xb9/0x120
 [<ffffffffa00306de>] nl80211_set_wowlan+0x75e/0x960 [cfg80211]
 [<ffffffff810bf3d5>] ? mark_held_locks+0x75/0xa0
 [<ffffffff8161a77b>] genl_family_rcv_msg+0x18b/0x360
 [<ffffffff810bf66d>] ? trace_hardirqs_on+0xd/0x10
 [<ffffffff8161a9d4>] genl_rcv_msg+0x84/0xc0
 [<ffffffff8161a950>] ? genl_family_rcv_msg+0x360/0x360
 [<ffffffff81618e79>] netlink_rcv_skb+0xa9/0xd0
 [<ffffffff81619458>] genl_rcv+0x28/0x40
 [<ffffffff816184a5>] netlink_unicast+0x105/0x180
 [<ffffffff8161886f>] netlink_sendmsg+0x34f/0x7a0
 [<ffffffff8105a097>] ? kvm_clock_read+0x27/0x40
 [<ffffffff815c644d>] sock_sendmsg+0x8d/0xc0
 [<ffffffff811a75c9>] ? might_fault+0xb9/0xc0
 [<ffffffff811a756e>] ? might_fault+0x5e/0xc0
 [<ffffffff815d5d26>] ? verify_iovec+0x56/0xe0
 [<ffffffff815c73e0>] ___sys_sendmsg+0x3d0/0x3e0
 [<ffffffff810a7be8>] ? sched_clock_cpu+0x98/0xd0
 [<ffffffff810611b4>] ? __do_page_fault+0x254/0x580
 [<ffffffff810bb39f>] ? up_read+0x1f/0x40
 [<ffffffff810611b4>] ? __do_page_fault+0x254/0x580
 [<ffffffff812146ed>] ? __fget_light+0x13d/0x160
 [<ffffffff815c7b02>] __sys_sendmsg+0x42/0x80
 [<ffffffff815c7b52>] SyS_sendmsg+0x12/0x20
 [<ffffffff81751f69>] system_call_fastpath+0x16/0x1b

Fixes: ea73cbce4e ("nl80211: fix scheduled scan RSSI matchset attribute confusion")
Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org [3.15+]
Signed-off-by: Luciano Coelho <luciano.coelho@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 12:33:25 +01:00
Johannes Berg
cec3f0ed7d cfg80211: use __force __rcu to suppress sparse warning
The code assigns a constant value (a pointer to a static variable)
to an RCU pointer, which results in a sparse warning:
  reg.c:112:10: warning: cast adds address space to expression (<asn:4>)

Suppress this warning by using __force.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 12:27:23 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
34f05f543f cfg80211: avoid mem leak on driver hint set
In the already-set and intersect case of a driver-hint, the previous
wiphy regdomain was not freed before being reset with a copy of the
cfg80211 regdomain.

Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Acked-by: Luis R. Rodriguez <mcgrof@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 12:25:33 +01:00
Jouni Malinen
08f6f14777 cfg80211: Fix 160 MHz channels with 80+80 and 160 MHz drivers
The VHT supported channel width field is a two bit integer, not a
bitfield. cfg80211_chandef_usable() was interpreting it incorrectly and
ended up rejecting 160 MHz channel width if the driver indicated support
for both 160 and 80+80 MHz channels.

Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org (3.16+)
Fixes: 3d9d1d6656 ("nl80211/cfg80211: support VHT channel configuration")
       (however, no real drivers had 160 MHz support it until 3.16)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 12:18:47 +01:00
Andreas Müller
d025933e29 mac80211: fix multicast LED blinking and counter
As multicast-frames can't be fragmented, "dot11MulticastReceivedFrameCount"
stopped being incremented after the use-after-free fix. Furthermore, the
RX-LED will be triggered by every multicast frame (which wouldn't happen
before) which wouldn't allow the LED to rest at all.

Fixes https://bugzilla.kernel.org/show_bug.cgi?id=89431 which also had the
patch.

Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org
Fixes: b8fff407a1 ("mac80211: fix use-after-free in defragmentation")
Signed-off-by: Andreas Müller <goo@stapelspeicher.org>
[rewrite commit message]
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 12:11:14 +01:00
Jes Sorensen
7e6225a160 mac80211: avoid using uninitialized stack data
Avoid a case where we would access uninitialized stack data if the AP
advertises HT support without 40MHz channel support.

Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org
Fixes: f3000e1b43 ("mac80211: fix broken use of VHT/20Mhz with some APs")
Signed-off-by: Jes Sorensen <Jes.Sorensen@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-12-12 12:00:46 +01:00
Florian Fainelli
9697f1cde9 net: dsa: propagate error code from dsa_slave_phy_setup
In case we cannot attach to our slave netdevice PHY, error out and
propagate that error up to the caller: dsa_slave_create().

Fixes: 0d8bcdd383 ("net: dsa: allow for more complex PHY setups")
Signed-off-by: Andrey Volkov <andrey.volkov@nexvision.fr>
Signed-off-by: Florian Fainelli <f.fainelli@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-11 21:00:08 -05:00
Florian Fainelli
53013c7743 net: dsa: handle non-existing PHYs on switch internal bus
In case there is no PHY at the designated address on the internal
switch, we would basically de-reference a null pointer here:

dsa_slave_phy_setup(...)
{
	p->phy = ds->slave_mii_bus->phy_map[p->port];
	phy_connect_direct(slave_dev, p->phy, dsa_slave_adjust_link,
				      ^------

This can be triggered when the platform configuration (platform_data or
Device Tree) indicates there should be a PHY device at this address, but
the HW is non-responsive, such that we cannot attach a PHY device at
this specific location.

Fix this by checking the return value prior to calling
phy_connect_direct().

CC: Andrew Lunn <andrew@lunn.ch>
Fixes: b31f65fb43 ("net: dsa: slave: Fix autoneg for phys on switch MDIO bus")
Reported-by: Brian Norris <computersforpeace@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Andrey Volkov <andrey.volkov@nexvision.fr>
Signed-off-by: Florian Fainelli <f.fainelli@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-11 20:58:50 -05:00
Linus Torvalds
70e71ca0af Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net-next
Pull networking updates from David Miller:

 1) New offloading infrastructure and example 'rocker' driver for
    offloading of switching and routing to hardware.

    This work was done by a large group of dedicated individuals, not
    limited to: Scott Feldman, Jiri Pirko, Thomas Graf, John Fastabend,
    Jamal Hadi Salim, Andy Gospodarek, Florian Fainelli, Roopa Prabhu

 2) Start making the networking operate on IOV iterators instead of
    modifying iov objects in-situ during transfers.  Thanks to Al Viro
    and Herbert Xu.

 3) A set of new netlink interfaces for the TIPC stack, from Richard
    Alpe.

 4) Remove unnecessary looping during ipv6 routing lookups, from Martin
    KaFai Lau.

 5) Add PAUSE frame generation support to gianfar driver, from Matei
    Pavaluca.

 6) Allow for larger reordering levels in TCP, which are easily
    achievable in the real world right now, from Eric Dumazet.

 7) Add a variable of napi_schedule that doesn't need to disable cpu
    interrupts, from Eric Dumazet.

 8) Use a doubly linked list to optimize neigh_parms_release(), from
    Nicolas Dichtel.

 9) Various enhancements to the kernel BPF verifier, and allow eBPF
    programs to actually be attached to sockets.  From Alexei
    Starovoitov.

10) Support TSO/LSO in sunvnet driver, from David L Stevens.

11) Allow controlling ECN usage via routing metrics, from Florian
    Westphal.

12) Remote checksum offload, from Tom Herbert.

13) Add split-header receive, BQL, and xmit_more support to amd-xgbe
    driver, from Thomas Lendacky.

14) Add MPLS support to openvswitch, from Simon Horman.

15) Support wildcard tunnel endpoints in ipv6 tunnels, from Steffen
    Klassert.

16) Do gro flushes on a per-device basis using a timer, from Eric
    Dumazet.  This tries to resolve the conflicting goals between the
    desired handling of bulk vs.  RPC-like traffic.

17) Allow userspace to ask for the CPU upon what a packet was
    received/steered, via SO_INCOMING_CPU.  From Eric Dumazet.

18) Limit GSO packets to half the current congestion window, from Eric
    Dumazet.

19) Add a generic helper so that all drivers set their RSS keys in a
    consistent way, from Eric Dumazet.

20) Add xmit_more support to enic driver, from Govindarajulu
    Varadarajan.

21) Add VLAN packet scheduler action, from Jiri Pirko.

22) Support configurable RSS hash functions via ethtool, from Eyal
    Perry.

* git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net-next: (1820 commits)
  Fix race condition between vxlan_sock_add and vxlan_sock_release
  net/macb: fix compilation warning for print_hex_dump() called with skb->mac_header
  net/mlx4: Add support for A0 steering
  net/mlx4: Refactor QUERY_PORT
  net/mlx4_core: Add explicit error message when rule doesn't meet configuration
  net/mlx4: Add A0 hybrid steering
  net/mlx4: Add mlx4_bitmap zone allocator
  net/mlx4: Add a check if there are too many reserved QPs
  net/mlx4: Change QP allocation scheme
  net/mlx4_core: Use tasklet for user-space CQ completion events
  net/mlx4_core: Mask out host side virtualization features for guests
  net/mlx4_en: Set csum level for encapsulated packets
  be2net: Export tunnel offloads only when a VxLAN tunnel is created
  gianfar: Fix dma check map error when DMA_API_DEBUG is enabled
  cxgb4/csiostor: Don't use MASTER_MUST for fw_hello call
  net: fec: only enable mdio interrupt before phy device link up
  net: fec: clear all interrupt events to support i.MX6SX
  net: fec: reset fep link status in suspend function
  net: sock: fix access via invalid file descriptor
  net: introduce helper macro for_each_cmsghdr
  ...
2014-12-11 14:27:06 -08:00
Linus Torvalds
6b9e2cea42 virtio: virtio 1.0 support, misc patches
This adds a lot of infrastructure for virtio 1.0 support.
 Notable missing pieces: virtio pci, virtio balloon (needs spec extension),
 vhost scsi.
 
 Plus, there are some minor fixes in a couple of places.
 
 Cc: David Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
 Cc: Rusty Russell <rusty@rustcorp.com.au>
 Signed-off-by: Michael S. Tsirkin <mst@redhat.com>
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 Version: GnuPG v1
 
 iQEcBAABAgAGBQJUh1CVAAoJECgfDbjSjVRpWZcH/2+EGPyng7Lca820UHA0cU1U
 u4D8CAAwOGaVdnUUo8ox1eon3LNB2UgRtgsl3rBDR3YTgFfNPrfuYdnHO0dYIDc1
 lS26NuPrVrTX0lA+OBPe2nlKrsrOkn8aw1kxG9Y0gKtNg/+HAGNW5e2eE7R/LrA5
 94XbWZ8g9Yf4GPG1iFmih9vQvvN0E68zcUlojfCnllySgaIEYr8nTiGQBWpRgJat
 fCqFAp1HMDZzGJQO+m1/Vw0OftTRVybyfai59e6uUTa8x1djvzPb/1MvREqQjegM
 ylSuofIVyj7JPu++FbAjd9mikkb53GSc8ql3YmWNZLdr69rnkzP0GdzQvrdheAo=
 =RtrR
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'for_linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/mst/vhost

Pull virtio updates from Michael Tsirkin:
 "virtio: virtio 1.0 support, misc patches

  This adds a lot of infrastructure for virtio 1.0 support.  Notable
  missing pieces: virtio pci, virtio balloon (needs spec extension),
  vhost scsi.

  Plus, there are some minor fixes in a couple of places.

  Note: some net drivers are affected by these patches.  David said he's
  fine with merging these patches through my tree.

  Rusty's on vacation, he acked using my tree for these, too"

* tag 'for_linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/mst/vhost: (70 commits)
  virtio_ccw: finalize_features error handling
  virtio_ccw: future-proof finalize_features
  virtio_pci: rename virtio_pci -> virtio_pci_common
  virtio_pci: update file descriptions and copyright
  virtio_pci: split out legacy device support
  virtio_pci: setup config vector indirectly
  virtio_pci: setup vqs indirectly
  virtio_pci: delete vqs indirectly
  virtio_pci: use priv for vq notification
  virtio_pci: free up vq->priv
  virtio_pci: fix coding style for structs
  virtio_pci: add isr field
  virtio: drop legacy_only driver flag
  virtio_balloon: drop legacy_only driver flag
  virtio_ccw: rev 1 devices set VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1
  virtio: allow finalize_features to fail
  virtio_ccw: legacy: don't negotiate rev 1/features
  virtio: add API to detect legacy devices
  virtio_console: fix sparse warnings
  vhost: remove unnecessary forward declarations in vhost.h
  ...
2014-12-11 12:20:31 -08:00
Johan Hedberg
1aeb9c651c Bluetooth: Fix notifying mgmt power off before flushing connection list
This patch moves the mgmt_powered() notification earlier in the
hci_dev_do_close() function. This way the correct "not powered" error
gets passed to any pending mgmt commands. Without the patch the pending
commands would instead get a misleading "disconnected" response when
powering down the adapter.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-11 20:57:39 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
a511b35ba4 Bluetooth: Fix incorrect pending cmd removal in pairing_complete()
The pairing_complete() function is used as a pending mgmt command
cmd_complete callback. The expectation of such functions is that they
are not responsible themselves for calling mgmt_pending_remove(). This
patch fixes the incorrect mgmt_pending_remove() call in
pairing_complete() and adds it to the appropriate changes.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-11 20:57:38 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
15013aeb63 Bluetooth: Fix calling hci_conn_put too early
The pairing_complete() function relies on a hci_conn reference to be
able to access the hci_conn object. It should therefore only release
this reference once it's done accessing the object, i.e. at the end of
the function.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-11 20:57:38 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
417287de88 Bluetooth: Fix check for support for page scan related commands
The Read Page Scan Activity and Read Page Scan Type commands are not
supported by all controllers. Move the execution of both commands
into the 3rd phase of the init procedure. And then check the bit
mask of supported commands before adding them to the init sequence.

With this re-ordering of the init sequence, the extra check for
AVM BlueFritz! controllers is no longer needed. They will report
that these two commands are not supported.

This fixes an issue with the Microsoft Corp. Wireless Transceiver
for Bluetooth 2.0 (ID 045e:009c).

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-11 21:42:11 +02:00
Jaganath Kanakkassery
5c1a4c8f28 Bluetooth: Fix missing hci_dev_lock/unlock in hci_event
mgmt_pending_remove() should be called with hci_dev_lock protection and
all hci_event.c functions which calls mgmt_complete() (which eventually
calls mgmt_pending_remove()) should hold the lock.
So this patch fixes the same

Signed-off-by: Jaganath Kanakkassery <jaganath.k@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-11 15:09:04 +01:00
Jaganath Kanakkassery
3ad675827f Bluetooth: Fix missing hci_dev_lock/unlock in mgmt req_complete()
mgmt_pending_remove() should be called with hci_dev_lock protection
and currently the rule to take dev lock is that all mgmt req_complete
functions should take dev lock. So this patch fixes the same in the
missing functions

Without this patch there is a chance of invalid memory access while
accessing the mgmt_pending list like below

bluetoothd:  392] [0] Backtrace:
bluetoothd:  392] [0] [<c04ec770>] (pending_eir_or_class+0x0/0x68) from [<c04f1830>] (add_uuid+0x34/0x1c4)
bluetoothd:  392] [0] [<c04f17fc>] (add_uuid+0x0/0x1c4) from [<c04f3cc4>] (mgmt_control+0x204/0x274)
bluetoothd:  392] [0] [<c04f3ac0>] (mgmt_control+0x0/0x274) from [<c04f609c>] (hci_sock_sendmsg+0x80/0x308)
bluetoothd:  392] [0] [<c04f601c>] (hci_sock_sendmsg+0x0/0x308) from [<c03d4d68>] (sock_aio_write+0x144/0x174)
bluetoothd:  392] [0]  r8:00000000 r7 7c1be90 r6 7c1be18 r5:00000017 r4 a90ea80
bluetoothd:  392] [0] [<c03d4c24>] (sock_aio_write+0x0/0x174) from [<c00e2d4c>] (do_sync_write+0xb0/0xe0)
bluetoothd:  392] [0] [<c00e2c9c>] (do_sync_write+0x0/0xe0) from [<c00e371c>] (vfs_write+0x134/0x13c)
bluetoothd:  392] [0]  r8:00000000 r7 7c1bf70 r6:beeca5c8 r5:00000017 r4 7c05900
bluetoothd:  392] [0] [<c00e35e8>] (vfs_write+0x0/0x13c) from [<c00e3910>] (sys_write+0x44/0x70)
bluetoothd:  392] [0]  r8:00000000 r7:00000004 r6:00000017 r5:beeca5c8 r4 7c05900
bluetoothd:  392] [0] [<c00e38cc>] (sys_write+0x0/0x70) from [<c000e3c0>] (ret_fast_syscall+0x0/0x30)
bluetoothd:  392] [0]  r9 7c1a000 r8:c000e568 r6:400b5f10 r5:403896d8 r4:beeca604
bluetoothd:  392] [0] Code: e28cc00c e152000c 0a00000f e3a00001 (e1d210b8)
bluetoothd:  392] [0] ---[ end trace 67b6ac67435864c4 ]---
bluetoothd:  392] [0] Kernel panic - not syncing: Fatal exception

Signed-off-by: Jaganath Kanakkassery <jaganath.k@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-11 14:08:47 +01:00
Linus Torvalds
92a578b064 ACPI and power management updates for 3.19-rc1
This time we have some more new material than we used to have during
 the last couple of development cycles.
 
 The most important part of it to me is the introduction of a unified
 interface for accessing device properties provided by platform
 firmware.  It works with Device Trees and ACPI in a uniform way and
 drivers using it need not worry about where the properties come
 from as long as the platform firmware (either DT or ACPI) makes
 them available.  It covers both devices and "bare" device node
 objects without struct device representation as that turns out to
 be necessary in some cases.  This has been in the works for quite
 a few months (and development cycles) and has been approved by
 all of the relevant maintainers.
 
 On top of that, some drivers are switched over to the new interface
 (at25, leds-gpio, gpio_keys_polled) and some additional changes are
 made to the core GPIO subsystem to allow device drivers to manipulate
 GPIOs in the "canonical" way on platforms that provide GPIO information
 in their ACPI tables, but don't assign names to GPIO lines (in which
 case the driver needs to do that on the basis of what it knows about
 the device in question).  That also has been approved by the GPIO
 core maintainers and the rfkill driver is now going to use it.
 
 Second is support for hardware P-states in the intel_pstate driver.
 It uses CPUID to detect whether or not the feature is supported by
 the processor in which case it will be enabled by default.  However,
 it can be disabled entirely from the kernel command line if necessary.
 
 Next is support for a platform firmware interface based on ACPI
 operation regions used by the PMIC (Power Management Integrated
 Circuit) chips on the Intel Baytrail-T and Baytrail-T-CR platforms.
 That interface is used for manipulating power resources and for
 thermal management: sensor temperature reporting, trip point setting
 and so on.
 
 Also the ACPI core is now going to support the _DEP configuration
 information in a limited way.  Basically, _DEP it supposed to reflect
 off-the-hierarchy dependencies between devices which may be very
 indirect, like when AML for one device accesses locations in an
 operation region handled by another device's driver (usually, the
 device depended on this way is a serial bus or GPIO controller).
 The support added this time is sufficient to make the ACPI battery
 driver work on Asus T100A, but it is general enough to be able to
 cover some other use cases in the future.
 
 Finally, we have a new cpufreq driver for the Loongson1B processor.
 
 In addition to the above, there are fixes and cleanups all over the
 place as usual and a traditional ACPICA update to a recent upstream
 release.
 
 As far as the fixes go, the ACPI LPSS (Low-power Subsystem) driver
 for Intel platforms should be able to handle power management of
 the DMA engine correctly, the cpufreq-dt driver should interact
 with the thermal subsystem in a better way and the ACPI backlight
 driver should handle some more corner cases, among other things.
 
 On top of the ACPICA update there are fixes for race conditions
 in the ACPICA's interrupt handling code which might lead to some
 random and strange looking failures on some systems.
 
 In the cleanups department the most visible part is the series
 of commits targeted at getting rid of the CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME
 configuration option.  That was triggered by a discussion
 regarding the generic power domains code during which we realized
 that trying to support certain combinations of PM config options
 was painful and not really worth it, because nobody would use them
 in production anyway.  For this reason, we decided to make
 CONFIG_PM_SLEEP select CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME and that lead to the
 conclusion that the latter became redundant and CONFIG_PM could
 be used instead of it.  The material here makes that replacement
 in a major part of the tree, but there will be at least one more
 batch of that in the second part of the merge window.
 
 Specifics:
 
  - Support for retrieving device properties information from ACPI
    _DSD device configuration objects and a unified device properties
    interface for device drivers (and subsystems) on top of that.
    As stated above, this works with Device Trees and ACPI and allows
    device drivers to be written in a platform firmware (DT or ACPI)
    agnostic way.  The at25, leds-gpio and gpio_keys_polled drivers
    are now going to use this new interface and the GPIO subsystem
    is additionally modified to allow device drivers to assign names
    to GPIO resources returned by ACPI _CRS objects (in case _DSD is
    not present or does not provide the expected data).  The changes
    in this set are mostly from Mika Westerberg, Rafael J Wysocki,
    Aaron Lu, and Darren Hart with some fixes from others (Fabio Estevam,
    Geert Uytterhoeven).
 
  - Support for Hardware Managed Performance States (HWP) as described
    in Volume 3, section 14.4, of the Intel SDM in the intel_pstate
    driver.  CPUID is used to detect whether or not the feature is
    supported by the processor.  If supported, it will be enabled
    automatically unless the intel_pstate=no_hwp switch is present in
    the kernel command line.  From Dirk Brandewie.
 
  - New Intel Broadwell-H ID for intel_pstate (Dirk Brandewie).
 
  - Support for firmware interface based on ACPI operation regions
    used by the PMIC chips on the Intel Baytrail-T and Baytrail-T-CR
    platforms for power resource control and thermal management
    (Aaron Lu).
 
  - Limited support for retrieving off-the-hierarchy dependencies
    between devices from ACPI _DEP device configuration objects
    and deferred probing support for the ACPI battery driver based
    on the _DEP information to make that driver work on Asus T100A
    (Lan Tianyu).
 
  - New cpufreq driver for the Loongson1B processor (Kelvin Cheung).
 
  - ACPICA update to upstream revision 20141107 which only affects
    tools (Bob Moore).
 
  - Fixes for race conditions in the ACPICA's interrupt handling
    code and in the ACPI code related to system suspend and resume
    (Lv Zheng and Rafael J Wysocki).
 
  - ACPI core fix for an RCU-related issue in the ioremap() regions
    management code that slowed down significantly after CPUs had
    been allowed to enter idle states even if they'd had RCU callbakcs
    queued and triggered some problems in certain proprietary graphics
    driver (and elsewhere).  The fix replaces synchronize_rcu() in
    that code with synchronize_rcu_expedited() which makes the issue
    go away.  From Konstantin Khlebnikov.
 
  - ACPI LPSS (Low-Power Subsystem) driver fix to handle power
    management of the DMA engine included into the LPSS correctly.
    The problem is that the DMA engine doesn't have ACPI PM support
    of its own and it simply is turned off when the last LPSS device
    having ACPI PM support goes into D3cold.  To work around that,
    the PM domain used by the ACPI LPSS driver is redesigned so at
    least one device with ACPI PM support will be on as long as the
    DMA engine is in use.  From Andy Shevchenko.
 
  - ACPI backlight driver fix to avoid using it on "Win8-compatible"
    systems where it doesn't work and where it was used by default by
    mistake (Aaron Lu).
 
  - Assorted minor ACPI core fixes and cleanups from Tomasz Nowicki,
    Sudeep Holla, Huang Rui, Hanjun Guo, Fabian Frederick, and
    Ashwin Chaugule (mostly related to the upcoming ARM64 support).
 
  - Intel RAPL (Running Average Power Limit) power capping driver
    fixes and improvements including new processor IDs (Jacob Pan).
 
  - Generic power domains modification to power up domains after
    attaching devices to them to meet the expectations of device
    drivers and bus types assuming devices to be accessible at
    probe time (Ulf Hansson).
 
  - Preliminary support for controlling device clocks from the
    generic power domains core code and modifications of the
    ARM/shmobile platform to use that feature (Ulf Hansson).
 
  - Assorted minor fixes and cleanups of the generic power
    domains core code (Ulf Hansson, Geert Uytterhoeven).
 
  - Assorted minor fixes and cleanups of the device clocks control
    code in the PM core (Geert Uytterhoeven, Grygorii Strashko).
 
  - Consolidation of device power management Kconfig options by making
    CONFIG_PM_SLEEP select CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME and removing the latter
    which is now redundant (Rafael J Wysocki and Kevin Hilman).  That
    is the first batch of the changes needed for this purpose.
 
  - Core device runtime power management support code cleanup related
    to the execution of callbacks (Andrzej Hajda).
 
  - cpuidle ARM support improvements (Lorenzo Pieralisi).
 
  - cpuidle cleanup related to the CPUIDLE_FLAG_TIME_VALID flag and
    a new MAINTAINERS entry for ARM Exynos cpuidle (Daniel Lezcano and
    Bartlomiej Zolnierkiewicz).
 
  - New cpufreq driver callback (->ready) to be executed when the
    cpufreq core is ready to use a given policy object and cpufreq-dt
    driver modification to use that callback for cooling device
    registration (Viresh Kumar).
 
  - cpufreq core fixes and cleanups (Viresh Kumar, Vince Hsu,
    James Geboski, Tomeu Vizoso).
 
  - Assorted fixes and cleanups in the cpufreq-pcc, intel_pstate,
    cpufreq-dt, pxa2xx cpufreq drivers (Lenny Szubowicz, Ethan Zhao,
    Stefan Wahren, Petr Cvek).
 
  - OPP (Operating Performance Points) framework modification to
    allow OPPs to be removed too and update of a few cpufreq drivers
    (cpufreq-dt, exynos5440, imx6q, cpufreq) to remove OPPs (added
    during initialization) on driver removal (Viresh Kumar).
 
  - Hibernation core fixes and cleanups (Tina Ruchandani and
    Markus Elfring).
 
  - PM Kconfig fix related to CPU power management (Pankaj Dubey).
 
  - cpupower tool fix (Prarit Bhargava).
 
 /
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 Version: GnuPG v2.0.22 (GNU/Linux)
 
 iQIcBAABCAAGBQJUhj6JAAoJEILEb/54YlRxTM4P/j5g5SfqvY0QKsn7sR7MGZ6v
 nsgCBhJAqTw3ocNC7EAs8z9h2GWy1KbKpakKYWAh9Fs1yZoey7tFSlcv/Rgjlp70
 uU5sDQHtpE9mHKiymdsowiQuWgpl962L4k+k8hUslhlvgk1PvVbpajR6OqG8G+pD
 asuIW9eh1APNkLyXmRJ3ZPomzs0VmRdZJ0NEs0lKX9mJskqEvxPIwdaxq3iaJq9B
 Fo0J345zUDcJnxWblDRdHlOigCimglElfN5qJwaC4KpwUKuBvLRKbp4f69+wfT0c
 kYFiR29X5KjJ2kLfP/wKsLyuDCYYXRq3tCia5M1tAqOjZ+UA89H/GDftx/5lntmv
 qUlBa35VfdS1SX4HyApZitOHiLgo+It/hl8Z9bJnhyVw66NxmMQ8JYN2imb8Lhqh
 XCLR7BxLTah82AapLJuQ0ZDHPzZqMPG2veC2vAzRMYzVijict/p4Y2+qBqONltER
 4rs9uRVn+hamX33lCLg8BEN8zqlnT3rJFIgGaKjq/wXHAU/zpE9CjOrKMQcAg9+s
 t51XMNPwypHMAYyGVhEL89ImjXnXxBkLRuquhlmEpvQchIhR+mR3dLsarGn7da44
 WPIQJXzcsojXczcwwfqsJCR4I1FTFyQIW+UNh02GkDRgRovQqo+Jk762U7vQwqH+
 LBdhvVaS1VW4v+FWXEoZ
 =5dox
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'pm+acpi-3.19-rc1' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/rafael/linux-pm

Pull ACPI and power management updates from Rafael Wysocki:
 "This time we have some more new material than we used to have during
  the last couple of development cycles.

  The most important part of it to me is the introduction of a unified
  interface for accessing device properties provided by platform
  firmware.  It works with Device Trees and ACPI in a uniform way and
  drivers using it need not worry about where the properties come from
  as long as the platform firmware (either DT or ACPI) makes them
  available.  It covers both devices and "bare" device node objects
  without struct device representation as that turns out to be necessary
  in some cases.  This has been in the works for quite a few months (and
  development cycles) and has been approved by all of the relevant
  maintainers.

  On top of that, some drivers are switched over to the new interface
  (at25, leds-gpio, gpio_keys_polled) and some additional changes are
  made to the core GPIO subsystem to allow device drivers to manipulate
  GPIOs in the "canonical" way on platforms that provide GPIO
  information in their ACPI tables, but don't assign names to GPIO lines
  (in which case the driver needs to do that on the basis of what it
  knows about the device in question).  That also has been approved by
  the GPIO core maintainers and the rfkill driver is now going to use
  it.

  Second is support for hardware P-states in the intel_pstate driver.
  It uses CPUID to detect whether or not the feature is supported by the
  processor in which case it will be enabled by default.  However, it
  can be disabled entirely from the kernel command line if necessary.

  Next is support for a platform firmware interface based on ACPI
  operation regions used by the PMIC (Power Management Integrated
  Circuit) chips on the Intel Baytrail-T and Baytrail-T-CR platforms.
  That interface is used for manipulating power resources and for
  thermal management: sensor temperature reporting, trip point setting
  and so on.

  Also the ACPI core is now going to support the _DEP configuration
  information in a limited way.  Basically, _DEP it supposed to reflect
  off-the-hierarchy dependencies between devices which may be very
  indirect, like when AML for one device accesses locations in an
  operation region handled by another device's driver (usually, the
  device depended on this way is a serial bus or GPIO controller).  The
  support added this time is sufficient to make the ACPI battery driver
  work on Asus T100A, but it is general enough to be able to cover some
  other use cases in the future.

  Finally, we have a new cpufreq driver for the Loongson1B processor.

  In addition to the above, there are fixes and cleanups all over the
  place as usual and a traditional ACPICA update to a recent upstream
  release.

  As far as the fixes go, the ACPI LPSS (Low-power Subsystem) driver for
  Intel platforms should be able to handle power management of the DMA
  engine correctly, the cpufreq-dt driver should interact with the
  thermal subsystem in a better way and the ACPI backlight driver should
  handle some more corner cases, among other things.

  On top of the ACPICA update there are fixes for race conditions in the
  ACPICA's interrupt handling code which might lead to some random and
  strange looking failures on some systems.

  In the cleanups department the most visible part is the series of
  commits targeted at getting rid of the CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME configuration
  option.  That was triggered by a discussion regarding the generic
  power domains code during which we realized that trying to support
  certain combinations of PM config options was painful and not really
  worth it, because nobody would use them in production anyway.  For
  this reason, we decided to make CONFIG_PM_SLEEP select
  CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME and that lead to the conclusion that the latter
  became redundant and CONFIG_PM could be used instead of it.  The
  material here makes that replacement in a major part of the tree, but
  there will be at least one more batch of that in the second part of
  the merge window.

  Specifics:

   - Support for retrieving device properties information from ACPI _DSD
     device configuration objects and a unified device properties
     interface for device drivers (and subsystems) on top of that.  As
     stated above, this works with Device Trees and ACPI and allows
     device drivers to be written in a platform firmware (DT or ACPI)
     agnostic way.  The at25, leds-gpio and gpio_keys_polled drivers are
     now going to use this new interface and the GPIO subsystem is
     additionally modified to allow device drivers to assign names to
     GPIO resources returned by ACPI _CRS objects (in case _DSD is not
     present or does not provide the expected data).  The changes in
     this set are mostly from Mika Westerberg, Rafael J Wysocki, Aaron
     Lu, and Darren Hart with some fixes from others (Fabio Estevam,
     Geert Uytterhoeven).

   - Support for Hardware Managed Performance States (HWP) as described
     in Volume 3, section 14.4, of the Intel SDM in the intel_pstate
     driver.  CPUID is used to detect whether or not the feature is
     supported by the processor.  If supported, it will be enabled
     automatically unless the intel_pstate=no_hwp switch is present in
     the kernel command line.  From Dirk Brandewie.

   - New Intel Broadwell-H ID for intel_pstate (Dirk Brandewie).

   - Support for firmware interface based on ACPI operation regions used
     by the PMIC chips on the Intel Baytrail-T and Baytrail-T-CR
     platforms for power resource control and thermal management (Aaron
     Lu).

   - Limited support for retrieving off-the-hierarchy dependencies
     between devices from ACPI _DEP device configuration objects and
     deferred probing support for the ACPI battery driver based on the
     _DEP information to make that driver work on Asus T100A (Lan
     Tianyu).

   - New cpufreq driver for the Loongson1B processor (Kelvin Cheung).

   - ACPICA update to upstream revision 20141107 which only affects
     tools (Bob Moore).

   - Fixes for race conditions in the ACPICA's interrupt handling code
     and in the ACPI code related to system suspend and resume (Lv Zheng
     and Rafael J Wysocki).

   - ACPI core fix for an RCU-related issue in the ioremap() regions
     management code that slowed down significantly after CPUs had been
     allowed to enter idle states even if they'd had RCU callbakcs
     queued and triggered some problems in certain proprietary graphics
     driver (and elsewhere).  The fix replaces synchronize_rcu() in that
     code with synchronize_rcu_expedited() which makes the issue go
     away.  From Konstantin Khlebnikov.

   - ACPI LPSS (Low-Power Subsystem) driver fix to handle power
     management of the DMA engine included into the LPSS correctly.  The
     problem is that the DMA engine doesn't have ACPI PM support of its
     own and it simply is turned off when the last LPSS device having
     ACPI PM support goes into D3cold.  To work around that, the PM
     domain used by the ACPI LPSS driver is redesigned so at least one
     device with ACPI PM support will be on as long as the DMA engine is
     in use.  From Andy Shevchenko.

   - ACPI backlight driver fix to avoid using it on "Win8-compatible"
     systems where it doesn't work and where it was used by default by
     mistake (Aaron Lu).

   - Assorted minor ACPI core fixes and cleanups from Tomasz Nowicki,
     Sudeep Holla, Huang Rui, Hanjun Guo, Fabian Frederick, and Ashwin
     Chaugule (mostly related to the upcoming ARM64 support).

   - Intel RAPL (Running Average Power Limit) power capping driver fixes
     and improvements including new processor IDs (Jacob Pan).

   - Generic power domains modification to power up domains after
     attaching devices to them to meet the expectations of device
     drivers and bus types assuming devices to be accessible at probe
     time (Ulf Hansson).

   - Preliminary support for controlling device clocks from the generic
     power domains core code and modifications of the ARM/shmobile
     platform to use that feature (Ulf Hansson).

   - Assorted minor fixes and cleanups of the generic power domains core
     code (Ulf Hansson, Geert Uytterhoeven).

   - Assorted minor fixes and cleanups of the device clocks control code
     in the PM core (Geert Uytterhoeven, Grygorii Strashko).

   - Consolidation of device power management Kconfig options by making
     CONFIG_PM_SLEEP select CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME and removing the latter
     which is now redundant (Rafael J Wysocki and Kevin Hilman).  That
     is the first batch of the changes needed for this purpose.

   - Core device runtime power management support code cleanup related
     to the execution of callbacks (Andrzej Hajda).

   - cpuidle ARM support improvements (Lorenzo Pieralisi).

   - cpuidle cleanup related to the CPUIDLE_FLAG_TIME_VALID flag and a
     new MAINTAINERS entry for ARM Exynos cpuidle (Daniel Lezcano and
     Bartlomiej Zolnierkiewicz).

   - New cpufreq driver callback (->ready) to be executed when the
     cpufreq core is ready to use a given policy object and cpufreq-dt
     driver modification to use that callback for cooling device
     registration (Viresh Kumar).

   - cpufreq core fixes and cleanups (Viresh Kumar, Vince Hsu, James
     Geboski, Tomeu Vizoso).

   - Assorted fixes and cleanups in the cpufreq-pcc, intel_pstate,
     cpufreq-dt, pxa2xx cpufreq drivers (Lenny Szubowicz, Ethan Zhao,
     Stefan Wahren, Petr Cvek).

   - OPP (Operating Performance Points) framework modification to allow
     OPPs to be removed too and update of a few cpufreq drivers
     (cpufreq-dt, exynos5440, imx6q, cpufreq) to remove OPPs (added
     during initialization) on driver removal (Viresh Kumar).

   - Hibernation core fixes and cleanups (Tina Ruchandani and Markus
     Elfring).

   - PM Kconfig fix related to CPU power management (Pankaj Dubey).

   - cpupower tool fix (Prarit Bhargava)"

* tag 'pm+acpi-3.19-rc1' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/rafael/linux-pm: (120 commits)
  i2c-omap / PM: Drop CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME from i2c-omap.c
  dmaengine / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  tools: cpupower: fix return checks for sysfs_get_idlestate_count()
  drivers: sh / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  e1000e / igb / PM: Eliminate CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME
  MMC / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  MFD / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  misc / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  media / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  input / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  leds: leds-gpio: Fix multiple instances registration without 'label' property
  iio / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  hsi / OMAP / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  i2c-hid / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  drm / exynos / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  gpio / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  hwrandom / exynos / PM: Use CONFIG_PM in #ifdef
  block / PM: Replace CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME with CONFIG_PM
  USB / PM: Drop CONFIG_PM_RUNTIME from the USB core
  PM: Merge the SET*_RUNTIME_PM_OPS() macros
  ...
2014-12-10 21:17:00 -08:00
Alexei Starovoitov
198bf1b046 net: sock: fix access via invalid file descriptor
0day robot reported the following crash:
[   21.233581] BUG: unable to handle kernel NULL pointer dereference at 0000000000000007
[   21.234709] IP: [<ffffffff8156ebda>] sk_attach_bpf+0x39/0xc2

It's due to bpf_prog_get() returning ERR_PTR.
Check it properly.

Reported-by: Fengguang Wu <fengguang.wu@intel.com>
Fixes: 89aa075832 ("net: sock: allow eBPF programs to be attached to sockets")
Signed-off-by: Alexei Starovoitov <ast@plumgrid.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 23:34:27 -05:00
Gu Zheng
f95b414edb net: introduce helper macro for_each_cmsghdr
Introduce helper macro for_each_cmsghdr as a wrapper of the enumerating
cmsghdr from msghdr, just cleanup.

Signed-off-by: Gu Zheng <guz.fnst@cn.fujitsu.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 22:41:55 -05:00
Linus Torvalds
b6da0076ba Merge branch 'akpm' (patchbomb from Andrew)
Merge first patchbomb from Andrew Morton:
 - a few minor cifs fixes
 - dma-debug upadtes
 - ocfs2
 - slab
 - about half of MM
 - procfs
 - kernel/exit.c
 - panic.c tweaks
 - printk upates
 - lib/ updates
 - checkpatch updates
 - fs/binfmt updates
 - the drivers/rtc tree
 - nilfs
 - kmod fixes
 - more kernel/exit.c
 - various other misc tweaks and fixes

* emailed patches from Andrew Morton <akpm@linux-foundation.org>: (190 commits)
  exit: pidns: fix/update the comments in zap_pid_ns_processes()
  exit: pidns: alloc_pid() leaks pid_namespace if child_reaper is exiting
  exit: exit_notify: re-use "dead" list to autoreap current
  exit: reparent: call forget_original_parent() under tasklist_lock
  exit: reparent: avoid find_new_reaper() if no children
  exit: reparent: introduce find_alive_thread()
  exit: reparent: introduce find_child_reaper()
  exit: reparent: document the ->has_child_subreaper checks
  exit: reparent: s/while_each_thread/for_each_thread/ in find_new_reaper()
  exit: reparent: fix the cross-namespace PR_SET_CHILD_SUBREAPER reparenting
  exit: reparent: fix the dead-parent PR_SET_CHILD_SUBREAPER reparenting
  exit: proc: don't try to flush /proc/tgid/task/tgid
  exit: release_task: fix the comment about group leader accounting
  exit: wait: drop tasklist_lock before psig->c* accounting
  exit: wait: don't use zombie->real_parent
  exit: wait: cleanup the ptrace_reparented() checks
  usermodehelper: kill the kmod_thread_locker logic
  usermodehelper: don't use CLONE_VFORK for ____call_usermodehelper()
  fs/hfs/catalog.c: fix comparison bug in hfs_cat_keycmp
  nilfs2: fix the nilfs_iget() vs. nilfs_new_inode() races
  ...
2014-12-10 18:34:42 -08:00
Al Viro
bd9b51e79c make default ->i_fop have ->open() fail with ENXIO
As it is, default ->i_fop has NULL ->open() (along with all other methods).
The only case where it matters is reopening (via procfs symlink) a file that
didn't get its ->f_op from ->i_fop - anything else will have ->i_fop assigned
to something sane (default would fail on read/write/ioctl/etc.).

	Unfortunately, such case exists - alloc_file() users, especially
anon_get_file() ones.  There we have tons of opened files of very different
kinds sharing the same inode.  As the result, attempt to reopen those via
procfs succeeds and you get a descriptor you can't do anything with.

	Moreover, in case of sockets we set ->i_fop that will only be used
on such reopen attempts - and put a failing ->open() into it to make sure
those do not succeed.

	It would be simpler to put such ->open() into default ->i_fop and leave
it unchanged both for anon inode (as we do anyway) and for socket ones.  Result:
	* everything going through do_dentry_open() works as it used to
	* sock_no_open() kludge is gone
	* attempts to reopen anon-inode files fail as they really ought to
	* ditto for aio_private_file()
	* ditto for perfmon - this one actually tried to imitate sock_no_open()
trick, but failed to set ->i_fop, so in the current tree reopens succeed and
yield completely useless descriptor.  Intent clearly had been to fail with
-ENXIO on such reopens; now it actually does.
	* everything else that used alloc_file() keeps working - it has ->i_fop
set for its inodes anyway

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-10 21:32:15 -05:00
Al Viro
707c5960f1 Merge branch 'nsfs' into for-next 2014-12-10 21:31:59 -05:00
Johannes Weiner
3e32cb2e0a mm: memcontrol: lockless page counters
Memory is internally accounted in bytes, using spinlock-protected 64-bit
counters, even though the smallest accounting delta is a page.  The
counter interface is also convoluted and does too many things.

Introduce a new lockless word-sized page counter API, then change all
memory accounting over to it.  The translation from and to bytes then only
happens when interfacing with userspace.

The removed locking overhead is noticable when scaling beyond the per-cpu
charge caches - on a 4-socket machine with 144-threads, the following test
shows the performance differences of 288 memcgs concurrently running a
page fault benchmark:

vanilla:

   18631648.500498      task-clock (msec)         #  140.643 CPUs utilized            ( +-  0.33% )
         1,380,638      context-switches          #    0.074 K/sec                    ( +-  0.75% )
            24,390      cpu-migrations            #    0.001 K/sec                    ( +-  8.44% )
     1,843,305,768      page-faults               #    0.099 M/sec                    ( +-  0.00% )
50,134,994,088,218      cycles                    #    2.691 GHz                      ( +-  0.33% )
   <not supported>      stalled-cycles-frontend
   <not supported>      stalled-cycles-backend
 8,049,712,224,651      instructions              #    0.16  insns per cycle          ( +-  0.04% )
 1,586,970,584,979      branches                  #   85.176 M/sec                    ( +-  0.05% )
     1,724,989,949      branch-misses             #    0.11% of all branches          ( +-  0.48% )

     132.474343877 seconds time elapsed                                          ( +-  0.21% )

lockless:

   12195979.037525      task-clock (msec)         #  133.480 CPUs utilized            ( +-  0.18% )
           832,850      context-switches          #    0.068 K/sec                    ( +-  0.54% )
            15,624      cpu-migrations            #    0.001 K/sec                    ( +- 10.17% )
     1,843,304,774      page-faults               #    0.151 M/sec                    ( +-  0.00% )
32,811,216,801,141      cycles                    #    2.690 GHz                      ( +-  0.18% )
   <not supported>      stalled-cycles-frontend
   <not supported>      stalled-cycles-backend
 9,999,265,091,727      instructions              #    0.30  insns per cycle          ( +-  0.10% )
 2,076,759,325,203      branches                  #  170.282 M/sec                    ( +-  0.12% )
     1,656,917,214      branch-misses             #    0.08% of all branches          ( +-  0.55% )

      91.369330729 seconds time elapsed                                          ( +-  0.45% )

On top of improved scalability, this also gets rid of the icky long long
types in the very heart of memcg, which is great for 32 bit and also makes
the code a lot more readable.

Notable differences between the old and new API:

- res_counter_charge() and res_counter_charge_nofail() become
  page_counter_try_charge() and page_counter_charge() resp. to match
  the more common kernel naming scheme of try_do()/do()

- res_counter_uncharge_until() is only ever used to cancel a local
  counter and never to uncharge bigger segments of a hierarchy, so
  it's replaced by the simpler page_counter_cancel()

- res_counter_set_limit() is replaced by page_counter_limit(), which
  expects its callers to serialize against themselves

- res_counter_memparse_write_strategy() is replaced by
  page_counter_limit(), which rounds down to the nearest page size -
  rather than up.  This is more reasonable for explicitely requested
  hard upper limits.

- to keep charging light-weight, page_counter_try_charge() charges
  speculatively, only to roll back if the result exceeds the limit.
  Because of this, a failing bigger charge can temporarily lock out
  smaller charges that would otherwise succeed.  The error is bounded
  to the difference between the smallest and the biggest possible
  charge size, so for memcg, this means that a failing THP charge can
  send base page charges into reclaim upto 2MB (4MB) before the limit
  would have been reached.  This should be acceptable.

[akpm@linux-foundation.org: add includes for WARN_ON_ONCE and memparse]
[akpm@linux-foundation.org: add includes for WARN_ON_ONCE, memparse, strncmp, and PAGE_SIZE]
Signed-off-by: Johannes Weiner <hannes@cmpxchg.org>
Acked-by: Michal Hocko <mhocko@suse.cz>
Acked-by: Vladimir Davydov <vdavydov@parallels.com>
Cc: Tejun Heo <tj@kernel.org>
Cc: David Rientjes <rientjes@google.com>
Cc: Stephen Rothwell <sfr@canb.auug.org.au>
Signed-off-by: Andrew Morton <akpm@linux-foundation.org>
Signed-off-by: Linus Torvalds <torvalds@linux-foundation.org>
2014-12-10 17:41:04 -08:00
Linus Torvalds
cbfe0de303 Merge branch 'for-linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/viro/vfs
Pull VFS changes from Al Viro:
 "First pile out of several (there _definitely_ will be more).  Stuff in
  this one:

   - unification of d_splice_alias()/d_materialize_unique()

   - iov_iter rewrite

   - killing a bunch of ->f_path.dentry users (and f_dentry macro).

     Getting that completed will make life much simpler for
     unionmount/overlayfs, since then we'll be able to limit the places
     sensitive to file _dentry_ to reasonably few.  Which allows to have
     file_inode(file) pointing to inode in a covered layer, with dentry
     pointing to (negative) dentry in union one.

     Still not complete, but much closer now.

   - crapectomy in lustre (dead code removal, mostly)

   - "let's make seq_printf return nothing" preparations

   - assorted cleanups and fixes

  There _definitely_ will be more piles"

* 'for-linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/viro/vfs: (63 commits)
  copy_from_iter_nocache()
  new helper: iov_iter_kvec()
  csum_and_copy_..._iter()
  iov_iter.c: handle ITER_KVEC directly
  iov_iter.c: convert copy_to_iter() to iterate_and_advance
  iov_iter.c: convert copy_from_iter() to iterate_and_advance
  iov_iter.c: get rid of bvec_copy_page_{to,from}_iter()
  iov_iter.c: convert iov_iter_zero() to iterate_and_advance
  iov_iter.c: convert iov_iter_get_pages_alloc() to iterate_all_kinds
  iov_iter.c: convert iov_iter_get_pages() to iterate_all_kinds
  iov_iter.c: convert iov_iter_npages() to iterate_all_kinds
  iov_iter.c: iterate_and_advance
  iov_iter.c: macros for iterating over iov_iter
  kill f_dentry macro
  dcache: fix kmemcheck warning in switch_names
  new helper: audit_file()
  nfsd_vfs_write(): use file_inode()
  ncpfs: use file_inode()
  kill f_dentry uses
  lockd: get rid of ->f_path.dentry->d_sb
  ...
2014-12-10 16:10:49 -08:00
Linus Torvalds
e20db597b6 NFS client updates for Linux 3.19
Highlights include:
 
 Features:
 - NFSv4.2 client support for hole punching and preallocation.
 - Further RPC/RDMA client improvements.
 - Add more RPC transport debugging tracepoints.
 - Add RPC debugging tools in debugfs.
 
 Bugfixes:
 - Stable fix for layoutget error handling
 - Fix a change in COMMIT behaviour resulting from the recent io code updates
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 Version: GnuPG v1
 
 iQIcBAABAgAGBQJUhRVTAAoJEGcL54qWCgDyfeUP/RoFo3ImTMbGxfcPJqoELjcO
 lZbQ+27pOE/whFDkWgiOVTwlgGct5a0WRo7GCZmpYJA4q1kmSv4ngTb3nMTCUztt
 xMJ0mBr0BqttVs+ouKiVPm3cejQXedEhttwWcloIXS8lNenlpL29Zlrx2NHdU8UU
 13+souocj0dwIyTYYS/4Lm9KpuCYnpDBpP5ShvQjVaMe/GxJo6GyZu70c7FgwGNz
 Nh9onzZV3mz1elhfizlV38aVA7KWVXtLWIqOFIKlT2fa4nWB8Hc07miR5UeOK0/h
 r+icnF2qCQe83MbjOxYNxIKB6uiA/4xwVc90X4AQ7F0RX8XPWHIQWG5tlkC9jrCQ
 3RGzYshWDc9Ud2mXtLMyVQxHVVYlFAe1WtdP8ZWb1oxDInmhrarnWeNyECz9xGKu
 VzIDZzeq9G8slJXATWGRfPsYr+Ihpzcen4QQw58cakUBcqEJrYEhlEOfLovM71k3
 /S/jSHBAbQqiw4LPMw87bA5A6+ZKcVSsNE0XCtNnhmqFpLc1kKRrl5vaN+QMk5tJ
 v4/zR0fPqH7SGAJWYs4brdfahyejEo0TwgpDs7KHmu1W9zQ0LCVTaYnQuUmQjta6
 WyYwIy3TTibdfR191O0E3NOW82Q/k/NBD6ySvabN9HqQ9eSk6+rzrWAslXCbYohb
 BJfzcQfDdx+lsyhjeTx9
 =wOP3
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'nfs-for-3.19-1' of git://git.linux-nfs.org/projects/trondmy/linux-nfs

Pull NFS client updates from Trond Myklebust:
 "Highlights include:

  Features:
   - NFSv4.2 client support for hole punching and preallocation.
   - Further RPC/RDMA client improvements.
   - Add more RPC transport debugging tracepoints.
   - Add RPC debugging tools in debugfs.

  Bugfixes:
   - Stable fix for layoutget error handling
   - Fix a change in COMMIT behaviour resulting from the recent io code
     updates"

* tag 'nfs-for-3.19-1' of git://git.linux-nfs.org/projects/trondmy/linux-nfs: (28 commits)
  sunrpc: add a debugfs rpc_xprt directory with an info file in it
  sunrpc: add debugfs file for displaying client rpc_task queue
  nfs: Add DEALLOCATE support
  nfs: Add ALLOCATE support
  NFS: Clean up nfs4_init_callback()
  NFS: SETCLIENTID XDR buffer sizes are incorrect
  SUNRPC: serialize iostats updates
  xprtrdma: Display async errors
  xprtrdma: Enable pad optimization
  xprtrdma: Re-write rpcrdma_flush_cqs()
  xprtrdma: Refactor tasklet scheduling
  xprtrdma: unmap all FMRs during transport disconnect
  xprtrdma: Cap req_cqinit
  xprtrdma: Return an errno from rpcrdma_register_external()
  nfs: define nfs_inc_fscache_stats and using it as possible
  nfs: replace nfs_add_stats with nfs_inc_stats when add one
  NFS: Deletion of unnecessary checks before the function call "nfs_put_client"
  sunrpc: eliminate RPC_TRACEPOINTS
  sunrpc: eliminate RPC_DEBUG
  lockd: eliminate LOCKD_DEBUG
  ...
2014-12-10 15:13:13 -08:00
David S. Miller
22f10923dd Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net
Conflicts:
	drivers/net/ethernet/amd/xgbe/xgbe-desc.c
	drivers/net/ethernet/renesas/sh_eth.c

Overlapping changes in both conflict cases.

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 15:48:20 -05:00
Joe Perches
785c20a08b irda: Convert function pointer arrays and uses to const
Making things const is a good thing.

(x86-64 defconfig with all irda)
$ size net/irda/built-in.o*
   text	   data	    bss	    dec	    hex	filename
 109276	   1868	    244	 111388	  1b31c	net/irda/built-in.o.new
 108828	   2316	    244	 111388	  1b31c	net/irda/built-in.o.old

Signed-off-by: Joe Perches <joe@perches.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 15:33:16 -05:00
Joe Perches
22bbf5f3e4 llc: Make llc_sap_action_t function pointer arrays const
It's better when function pointer arrays aren't modifiable.

Net change:

$ size net/llc/built-in.o.*
   text	   data	    bss	    dec	    hex	filename
  61193	  12758	   1344	  75295	  1261f	net/llc/built-in.o.new
  47113	  27030	   1344	  75487	  126df	net/llc/built-in.o.old

Signed-off-by: Joe Perches <joe@perches.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 15:21:24 -05:00
Joe Perches
9b37306935 llc: Make llc_conn_ev_qfyr_t function pointer arrays const
It's better when function pointer arrays aren't modifiable.

Net change from original:

$ size net/llc/built-in.o.*
   text	   data	    bss	    dec	    hex	filename
  61065	  12886	   1344	  75295	  1261f	net/llc/built-in.o.new
  47113	  27030	   1344	  75487	  126df	net/llc/built-in.o.old

Signed-off-by: Joe Perches <joe@perches.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 15:21:24 -05:00
Joe Perches
14b7d95fd2 llc: Make function pointer arrays const
It's better when function pointer arrays aren't modifiable.

Signed-off-by: Joe Perches <joe@perches.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 15:21:24 -05:00
Daniel Borkmann
87545899b5 net: replace remaining users of arch_fast_hash with jhash
This patch effectively reverts commit 500f808726 ("net: ovs: use CRC32
accelerated flow hash if available"), and other remaining arch_fast_hash()
users such as from nfsd via commit 6282cd5655 ("NFSD: Don't hand out
delegations for 30 seconds after recalling them.") where it has been used
as a hash function for bloom filtering.

While we think that these users are actually not much of concern, it has
been requested to remove the arch_fast_hash() library bits that arose
from [1] entirely as per recent discussion [2]. The main argument is that
using it as a hash may introduce bias due to its linearity (see avalanche
criterion) and thus makes it less clear (though we tried to document that)
when this security/performance trade-off is actually acceptable for a
general purpose library function.

Lets therefore avoid any further confusion on this matter and remove it to
prevent any future accidental misuse of it. For the time being, this is
going to make hashing of flow keys a bit more expensive in the ovs case,
but future work could reevaluate a different hashing discipline.

  [1] https://patchwork.ozlabs.org/patch/299369/
  [2] https://patchwork.ozlabs.org/patch/418756/

Cc: Neil Brown <neilb@suse.de>
Cc: Francesco Fusco <fusco@ntop.org>
Cc: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Cc: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 15:17:45 -05:00
Daniel Borkmann
7f19fc5e0b netlink: use jhash as hashfn for rhashtable
For netlink, we shouldn't be using arch_fast_hash() as a hashing
discipline, but rather jhash() instead.

Since netlink sockets can be opened by any user, a local attacker
would be able to easily create collisions with the DPDK-derived
arch_fast_hash(), which trades off performance for security by
using crc32 CPU instructions on x86_64.

While it might have a legimite use case in other places, it should
be avoided in netlink context, though. As rhashtable's API is very
flexible, we could later on still decide on other hashing disciplines,
if legitimate.

Reference: http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.linux.kernel/1844123
Fixes: e341694e3e ("netlink: Convert netlink_lookup() to use RCU protected hash table")
Cc: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>
Signed-off-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Acked-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Acked-by: Hannes Frederic Sowa <hannes@stressinduktion.org>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 15:17:45 -05:00
Richard Alpe
340b6e59fb tipc: fix broadcast wakeup contention after congestion
commit 908344cdda ("tipc: fix bug in multicast congestion handling")
introduced a race in the broadcast link wakeup functionality.

This patch eliminates this broadcast link wakeup race caused by
operation on the wakeup list without proper locking. If this race
hit and corrupted the list all subsequent wakeup messages would be
lost, resulting in a considerable memory leak.

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 14:45:33 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
fd11a83dd3 net: Pull out core bits of __netdev_alloc_skb and add __napi_alloc_skb
This change pulls the core functionality out of __netdev_alloc_skb and
places them in a new function named __alloc_rx_skb.  The reason for doing
this is to make these bits accessible to a new function __napi_alloc_skb.
In addition __alloc_rx_skb now has a new flags value that is used to
determine which page frag pool to allocate from.  If the SKB_ALLOC_NAPI
flag is set then the NAPI pool is used.  The advantage of this is that we
do not have to use local_irq_save/restore when accessing the NAPI pool from
NAPI context.

In my test setup I saw at least 11ns of savings using the napi_alloc_skb
function versus the netdev_alloc_skb function, most of this being due to
the fact that we didn't have to call local_irq_save/restore.

The main use case for napi_alloc_skb would be for things such as copybreak
or page fragment based receive paths where an skb is allocated after the
data has been received instead of before.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 13:31:57 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
ffde7328a3 net: Split netdev_alloc_frag into __alloc_page_frag and add __napi_alloc_frag
This patch splits the netdev_alloc_frag function up so that it can be used
on one of two page frag pools instead of being fixed on the
netdev_alloc_cache.  By doing this we can add a NAPI specific function
__napi_alloc_frag that accesses a pool that is only used from softirq
context.  The advantage to this is that we do not need to call
local_irq_save/restore which can be a significant savings.

I also took the opportunity to refactor the core bits that were placed in
__alloc_page_frag.  First I updated the allocation to do either a 32K
allocation or an order 0 page.  This is based on the changes in commmit
d9b2938aa where it was found that latencies could be reduced in case of
failures.  Then I also rewrote the logic to work from the end of the page to
the start.  By doing this the size value doesn't have to be used unless we
have run out of space for page fragments.  Finally I cleaned up the atomic
bits so that we just do an atomic_sub_and_test and if that returns true then
we set the page->_count via an atomic_set.  This way we can remove the extra
conditional for the atomic_read since it would have led to an atomic_inc in
the case of success anyway.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Acked-by: Alexei Starovoitov <ast@plumgrid.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 13:31:57 -05:00
David S. Miller
6e5f59aacb Merge branch 'for-davem-2' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/viro/vfs
More iov_iter work for the networking from Al Viro.

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-10 13:17:23 -05:00
Dan Carpenter
3b05ac3824 ipvs: uninitialized data with IP_VS_IPV6
The app_tcp_pkt_out() function expects "*diff" to be set and ends up
using uninitialized data if CONFIG_IP_VS_IPV6 is turned on.

The same issue is there in app_tcp_pkt_in().  Thanks to Julian Anastasov
for noticing that.

Signed-off-by: Dan Carpenter <dan.carpenter@oracle.com>
Acked-by: Julian Anastasov <ja@ssi.bg>
Signed-off-by: Simon Horman <horms@verge.net.au>
2014-12-10 17:36:47 +09:00
Linus Torvalds
86c6a2fddf Merge branch 'sched-core-for-linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/tip/tip
Pull scheduler updates from Ingo Molnar:
 "The main changes in this cycle are:

   - 'Nested Sleep Debugging', activated when CONFIG_DEBUG_ATOMIC_SLEEP=y.

     This instruments might_sleep() checks to catch places that nest
     blocking primitives - such as mutex usage in a wait loop.  Such
     bugs can result in hard to debug races/hangs.

     Another category of invalid nesting that this facility will detect
     is the calling of blocking functions from within schedule() ->
     sched_submit_work() -> blk_schedule_flush_plug().

     There's some potential for false positives (if secondary blocking
     primitives themselves are not ready yet for this facility), but the
     kernel will warn once about such bugs per bootup, so the warning
     isn't much of a nuisance.

     This feature comes with a number of fixes, for problems uncovered
     with it, so no messages are expected normally.

   - Another round of sched/numa optimizations and refinements, for
     CONFIG_NUMA_BALANCING=y.

   - Another round of sched/dl fixes and refinements.

  Plus various smaller fixes and cleanups"

* 'sched-core-for-linus' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/tip/tip: (54 commits)
  sched: Add missing rcu protection to wake_up_all_idle_cpus
  sched/deadline: Introduce start_hrtick_dl() for !CONFIG_SCHED_HRTICK
  sched/numa: Init numa balancing fields of init_task
  sched/deadline: Remove unnecessary definitions in cpudeadline.h
  sched/cpupri: Remove unnecessary definitions in cpupri.h
  sched/deadline: Fix rq->dl.pushable_tasks bug in push_dl_task()
  sched/fair: Fix stale overloaded status in the busiest group finding logic
  sched: Move p->nr_cpus_allowed check to select_task_rq()
  sched/completion: Document when to use wait_for_completion_io_*()
  sched: Update comments about CLONE_NEWUTS and CLONE_NEWIPC
  sched/fair: Kill task_struct::numa_entry and numa_group::task_list
  sched: Refactor task_struct to use numa_faults instead of numa_* pointers
  sched/deadline: Don't check CONFIG_SMP in switched_from_dl()
  sched/deadline: Reschedule from switched_from_dl() after a successful pull
  sched/deadline: Push task away if the deadline is equal to curr during wakeup
  sched/deadline: Add deadline rq status print
  sched/deadline: Fix artificial overrun introduced by yield_task_dl()
  sched/rt: Clean up check_preempt_equal_prio()
  sched/core: Use dl_bw_of() under rcu_read_lock_sched()
  sched: Check if we got a shallowest_idle_cpu before searching for least_loaded_cpu
  ...
2014-12-09 21:21:34 -08:00
Jiri Pirko
6ea3b446b9 net: sched: cls: use nla_nest_cancel instead of nlmsg_trim
To cancel nesting, this function is more convenient.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 21:49:58 -05:00
Valdis.Kletnieks@vt.edu
69204cf7eb net: fix suspicious rcu_dereference_check in net/sched/sch_fq_codel.c
commit 46e5da40ae (net: qdisc: use rcu prefix and silence
 sparse warnings) triggers a spurious warning:

net/sched/sch_fq_codel.c:97 suspicious rcu_dereference_check() usage!

The code should be using the _bh variant of rcu_dereference.

Signed-off-by: Valdis Kletnieks <valdis.kletnieks@vt.edu>
Acked-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Acked-by: John Fastabend <john.r.fastabend@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 21:49:09 -05:00
Eric Dumazet
0f85feae6b tcp: fix more NULL deref after prequeue changes
When I cooked commit c3658e8d0f ("tcp: fix possible NULL dereference in
tcp_vX_send_reset()") I missed other spots we could deref a NULL
skb_dst(skb)

Again, if a socket is provided, we do not need skb_dst() to get a
pointer to network namespace : sock_net(sk) is good enough.

Reported-by: Dann Frazier <dann.frazier@canonical.com>
Bisected-by: Dann Frazier <dann.frazier@canonical.com>
Tested-by: Dann Frazier <dann.frazier@canonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Fixes: ca777eff51 ("tcp: remove dst refcount false sharing for prequeue mode")
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 21:38:44 -05:00
Ying Xue
023160bc8f tipc: avoid double lock 'spin_lock:&seq->lock'
The commit fb9962f3ce ("tipc: ensure all name sequences are properly
protected with its lock") involves below errors:

net/tipc/name_table.c:980 tipc_purge_publications() error: double lock 'spin_lock:&seq->lock'

Reported-by: Dan Carpenter <dan.carpenter@oracle.com>
Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 18:27:03 -05:00
Roopa Prabhu
1d460b988d rocker: remove swdev mode
Remove use of 'swdev' mode in rocker. rocker dev offloads
can use the BRIDGE_FLAGS_SELF to indicate offload to hardware.

Signed-off-by: Roopa Prabhu <roopa@cumulusnetworks.com>
Signed-off-by: Scott Feldman <sfeldma@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 18:24:47 -05:00
David S. Miller
b5f185f33d Merge tag 'master-2014-12-08' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/linville/wireless-next
John W. Linville says:

====================
pull request: wireless-next 2014-12-08

Please pull this last batch of pending wireless updates for the 3.19 tree...

For the wireless bits, Johannes says:

"This time I have Felix's no-status rate control work, which will allow
drivers to work better with rate control even if they don't have perfect
status reporting. In addition to this, a small hwsim fix from Patrik,
one of the regulatory patches from Arik, and a number of cleanups and
fixes I did myself.

Of note is a patch where I disable CFG80211_WEXT so that compatibility
is no longer selectable - this is intended as a wake-up call for anyone
who's still using it, and is still easily worked around (it's a one-line
patch) before we fully remove the code as well in the future."

For the Bluetooth bits, Johan says:

"Here's one more bluetooth-next pull request for 3.19:

 - Minor cleanups for ieee802154 & mac802154
 - Fix for the kernel warning with !TASK_RUNNING reported by Kirill A.
   Shutemov
 - Support for another ath3k device
 - Fix for tracking link key based security level
 - Device tree bindings for btmrvl + a state update fix
 - Fix for wrong ACL flags on LE links"

And...

"In addition to the previous one this contains two more cleanups to
mac802154 as well as support for some new HCI features from the
Bluetooth 4.2 specification.

From the original request:

'Here's what should be the last bluetooth-next pull request for 3.19.
It's rather large but the majority of it is the Low Energy Secure
Connections feature that's part of the Bluetooth 4.2 specification. The
specification went public only this week so we couldn't publish the
corresponding code before that. The code itself can nevertheless be
considered fairly mature as it's been in development for over 6 months
and gone through several interoperability test events.

Besides LE SC the pull request contains an important fix for command
complete events for mgmt sockets which also fixes some leaks of hci_conn
objects when powering off or unplugging Bluetooth adapters.

A smaller feature that's part of the pull request is service discovery
support. This is like normal device discovery except that devices not
matching specific UUIDs or strong enough RSSI are filtered out.

Other changes that the pull request contains are firmware dump support
to the btmrvl driver, firmware download support for Broadcom BCM20702A0
variants, as well as some coding style cleanups in 6lowpan &
ieee802154/mac802154 code.'"

For the NFC bits, Samuel says:

"With this one we get:

- NFC digital improvements for DEP support: Chaining, NACK and ATN
  support added.

- NCI improvements: Support for p2p target, SE IO operand addition,
  SE operands extensions to support proprietary implementations, and
  a few fixes.

- NFC HCI improvements: OPEN_PIPE and NOTIFY_ALL_CLEARED support,
  and SE IO operand addition.

- A bunch of minor improvements and fixes for STMicro st21nfcb and
  st21nfca"

For the iwlwifi bits, Emmanuel says:

"Major works are CSA and TDLS. On top of that I have a new
firmware API for scan and a few rate control improvements.
Johannes find a few tricks to improve our CPU utilization
and adds support for a new spin of 7265 called 7265D.
Along with this a few random things that don't stand out."

And...

"I deprecate here -8.ucode since -9 has been published long ago.
Along with that I have a new activity, we have now better
a infrastructure for firmware debugging. This will allow to
have configurable probes insides the firmware.
Luca continues his work on NetDetect, this feature is now
complete. All the rest is minor fixes here and there."

For the Atheros bits, Kalle says:

"Only ath10k changes this time and no major changes. Most visible are:

o new debugfs interface for runtime firmware debugging (Yanbo)

o fix shared WEP (Sujith)

o don't rebuild whenever kernel version changes (Johannes)

o lots of refactoring to make it easier to add new hw support (Michal)

There's also smaller fixes and improvements with no point of listing
here."

In addition, there are a few last minute updates to ath5k,
ath9k, brcmfmac, brcmsmac, mwifiex, rt2x00, rtlwifi, and wil6210.
Also included is a pull of the wireless tree to pick-up the fixes
originally included in "pull request: wireless 2014-12-03"...

Please let me know if there are problems!
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 18:12:03 -05:00
Li RongQing
e008f3f07f net: avoid to call skb_queue_len again
the queue length of sd->input_pkt_queue has been put into qlen,
and impossible to change, since hold the lock

Signed-off-by: Li RongQing <roy.qing.li@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Cc: Sergei Shtylyov <sergei.shtylyov@cogentembedded.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 17:03:19 -05:00
David S. Miller
602de7ead5 linux-can-next-for-3.19-20141207
-----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 Version: GnuPG v1
 
 iQIcBAABAgAGBQJUhNqoAAoJECte4hHFiupU57IP/1ioNl+EkM8ZXCH+pZCsMuoF
 S33lLQjJ2WEh2WZXDEJqGWdv7FRh5dUyRB67TpMCzQa8lsyPykapFAy4s1DEEZ46
 EbsRHjkJdw+fg3dRGp33XPD55t2xXz9CYB7OuVGLjBEWdFb5a2by+JYCctTynqum
 xI+qGo6IKcAvlyYAmiopZ+FOBUMhRo30GkkzVnoIsQn+Z1HYEdJ+QGryL1rOY01D
 Gt4d+hZ6bT08yy+4ZB3Sr6/H3w4e8saUCS8H+JyLVYR+quM0T/uV4drqk/21kUNU
 954LPu5GY5l6gYDEaki96Rc6DpuqsWlgy7oh1E3p9XN0vZFPEjmFXkic28hHpvKm
 nDThB9qllwYUu9hmALaMuxkbRmJK/NvFwlzdtp0uZIiiENGGQrD368wiWxyzD3aP
 HvthWTNM2E+T15gmmzUNnGPbaTWgxjp4G4wEucX/yLiZDTu0ftoFBvnRy3emWhI0
 3N1Lf3ZBGYuHQvyUMWMgQ53nwuPuDgcVy/wYEUu11rI4zFcP7OmrznPhtnwfwQmz
 lMppDC0d3L0PGjI4/oKXJAXrCuAVldv+eLFOpHaJuXU+VuglEOpetjUDMv2A0hbQ
 23HcX+rIRd+8M8H+RtAYrqmocAOw70/cy0NzuLfI8a7kOW9H55dHADx4IFTae2E+
 X1dBTj1EHrIlyw6lkC9e
 =icE1
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'linux-can-next-for-3.19-20141207' of git://gitorious.org/linux-can/linux-can-next

Marc Kleine-Budde says:

====================
pull-request: can-next 2014-12-07

this is a pull request of 8 patches for net-next/master.

Andri Yngvason contributes 4 patches in which the CAN state change
handling is consolidated and unified among the sja1000, mscan and
flexcan driver. The three patches by Jeremiah Mahler fix spelling
mistakes and eliminate the banner[] variable in various parts. And a
patch by me that switches on sparse endianess checking by default.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 16:49:00 -05:00
Eric Dumazet
605ad7f184 tcp: refine TSO autosizing
Commit 95bd09eb27 ("tcp: TSO packets automatic sizing") tried to
control TSO size, but did this at the wrong place (sendmsg() time)

At sendmsg() time, we might have a pessimistic view of flow rate,
and we end up building very small skbs (with 2 MSS per skb).

This is bad because :

 - It sends small TSO packets even in Slow Start where rate quickly
   increases.
 - It tends to make socket write queue very big, increasing tcp_ack()
   processing time, but also increasing memory needs, not necessarily
   accounted for, as fast clones overhead is currently ignored.
 - Lower GRO efficiency and more ACK packets.

Servers with a lot of small lived connections suffer from this.

Lets instead fill skbs as much as possible (64KB of payload), but split
them at xmit time, when we have a precise idea of the flow rate.
skb split is actually quite efficient.

Patch looks bigger than necessary, because TCP Small Queue decision now
has to take place after the eventual split.

As Neal suggested, introduce a new tcp_tso_autosize() helper, so that
tcp_tso_should_defer() can be synchronized on same goal.

Rename tp->xmit_size_goal_segs to tp->gso_segs, as this variable
contains number of mss that we can put in GSO packet, and is not
related to the autosizing goal anymore.

Tested:

40 ms rtt link

nstat >/dev/null
netperf -H remote -l -2000000 -- -s 1000000
nstat | egrep "IpInReceives|IpOutRequests|TcpOutSegs|IpExtOutOctets"

Before patch :

Recv   Send    Send
Socket Socket  Message  Elapsed
Size   Size    Size     Time     Throughput
bytes  bytes   bytes    secs.    10^6bits/s

 87380 2000000 2000000    0.36         44.22
IpInReceives                    600                0.0
IpOutRequests                   599                0.0
TcpOutSegs                      1397               0.0
IpExtOutOctets                  2033249            0.0

After patch :

Recv   Send    Send
Socket Socket  Message  Elapsed
Size   Size    Size     Time     Throughput
bytes  bytes   bytes    secs.    10^6bits/sec

 87380 2000000 2000000    0.36       44.27
IpInReceives                    221                0.0
IpOutRequests                   232                0.0
TcpOutSegs                      1397               0.0
IpExtOutOctets                  2013953            0.0

Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Signed-off-by: Neal Cardwell <ncardwell@google.com>
Acked-by: Yuchung Cheng <ycheng@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 16:39:22 -05:00
Al Viro
d3a9632f09 skb_copy_datagram_iovec() can die
no callers other than itself.

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-09 16:29:11 -05:00
Al Viro
e5a4b0bb80 switch memcpy_to_msg() and skb_copy{,_and_csum}_datagram_msg() to primitives
... making both non-draining.  That means that tcp_recvmsg() becomes
non-draining.  And _that_ would break iscsit_do_rx_data() unless we
	a) make sure tcp_recvmsg() is uniformly non-draining (it is)
	b) make sure it copes with arbitrary (including shifted)
iov_iter (it does, all it uses is iov_iter primitives)
	c) make iscsit_do_rx_data() initialize ->msg_iter only once.

Fortunately, (c) is doable with minimal work and we are rid of one
the two places where kernel send/recvmsg users would be unhappy with
non-draining behaviour.

Actually, that makes all but one of ->recvmsg() instances iov_iter-clean.
The exception is skcipher_recvmsg() and it also isn't hard to convert
to primitives (iov_iter_get_pages() is needed there).  That'll wait
a bit - there's some interplay with ->sendmsg() path for that one.

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-09 16:29:10 -05:00
Al Viro
17836394e5 first fruits - kill l2cap ->memcpy_fromiovec()
Just use copy_from_iter().  That's what this method is trying to do
in all cases, in a very convoluted fashion.

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-09 16:29:10 -05:00
Al Viro
c0371da604 put iov_iter into msghdr
Note that the code _using_ ->msg_iter at that point will be very
unhappy with anything other than unshifted iovec-backed iov_iter.
We still need to convert users to proper primitives.

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-09 16:29:03 -05:00
Al Viro
d838df2e5d vmci: propagate msghdr all way down to __qp_memcpy_from_queue()
... and switch it to memcpy_to_msg()

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-09 16:28:23 -05:00
Al Viro
56c39fb67c switch l2cap ->memcpy_fromiovec() to msghdr
it'll die soon enough - now that kvec-backed iov_iter works regardless
of set_fs(), both instances will become copy_from_iter() as soon as
we introduce ->msg_iter...

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-09 16:28:23 -05:00
Al Viro
f4362a2c95 switch tcp_sock->ucopy from iovec (ucopy.iov) to msghdr (ucopy.msg)
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-09 16:28:22 -05:00
Al Viro
f69e6d131f ip_generic_getfrag, udplite_getfrag: switch to passing msghdr
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-09 16:28:22 -05:00
Al Viro
19e3c66b52 ipv6 equivalent of "ipv4: Avoid reading user iov twice after raw_probe_proto_opt"
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-09 16:28:21 -05:00
Al Viro
b61e9dcc5e raw.c: stick msghdr into raw_frag_vec
we'll want access to ->msg_iter

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-09 16:28:21 -05:00
Hannes Frederic Sowa
dbfc4fb7d5 dst: no need to take reference on DST_NOCACHE dsts
Since commit f886497212 ("ipv4: fix dst race in sk_dst_get()")
DST_NOCACHE dst_entries get freed by RCU. So there is no need to get a
reference on them when we are in rcu protected sections.

Cc: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Cc: Julian Anastasov <ja@ssi.bg>
Signed-off-by: Hannes Frederic Sowa <hannes@stressinduktion.org>
Reviewed-by: Julian Anastasov <ja@ssi.bg>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 16:08:17 -05:00
Jiri Benc
d2b2a13245 openvswitch: set correct protocol on route lookup
Respect what the caller passed to ovs_tunnel_get_egress_info.

Fixes: 8f0aad6f35 ("openvswitch: Extend packet attribute for egress tunnel info")
Signed-off-by: Jiri Benc <jbenc@redhat.com>
Acked-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 16:01:21 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
bd42b78860 net: sched: cls_basic: fix error path in basic_change()
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Reviewed-by: John Fastabend <john.r.fastabend@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 15:41:56 -05:00
Gu Zheng
0cf00c6f36 net/socket.c : introduce helper function do_sock_sendmsg to replace reduplicate code
Introduce helper function do_sock_sendmsg() to simplify sock_sendmsg{_nosec},
and replace reduplicate code.

Signed-off-by: Gu Zheng <guz.fnst@cn.fujitsu.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 15:24:26 -05:00
Eric Dumazet
42eef7a0bb tcp_cubic: refine Hystart delay threshold
In commit 2b4636a5f8 ("tcp_cubic: make the delay threshold of HyStart
less sensitive"), HYSTART_DELAY_MIN was changed to 4 ms.

The remaining problem is that using delay_min + (delay_min/16) as the
threshold is too sensitive.

6.25 % of variation is too small for rtt above 60 ms, which are not
uncommon.

Lets use 12.5 % instead (delay_min + (delay_min/8))

Tested:
 80 ms RTT between peers, FQ/pacing packet scheduler on sender.
 10 bulk transfers of 10 seconds :

nstat >/dev/null
for i in `seq 1 10`
 do
   netperf -H remote -- -k THROUGHPUT | grep THROUGHPUT
 done
nstat | grep Hystart

With the 6.25 % threshold :

THROUGHPUT=20.66
THROUGHPUT=249.38
THROUGHPUT=254.10
THROUGHPUT=14.94
THROUGHPUT=251.92
THROUGHPUT=237.73
THROUGHPUT=19.18
THROUGHPUT=252.89
THROUGHPUT=21.32
THROUGHPUT=15.58
TcpExtTCPHystartTrainDetect     2                  0.0
TcpExtTCPHystartTrainCwnd       4756               0.0
TcpExtTCPHystartDelayDetect     5                  0.0
TcpExtTCPHystartDelayCwnd       180                0.0

With the 12.5 % threshold
THROUGHPUT=251.09
THROUGHPUT=247.46
THROUGHPUT=250.92
THROUGHPUT=248.91
THROUGHPUT=250.88
THROUGHPUT=249.84
THROUGHPUT=250.51
THROUGHPUT=254.15
THROUGHPUT=250.62
THROUGHPUT=250.89
TcpExtTCPHystartTrainDetect     1                  0.0
TcpExtTCPHystartTrainCwnd       3175               0.0

Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Acked-by: Neal Cardwell <ncardwell@google.com>
Tested-by: Neal Cardwell <ncardwell@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 14:58:23 -05:00
Eric Dumazet
6e3a8a937c tcp_cubic: add SNMP counters to track how effective is Hystart
When deploying FQ pacing, one thing we noticed is that CUBIC Hystart
triggers too soon.

Having SNMP counters to have an idea of how often the various Hystart
methods trigger is useful prior to any modifications.

This patch adds SNMP counters tracking, how many time "ack train" or
"Delay" based Hystart triggers, and cumulative sum of cwnd at the time
Hystart decided to end SS (Slow Start)

myhost:~# nstat -a | grep Hystart
TcpExtTCPHystartTrainDetect     9                  0.0
TcpExtTCPHystartTrainCwnd       20650              0.0
TcpExtTCPHystartDelayDetect     10                 0.0
TcpExtTCPHystartDelayCwnd       360                0.0

->
 Train detection was triggered 9 times, and average cwnd was
 20650/9=2294,
 Delay detection was triggered 10 times and average cwnd was 36

Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Acked-by: Neal Cardwell <ncardwell@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 14:58:23 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
57d743a3de net: sched: cls: remove unused op put from tcf_proto_ops
It is never called and implementations are void. So just remove it.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Signed-off-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 14:49:02 -05:00
Erik Hugne
4988bb4a3f tipc: fix missing spinlock init and nullptr oops
commit 908344cdda ("tipc: fix bug in multicast congestion
handling") introduced two bugs with the bclink wakeup
function. This commit fixes the missing spinlock init for the
waiting_sks list. We also eliminate the race condition
between the waiting_sks length check/dequeue operations in
tipc_bclink_wakeup_users by simply removing the redundant
length check.

Signed-off-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Tero Aho <Tero.Aho@coriant.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 13:41:54 -05:00
Eric Dumazet
6ffe75eb53 net: avoid two atomic operations in fast clones
Commit ce1a4ea3f1 ("net: avoid one atomic operation in skb_clone()")
took the wrong way to save one atomic operation.

It is actually possible to avoid two atomic operations, if we
do not change skb->fclone values, and only rely on clone_ref
content to signal if the clone is available or not.

skb_clone() can simply use the fast clone if clone_ref is 1.

kfree_skbmem() can avoid the atomic_dec_and_test() if clone_ref is 1.

Note that because we usually free the clone before the original skb,
this particular attempt is only done for the original skb to have better
branch prediction.

SKB_FCLONE_FREE is removed.

Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Cc: Chris Mason <clm@fb.com>
Cc: Sabrina Dubroca <sd@queasysnail.net>
Cc: Vijay Subramanian <subramanian.vijay@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 13:40:20 -05:00
Andrew Shewmaker
5d330cddb9 Update old iproute2 and Xen Remus links
Signed-off-by: Andrew Shewmaker <agshew@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Stephen Hemminger <stephen@networkplumber.org>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 13:38:13 -05:00
Mahesh Bandewar
395eea6ccf rtnetlink: delay RTM_DELLINK notification until after ndo_uninit()
The commit 56bfa7ee7c ("unregister_netdevice : move RTM_DELLINK to
until after ndo_uninit") tried to do this ealier but while doing so
it created a problem. Unfortunately the delayed rtmsg_ifinfo() also
delayed call to fill_info(). So this translated into asking driver
to remove private state and then query it's private state. This
could have catastropic consequences.

This change breaks the rtmsg_ifinfo() into two parts - one takes the
precise snapshot of the device by called fill_info() before calling
the ndo_uninit() and the second part sends the notification using
collected snapshot.

It was brought to notice when last link is deleted from an ipvlan device
when it has free-ed the port and the subsequent .fill_info() call is
trying to get the info from the port.

kernel: [  255.139429] ------------[ cut here ]------------
kernel: [  255.139439] WARNING: CPU: 12 PID: 11173 at net/core/rtnetlink.c:2238 rtmsg_ifinfo+0x100/0x110()
kernel: [  255.139493] Modules linked in: ipvlan bonding w1_therm ds2482 wire cdc_acm ehci_pci ehci_hcd i2c_dev i2c_i801 i2c_core msr cpuid bnx2x ptp pps_core mdio libcrc32c
kernel: [  255.139513] CPU: 12 PID: 11173 Comm: ip Not tainted 3.18.0-smp-DEV #167
kernel: [  255.139514] Hardware name: Intel RML,PCH/Ibis_QC_18, BIOS 1.0.10 05/15/2012
kernel: [  255.139515]  0000000000000009 ffff880851b6b828 ffffffff815d87f4 00000000000000e0
kernel: [  255.139516]  0000000000000000 ffff880851b6b868 ffffffff8109c29c 0000000000000000
kernel: [  255.139518]  00000000ffffffa6 00000000000000d0 ffffffff81aaf580 0000000000000011
kernel: [  255.139520] Call Trace:
kernel: [  255.139527]  [<ffffffff815d87f4>] dump_stack+0x46/0x58
kernel: [  255.139531]  [<ffffffff8109c29c>] warn_slowpath_common+0x8c/0xc0
kernel: [  255.139540]  [<ffffffff8109c2ea>] warn_slowpath_null+0x1a/0x20
kernel: [  255.139544]  [<ffffffff8150d570>] rtmsg_ifinfo+0x100/0x110
kernel: [  255.139547]  [<ffffffff814f78b5>] rollback_registered_many+0x1d5/0x2d0
kernel: [  255.139549]  [<ffffffff814f79cf>] unregister_netdevice_many+0x1f/0xb0
kernel: [  255.139551]  [<ffffffff8150acab>] rtnl_dellink+0xbb/0x110
kernel: [  255.139553]  [<ffffffff8150da90>] rtnetlink_rcv_msg+0xa0/0x240
kernel: [  255.139557]  [<ffffffff81329283>] ? rhashtable_lookup_compare+0x43/0x80
kernel: [  255.139558]  [<ffffffff8150d9f0>] ? __rtnl_unlock+0x20/0x20
kernel: [  255.139562]  [<ffffffff8152cb11>] netlink_rcv_skb+0xb1/0xc0
kernel: [  255.139563]  [<ffffffff8150a495>] rtnetlink_rcv+0x25/0x40
kernel: [  255.139565]  [<ffffffff8152c398>] netlink_unicast+0x178/0x230
kernel: [  255.139567]  [<ffffffff8152c75f>] netlink_sendmsg+0x30f/0x420
kernel: [  255.139571]  [<ffffffff814e0b0c>] sock_sendmsg+0x9c/0xd0
kernel: [  255.139575]  [<ffffffff811d1d7f>] ? rw_copy_check_uvector+0x6f/0x130
kernel: [  255.139577]  [<ffffffff814e11c9>] ? copy_msghdr_from_user+0x139/0x1b0
kernel: [  255.139578]  [<ffffffff814e1774>] ___sys_sendmsg+0x304/0x310
kernel: [  255.139581]  [<ffffffff81198723>] ? handle_mm_fault+0xca3/0xde0
kernel: [  255.139585]  [<ffffffff811ebc4c>] ? destroy_inode+0x3c/0x70
kernel: [  255.139589]  [<ffffffff8108e6ec>] ? __do_page_fault+0x20c/0x500
kernel: [  255.139597]  [<ffffffff811e8336>] ? dput+0xb6/0x190
kernel: [  255.139606]  [<ffffffff811f05f6>] ? mntput+0x26/0x40
kernel: [  255.139611]  [<ffffffff811d2b94>] ? __fput+0x174/0x1e0
kernel: [  255.139613]  [<ffffffff814e2129>] __sys_sendmsg+0x49/0x90
kernel: [  255.139615]  [<ffffffff814e2182>] SyS_sendmsg+0x12/0x20
kernel: [  255.139617]  [<ffffffff815df092>] system_call_fastpath+0x12/0x17
kernel: [  255.139619] ---[ end trace 5e6703e87d984f6b ]---

Signed-off-by: Mahesh Bandewar <maheshb@google.com>
Reported-by: Toshiaki Makita <makita.toshiaki@lab.ntt.co.jp>
Cc: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Cc: Roopa Prabhu <roopa@cumulusnetworks.com>
Cc: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
Acked-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Acked-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 13:36:57 -05:00
Erik Hugne
88b17b6a22 tipc: drop tx side permission checks
Part of the old remote management feature is a piece of code
that checked permissions on the local system to see if a certain
operation was permitted, and if so pass the command to a remote
node. This serves no purpose after the removal of remote management
with commit 5902385a24 ("tipc: obsolete the remote management
feature") so we remove it.

Signed-off-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 13:30:13 -05:00
Daniel Borkmann
9772b54c55 net: sctp: use MAX_HEADER for headroom reserve in output path
To accomodate for enough headroom for tunnels, use MAX_HEADER instead
of LL_MAX_HEADER. Robert reported that he has hit after roughly 40hrs
of trinity an skb_under_panic() via SCTP output path (see reference).
I couldn't reproduce it from here, but not using MAX_HEADER as elsewhere
in other protocols might be one possible cause for this.

In any case, it looks like accounting on chunks themself seems to look
good as the skb already passed the SCTP output path and did not hit
any skb_over_panic(). Given tunneling was enabled in his .config, the
headroom would have been expanded by MAX_HEADER in this case.

Reported-by: Robert Święcki <robert@swiecki.net>
Reference: https://lkml.org/lkml/2014/12/1/507
Fixes: 594ccc14df ("[SCTP] Replace incorrect use of dev_alloc_skb with alloc_skb in sctp_packet_transmit().")
Signed-off-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Acked-by: Vlad Yasevich <vyasevich@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Neil Horman <nhorman@tuxdriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 13:24:03 -05:00
Duan Jiong
86fe8f8920 ipv6: remove useless spin_lock/spin_unlock
xchg is atomic, so there is no necessary to use spin_lock/spin_unlock
to protect it. At last, remove the redundant
opt = xchg(&inet6_sk(sk)->opt, opt); statement.

Signed-off-by: Duan Jiong <duanj.fnst@cn.fujitsu.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-09 13:18:09 -05:00
Andy Shevchenko
1b2e122d16 sunrpc/cache: convert to use string_escape_str()
There is nice kernel helper to escape a given strings by provided rules. Let's
use it instead of custom approach.

Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
[bfields@redhat.com: fix length calculation]
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:30:20 -05:00
Jeff Layton
acf06a7fa1 sunrpc: only call test_bit once in svc_xprt_received
...move the WARN_ON_ONCE inside the following if block since they use
the same condition.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:29:14 -05:00
Jeff Layton
83a712e0af sunrpc: add some tracepoints around enqueue and dequeue of svc_xprt
These were useful when I was tracking down a race condition between
svc_xprt_do_enqueue and svc_get_next_xprt.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:29:14 -05:00
Jeff Layton
b1691bc03d sunrpc: convert to lockless lookup of queued server threads
Testing has shown that the pool->sp_lock can be a bottleneck on a busy
server. Every time data is received on a socket, the server must take
that lock in order to dequeue a thread from the sp_threads list.

Address this problem by eliminating the sp_threads list (which contains
threads that are currently idle) and replacing it with a RQ_BUSY flag in
svc_rqst. This allows us to walk the sp_all_threads list under the
rcu_read_lock and find a suitable thread for the xprt by doing a
test_and_set_bit.

Note that we do still have a potential atomicity problem however with
this approach.  We don't want svc_xprt_do_enqueue to set the
rqst->rq_xprt pointer unless a test_and_set_bit of RQ_BUSY returned
zero (which indicates that the thread was idle). But, by the time we
check that, the bit could be flipped by a waking thread.

To address this, we acquire a new per-rqst spinlock (rq_lock) and take
that before doing the test_and_set_bit. If that returns false, then we
can set rq_xprt and drop the spinlock. Then, when the thread wakes up,
it must set the bit under the same spinlock and can trust that if it was
already set then the rq_xprt is also properly set.

With this scheme, the case where we have an idle thread no longer needs
to take the highly contended pool->sp_lock at all, and that removes the
bottleneck.

That still leaves one issue: What of the case where we walk the whole
sp_all_threads list and don't find an idle thread? Because the search is
lockess, it's possible for the queueing to race with a thread that is
going to sleep. To address that, we queue the xprt and then search again.

If we find an idle thread at that point, we can't attach the xprt to it
directly since that might race with a different thread waking up and
finding it.  All we can do is wake the idle thread back up and let it
attempt to find the now-queued xprt.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Tested-by: Chris Worley <chris.worley@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:22:22 -05:00
Jeff Layton
403c7b4444 sunrpc: fix potential races in pool_stats collection
In a later patch, we'll be removing some spinlocking around the socket
and thread queueing code in order to fix some contention problems. At
that point, the stats counters will no longer be protected by the
sp_lock.

Change the counters to atomic_long_t fields, except for the
"sockets_queued" counter which will still be manipulated under a
spinlock.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Tested-by: Chris Worley <chris.worley@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:22:22 -05:00
Jeff Layton
812443865c sunrpc: add a rcu_head to svc_rqst and use kfree_rcu to free it
...also make the manipulation of sp_all_threads list use RCU-friendly
functions.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Tested-by: Chris Worley <chris.worley@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:22:22 -05:00
Jeff Layton
0b5707e452 sunrpc: require svc_create callers to pass in meaningful shutdown routine
Currently all svc_create callers pass in NULL for the shutdown parm,
which then gets fixed up to be svc_rpcb_cleanup if the service uses
rpcbind.

Simplify this by instead having the the only caller that requires it
(lockd) pass in svc_rpcb_cleanup and get rid of the special casing.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:22:21 -05:00
Jeff Layton
ceff739c53 sunrpc: have svc_wake_up only deal with pool 0
The way that svc_wake_up works is a bit inefficient. It walks all of the
available pools for a service and either wakes up a task in each one or
sets the SP_TASK_PENDING flag in each one.

When svc_wake_up is called, there is no need to wake up more than one
thread to do this work. In practice, only lockd currently uses this
function and it's single threaded anyway. Thus, this just boils down to
doing a wake up of a thread in pool 0 or setting a single flag.

Eliminate the for loop in this function and change it to just operate on
pool 0. Also update the comments that sit above it and get rid of some
code that has been commented out for years now.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:22:21 -05:00
Jeff Layton
4d5db3f536 sunrpc: convert sp_task_pending flag to use atomic bitops
In a later patch, we'll want to be able to handle this flag without
holding the sp_lock. Change this field to an unsigned long flags
field, and declare a new flag in it that can be managed with atomic
bitops.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:22:21 -05:00
Jeff Layton
779fb0f3af sunrpc: move rq_splice_ok flag into rq_flags
Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:22:21 -05:00
Jeff Layton
78b65eb3fd sunrpc: move rq_dropme flag into rq_flags
Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:22:20 -05:00
Jeff Layton
30660e04b0 sunrpc: move rq_usedeferral flag to rq_flags
Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:22:20 -05:00
Jeff Layton
7501cc2bcf sunrpc: move rq_local field to rq_flags
Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:21:21 -05:00
Jeff Layton
4d152e2c9a sunrpc: add a generic rq_flags field to svc_rqst and move rq_secure to it
In a later patch, we're going to need some atomic bit flags. Since that
field will need to be an unsigned long, we mitigate that space
consumption by migrating some other bitflags to the new field. Start
with the rq_secure flag.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 11:21:20 -05:00
J. Bruce Fields
2941b0e91b NFS client updates for Linux 3.19
Highlights include:
 
 Features:
 - NFSv4.2 client support for hole punching and preallocation.
 - Further RPC/RDMA client improvements.
 - Add more RPC transport debugging tracepoints.
 - Add RPC debugging tools in debugfs.
 
 Bugfixes:
 - Stable fix for layoutget error handling
 - Fix a change in COMMIT behaviour resulting from the recent io code updates
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 Version: GnuPG v1
 
 iQIcBAABAgAGBQJUhRVTAAoJEGcL54qWCgDyfeUP/RoFo3ImTMbGxfcPJqoELjcO
 lZbQ+27pOE/whFDkWgiOVTwlgGct5a0WRo7GCZmpYJA4q1kmSv4ngTb3nMTCUztt
 xMJ0mBr0BqttVs+ouKiVPm3cejQXedEhttwWcloIXS8lNenlpL29Zlrx2NHdU8UU
 13+souocj0dwIyTYYS/4Lm9KpuCYnpDBpP5ShvQjVaMe/GxJo6GyZu70c7FgwGNz
 Nh9onzZV3mz1elhfizlV38aVA7KWVXtLWIqOFIKlT2fa4nWB8Hc07miR5UeOK0/h
 r+icnF2qCQe83MbjOxYNxIKB6uiA/4xwVc90X4AQ7F0RX8XPWHIQWG5tlkC9jrCQ
 3RGzYshWDc9Ud2mXtLMyVQxHVVYlFAe1WtdP8ZWb1oxDInmhrarnWeNyECz9xGKu
 VzIDZzeq9G8slJXATWGRfPsYr+Ihpzcen4QQw58cakUBcqEJrYEhlEOfLovM71k3
 /S/jSHBAbQqiw4LPMw87bA5A6+ZKcVSsNE0XCtNnhmqFpLc1kKRrl5vaN+QMk5tJ
 v4/zR0fPqH7SGAJWYs4brdfahyejEo0TwgpDs7KHmu1W9zQ0LCVTaYnQuUmQjta6
 WyYwIy3TTibdfR191O0E3NOW82Q/k/NBD6ySvabN9HqQ9eSk6+rzrWAslXCbYohb
 BJfzcQfDdx+lsyhjeTx9
 =wOP3
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'nfs-for-3.19-1' into nfsd for-3.19 branch

Mainly what I need is 860a0d9e51 "sunrpc: add some tracepoints in
svc_rqst handling functions", which subsequent server rpc patches from
jlayton depend on.  I'm merging this later tag on the assumption that's
more likely to be a tested and stable point.
2014-12-09 11:12:26 -05:00
Michael S. Tsirkin
dc9e51534b af_packet: virtio 1.0 stubs
This merely fixes sparse warnings, without actually
adding support for the new APIs.

Still working out the best way to enable the new
functionality.

Signed-off-by: Michael S. Tsirkin <mst@redhat.com>
2014-12-09 12:06:32 +02:00
Fengguang Wu
fe70077197 Bluetooth: fix err_cast.cocci warnings
net/bluetooth/smp.c:2650:9-16: WARNING: ERR_CAST can be used with tfm_aes

Use ERR_CAST inlined function instead of ERR_PTR(PTR_ERR(...))

Generated by: scripts/coccinelle/api/err_cast.cocci

Signed-off-by: Fengguang Wu <fengguang.wu@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-09 08:06:51 +01:00
David S. Miller
6db70e3e1d Merge branch 'master' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/klassert/ipsec-next
Steffen Klassert says:

====================
pull request (net-next): ipsec-next 2014-12-03

1) Fix a set but not used warning. From Fabian Frederick.

2) Currently we make sequence number values available to userspace
   only if we use ESN. Make the sequence number values also available
   for non ESN states. From Zhi Ding.

3) Remove socket policy hashing. We don't need it because socket
   policies are always looked up via a linked list. From Herbert Xu.

4) After removing socket policy hashing, we can use __xfrm_policy_link
   in xfrm_policy_insert. From Herbert Xu.

5) Add a lookup method for vti6 tunnels with wildcard endpoints.
   I forgot this when I initially implemented vti6.

Please pull or let me know if there are problems.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 21:30:21 -05:00
Eyal Perry
892311f66f ethtool: Support for configurable RSS hash function
This patch extends the set/get_rxfh ethtool-options for getting or
setting the RSS hash function.

It modifies drivers implementation of set/get_rxfh accordingly.

This change also delegates the responsibility of checking whether a
modification to a certain RX flow hash parameter is supported to the
driver implementation of set_rxfh.

User-kernel API is done through the new hfunc bitmask field in the
ethtool_rxfh struct. A bit set in the hfunc field is corresponding to an
index in the new string-set ETH_SS_RSS_HASH_FUNCS.

Got approval from most of the relevant driver maintainers that their
driver is using Toeplitz, and for the few that didn't answered, also
assumed it is Toeplitz.

Cc: Tom Lendacky <thomas.lendacky@amd.com>
Cc: Ariel Elior <ariel.elior@qlogic.com>
Cc: Prashant Sreedharan <prashant@broadcom.com>
Cc: Michael Chan <mchan@broadcom.com>
Cc: Hariprasad S <hariprasad@chelsio.com>
Cc: Sathya Perla <sathya.perla@emulex.com>
Cc: Subbu Seetharaman <subbu.seetharaman@emulex.com>
Cc: Ajit Khaparde <ajit.khaparde@emulex.com>
Cc: Jeff Kirsher <jeffrey.t.kirsher@intel.com>
Cc: Jesse Brandeburg <jesse.brandeburg@intel.com>
Cc: Bruce Allan <bruce.w.allan@intel.com>
Cc: Carolyn Wyborny <carolyn.wyborny@intel.com>
Cc: Don Skidmore <donald.c.skidmore@intel.com>
Cc: Greg Rose <gregory.v.rose@intel.com>
Cc: Matthew Vick <matthew.vick@intel.com>
Cc: John Ronciak <john.ronciak@intel.com>
Cc: Mitch Williams <mitch.a.williams@intel.com>
Cc: Amir Vadai <amirv@mellanox.com>
Cc: Solarflare linux maintainers <linux-net-drivers@solarflare.com>
Cc: Shradha Shah <sshah@solarflare.com>
Cc: Shreyas Bhatewara <sbhatewara@vmware.com>
Cc: "VMware, Inc." <pv-drivers@vmware.com>
Cc: Ben Hutchings <ben@decadent.org.uk>
Signed-off-by: Eyal Perry <eyalpe@mellanox.com>
Signed-off-by: Amir Vadai <amirv@mellanox.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 21:07:10 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
18b5427ae1 net_sched: cls_cgroup: remove unnecessary if
since head->handle == handle (checked before), just assign handle.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:53:41 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
2f8a2965da net_sched: cls_flow: remove duplicate assignments
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:53:41 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
6a659cd061 net_sched: cls_flow: remove faulty use of list_for_each_entry_rcu
rcu variant is not correct here. The code is called by updater (rtnl
lock is held), not by reader (no rcu_read_lock is held).

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:53:40 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
3fe6b49e2f net_sched: cls_bpf: remove faulty use of list_for_each_entry_rcu
rcu variant is not correct here. The code is called by updater (rtnl
lock is held), not by reader (no rcu_read_lock is held).

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
ACKed-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Acked-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:53:40 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
472f583701 net_sched: cls_bpf: remove unnecessary iteration and use passed arg
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Acked-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:53:40 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
e4386456ae net_sched: cls_basic: remove unnecessary iteration and use passed arg
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:53:40 -05:00
Ying Xue
97ede29e80 tipc: convert name table read-write lock to RCU
Convert tipc name table read-write lock to RCU. After this change,
a new spin lock is used to protect name table on write side while
RCU is applied on read side.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Tested-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:39:57 -05:00
Ying Xue
834caafa3e tipc: remove unnecessary INIT_LIST_HEAD
When a list_head variable is seen as a new entry to be added to a
list head, it's unnecessary to be initialized with INIT_LIST_HEAD().

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Tested-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:39:57 -05:00
Ying Xue
5492390a94 tipc: simplify relationship between name table lock and node lock
When tipc name sequence is published, name table lock is released
before name sequence buffer is delivered to remote nodes through its
underlying unicast links. However, when name sequence is withdrawn,
the name table lock is held until the transmission of the removal
message of name sequence is finished. During the process, node lock
is nested in name table lock. To prevent node lock from being nested
in name table lock, while withdrawing name, we should adopt the same
locking policy of publishing name sequence: name table lock should
be released before message is sent.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Tested-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:39:57 -05:00
Ying Xue
3493d25cfb tipc: any name table member must be protected under name table lock
As tipc_nametbl_lock is used to protect name_table structure, the lock
must be held while all members of name_table structure are accessed.
However, the lock is not obtained while a member of name_table
structure - local_publ_count is read in tipc_nametbl_publish(), as
a consequence, an inconsistent value of local_publ_count might be got.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Tested-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:39:57 -05:00
Ying Xue
fb9962f3ce tipc: ensure all name sequences are properly protected with its lock
TIPC internally created a name table which is used to store name
sequences. Now there is a read-write lock - tipc_nametbl_lock to
protect the table, and each name sequence saved in the table is
protected with its private lock. When a name sequence is inserted
or removed to or from the table, its members might need to change.
Therefore, in normal case, the two locks must be held while TIPC
operates the table. However, there are still several places where
we only hold tipc_nametbl_lock without proprerly obtaining name
sequence lock, which might cause the corruption of name sequence.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Tested-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:39:56 -05:00
Ying Xue
38622f4195 tipc: ensure all name sequences are released when name table is stopped
As TIPC subscriber server is terminated before name table, no user
depends on subscription list of name sequence when name table is
stopped. Therefore, all name sequences stored in name table should
be released whatever their subscriptions lists are empty or not,
otherwise, memory leak might happen.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Tested-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:39:56 -05:00
Ying Xue
993bfe5daf tipc: make name table allocated dynamically
Name table locking policy is going to be adjusted from read-write
lock protection to RCU lock protection in the future commits. But
its essential precondition is to convert the allocation way of name
table from static to dynamic mode.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Tested-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:39:56 -05:00
Ying Xue
1b61e70ad1 tipc: remove size variable from publ_list struct
The size variable is introduced in publ_list struct to help us exactly
calculate SKB buffer sizes needed by publications when all publications
in name table are delivered in bulk in named_distribute(). But if
publication SKB buffer size is assumed to MTU, the size variable in
publ_list struct can be completely eliminated at the cost of wasting
a bit memory space for last SKB.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Aho <tero.aho@coriant.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Tested-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:39:55 -05:00
Al Viro
ba00410b81 Merge branch 'iov_iter' into for-next 2014-12-08 20:39:29 -05:00
Joe Perches
60c04aecd8 udp: Neaten and reduce size of compute_score functions
The compute_score functions are a bit difficult to read.

Neaten them a bit to reduce object sizes and make them a
bit more intelligible.

Return early to avoid indentation and avoid unnecessary
initializations.

(allyesconfig, but w/ -O2 and no profiling)

$ size net/ipv[46]/udp.o.*
   text    data     bss     dec     hex filename
  28680    1184      25   29889    74c1 net/ipv4/udp.o.new
  28756    1184      25   29965    750d net/ipv4/udp.o.old
  17600    1010       2   18612    48b4 net/ipv6/udp.o.new
  17632    1010       2   18644    48d4 net/ipv6/udp.o.old

Signed-off-by: Joe Perches <joe@perches.com>
Acked-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:28:47 -05:00
Willem de Bruijn
829ae9d611 net-timestamp: allow reading recv cmsg on errqueue with origin tstamp
Allow reading of timestamps and cmsg at the same time on all relevant
socket families. One use is to correlate timestamps with egress
device, by asking for cmsg IP_PKTINFO.

on AF_INET sockets, call the relevant function (ip_cmsg_recv). To
avoid changing legacy expectations, only do so if the caller sets a
new timestamping flag SOF_TIMESTAMPING_OPT_CMSG.

on AF_INET6 sockets, IPV6_PKTINFO and all other recv cmsg are already
returned for all origins. only change is to set ifindex, which is
not initialized for all error origins.

In both cases, only generate the pktinfo message if an ifindex is
known. This is not the case for ACK timestamps.

The difference between the protocol families is probably a historical
accident as a result of the different conditions for generating cmsg
in the relevant ip(v6)_recv_error function:

ipv4:        if (serr->ee.ee_origin == SO_EE_ORIGIN_ICMP) {
ipv6:        if (serr->ee.ee_origin != SO_EE_ORIGIN_LOCAL) {

At one time, this was the same test bar for the ICMP/ICMP6
distinction. This is no longer true.

Signed-off-by: Willem de Bruijn <willemb@google.com>

----

Changes
  v1 -> v2
    large rewrite
    - integrate with existing pktinfo cmsg generation code
    - on ipv4: only send with new flag, to maintain legacy behavior
    - on ipv6: send at most a single pktinfo cmsg
    - on ipv6: initialize fields if not yet initialized

The recv cmsg interfaces are also relevant to the discussion of
whether looping packet headers is problematic. For v6, cmsgs that
identify many headers are already returned. This patch expands
that to v4. If it sounds reasonable, I will follow with patches

1. request timestamps without payload with SOF_TIMESTAMPING_OPT_TSONLY
   (http://patchwork.ozlabs.org/patch/366967/)
2. sysctl to conditionally drop all timestamps that have payload or
   cmsg from users without CAP_NET_RAW.
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:20:48 -05:00
Willem de Bruijn
7ce875e5ec ipv4: warn once on passing AF_INET6 socket to ip_recv_error
One line change, in response to catching an occurrence of this bug.
See also fix f4713a3dfa ("net-timestamp: make tcp_recvmsg call ...")

Signed-off-by: Willem de Bruijn <willemb@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-08 20:20:48 -05:00
John W. Linville
81c412600f Merge branch 'master' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/linville/wireless 2014-12-08 13:58:58 -05:00
Rafael J. Wysocki
d3eaf5875e Merge branch 'device-properties'
* device-properties:
  leds: leds-gpio: Fix multiple instances registration without 'label' property
  leds: leds-gpio: Fix legacy GPIO number case
  ACPI / property: Drop size_prop from acpi_dev_get_property_reference()
  leds: leds-gpio: Convert gpio_blink_set() to use GPIO descriptors
  ACPI / GPIO: Document ACPI GPIO mappings API
  net: rfkill: gpio: Add default GPIO driver mappings for ACPI
  ACPI / GPIO: Driver GPIO mappings for ACPI GPIOs
  input: gpio_keys_polled: Make use of device property API
  leds: leds-gpio: Make use of device property API
  gpio: Support for unified device properties interface
  Driver core: Unified interface for firmware node properties
  input: gpio_keys_polled: Add support for GPIO descriptors
  leds: leds-gpio: Add support for GPIO descriptors
  gpio: sch: Consolidate core and resume banks
  gpio / ACPI: Add support for _DSD device properties
  misc: at25: Make use of device property API
  ACPI: Allow drivers to match using Device Tree compatible property
  Driver core: Unified device properties interface for platform firmware
  ACPI: Add support for device specific properties
2014-12-08 19:50:17 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
9437d2edc3 Bluetooth: Fix generation of non-resolvable private addresses
When the host decides to use a non-resolvable private address, it
must ensure that this generated address does not match the public
address of the controller. Add an extra check to ensure this required
behavior.

In addition rename the variable from urpa to nrpa and fix all of the
comments in the code that use the term unresolvable instead of the
term non-resolvable as used in the Bluetooth specification.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-08 09:21:14 +02:00
Steffen Klassert
f855691975 xfrm6: Fix the nexthdr offset in _decode_session6.
xfrm_decode_session() was originally designed for the
usage in the receive path where the correct nexthdr offset
is stored in IP6CB(skb)->nhoff. Over time this function
spread to code that is used in the output path (netfilter,
vti) where IP6CB(skb)->nhoff is not set. As a result, we
get a wrong nexthdr and the upper layer flow informations
are wrong. This can leed to incorrect policy lookups.

Signed-off-by: Steffen Klassert <steffen.klassert@secunet.com>
2014-12-08 07:56:18 +01:00
Steffen Klassert
de3b7a06df xfrm6: Fix transport header offset in _decode_session6.
skb->transport_header might not be valid when we do a reverse
decode because the ipv6 tunnel error handlers don't update it
to the inner transport header. This leads to a wrong offset
calculation and to wrong layer 4 informations. We fix this
by using the size of the ipv6 header as the first offset.

Signed-off-by: Steffen Klassert <steffen.klassert@secunet.com>
2014-12-08 07:38:14 +01:00
Jeremiah Mahler
069f8457ae can: fix spelling errors
Fix various spelling errors in the comments of the CAN modules.

Signed-off-by: Jeremiah Mahler <jmmahler@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Oliver Hartkopp <socketcan@hartkopp.net>
Signed-off-by: Marc Kleine-Budde <mkl@pengutronix.de>
2014-12-07 21:22:05 +01:00
Jeremiah Mahler
b111b78c6e can: eliminate banner[] variable and switch to pr_info()
Several CAN modules use a design pattern with a banner[] variable at the
top which defines a string that is used once during init to print the
banner.  The string is also embedded with KERN_INFO which makes it
printk() specific.

Improve the code by eliminating the banner[] variable and moving the
string to where it is printed.  Then switch from printk(KERN_INFO to
pr_info() for the lines that were changed.

Signed-off-by: Jeremiah Mahler <jmmahler@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Oliver Hartkopp <socketcan@hartkopp.net>
Signed-off-by: Marc Kleine-Budde <mkl@pengutronix.de>
2014-12-07 21:22:01 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
08f63cc502 Bluetooth: Check for force_lesc_support before rejecting SMP over BR/EDR
The SMP over BR/EDR requests for cross-transport pairing should also
accepted when the debugfs setting force_lesc_support has been enabled.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-07 20:03:58 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
f9be9e8661 Bluetooth: Check for force_lesc_support when enabling SMP over BR/EDR
The SMP over BR/EDR support for cross-transport pairing should also be
enabled when the debugfs setting force_lesc_support has been enabled.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-06 09:51:41 +02:00
Alexei Starovoitov
89aa075832 net: sock: allow eBPF programs to be attached to sockets
introduce new setsockopt() command:

setsockopt(sock, SOL_SOCKET, SO_ATTACH_BPF, &prog_fd, sizeof(prog_fd))

where prog_fd was received from syscall bpf(BPF_PROG_LOAD, attr, ...)
and attr->prog_type == BPF_PROG_TYPE_SOCKET_FILTER

setsockopt() calls bpf_prog_get() which increments refcnt of the program,
so it doesn't get unloaded while socket is using the program.

The same eBPF program can be attached to multiple sockets.

User task exit automatically closes socket which calls sk_filter_uncharge()
which decrements refcnt of eBPF program

Signed-off-by: Alexei Starovoitov <ast@plumgrid.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-05 21:47:32 -08:00
Pravin B Shelar
f2a01517f2 openvswitch: Fix flow mask validation.
Following patch fixes typo in the flow validation. This prevented
installation of ARP and IPv6 flows.

Fixes: 19e7a3df72 ("openvswitch: Fix NDP flow mask validation")
Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Reviewed-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-05 21:42:16 -08:00
Tom Herbert
6fb2a75673 gre: Set inner mac header in gro complete
Set the inner mac header to point to the GRE payload when
doing GRO. This is needed if we proceed to send the packet
through GRE GSO which now uses the inner mac header instead
of inner network header to determine the length of encapsulation
headers.

Fixes: 14051f0452 ("gre: Use inner mac length when computing tunnel length")
Reported-by: Wolfgang Walter <linux@stwm.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Herbert <therbert@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-05 21:18:34 -08:00
David S. Miller
244ebd9f8f Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/pablo/nf-next
Pablo Neira Ayuso says:

====================
Netfilter updates for net-next

The following batch contains netfilter updates for net-next. Basically,
enhancements for xt_recent, skip zeroing of timer in conntrack, fix
linking problem with recent redirect support for nf_tables, ipset
updates and a couple of cleanups. More specifically, they are:

1) Rise maximum number per IP address to be remembered in xt_recent
   while retaining backward compatibility, from Florian Westphal.

2) Skip zeroing timer area in nf_conn objects, also from Florian.

3) Inspect IPv4 and IPv6 traffic from the bridge to allow filtering using
   using meta l4proto and transport layer header, from Alvaro Neira.

4) Fix linking problems in the new redirect support when CONFIG_IPV6=n
   and IP6_NF_IPTABLES=n.

And ipset updates from Jozsef Kadlecsik:

5) Support updating element extensions when the set is full (fixes
   netfilter bugzilla id 880).

6) Fix set match with 32-bits userspace / 64-bits kernel.

7) Indicate explicitly when /0 networks are supported in ipset.

8) Simplify cidr handling for hash:*net* types.

9) Allocate the proper size of memory when /0 networks are supported.

10) Explicitly add padding elements to hash:net,net and hash:net,port,
    because the elements must be u32 sized for the used hash function.

Jozsef is also cooking ipset RCU conversion which should land soon if
they reach the merge window in time.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-05 20:56:46 -08:00
John W. Linville
f700076a9d Merge branch 'for-upstream' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/bluetooth/bluetooth-next 2014-12-05 14:12:24 -05:00
Marcel Holtmann
5a34bd5f5d Bluetooth: Enable events for P-256 Public Key and DHKey commands
When the LE Read Local P-256 Public Key command is supported, then
enable its corresponding complete event. And when the LE Generate DHKey
command is supported, enable its corresponding complete event as well.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 18:17:49 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
4efbb2ce8b Bluetooth: Add support for enabling Extended Scanner Filter Policies
The new Extended Scanner Filter Policies feature has to be enabled by
selecting the correct filter policy for the scan parameters. This
patch does that when the controller has been enabled to use LE Privacy.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 18:17:19 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
2f010b5588 Bluetooth: Add support for handling LE Direct Advertising Report events
When the controller sends a LE Direct Advertising Report event, the host
must confirm that the resolvable random address provided matches with
its own identity resolving key. If it does, then that advertising report
needs to be processed. If it does not match, the report needs to be
ignored.

This patch adds full support for handling these new reports and using
them for device discovery and connection handling. This means when a
Bluetooth controller supports the Extended Scanner Filter Policies, it
is possible to use directed advertising with LE privacy.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 18:16:41 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
4b71bba45c Bluetooth: Enabled LE Direct Advertising Report event if supported
When the controller supports the Extended Scanner Filter Policies, it
supports the LE Direct Advertising Report event. However by default
that event is blocked by the LE event mask. It is required to enable
it during controller setup.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 18:15:33 +02:00
Varka Bhadram
bcb47aabf4 mac802154: use goto label on failure
Signed-off-by: Varka Bhadram <varkab@cdac.in>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Schmidt <s.schmidt@samsung.com>
Acked-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 14:18:42 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
da25cf6a98 Bluetooth: Report invalid RSSI for service discovery and background scan
When using Start Service Discovery and when background scanning is used
to report devices, the RSSI is reported or the value 127 is provided in
case RSSI in unavailable.

For Start Discovery the value 0 is reported to keep backwards
compatibility with the existing users.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 14:14:28 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
efb2513fd6 Bluetooth: Fix discovery filter when no RSSI is available
When no RSSI value is available then make sure that the result is
filtered out when the RSSI threshold filter is active.

This means that all Bluetooth 1.1 or earlier devices will not
report any results when using a RSSI threshold filter.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 14:14:26 +02:00
Johan Hedberg
189f6ad21f Bluetooth: Remove redundant reverse_base_uuid variable
The mgmt.c file already has a bluetooth_base_uuid variable which has the
exact same value as the reverse_base_uuid one. This patch removes the
redundant variable.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:47:24 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
9981bdb05a Bluetooth: Fix Get Conn Info to use cmd_complete callback
This patch fixes the Get Connection Information mgmt command to take
advantage of the new cmd_complete callback. This allows for great
simplifications in the logic for constructing the cmd_complete event.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:46:28 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
ebf86aa3ae Bluetooth: Fix initializing hci_conn RSSI to invalid value
When we create the hci_conn object we should properly initialize the
RSSI to HCI_RSSI_INVALID.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:46:10 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
69487371d1 Bluetooth: Convert Get Clock Info to use cmd_complete callback
This patch converts the Get Clock Information mgmt command to take
advantage of the new cmd_complete callback for pending commands.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:46:10 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
2922a94fcc Bluetooth: Convert discovery commands to use cmd_complete callback
This patch converts the Start/Stop Discovery mgmt commands to use the
cmd_complete callback of struct pending_cmd. Since both of these
commands return the same parameters as they take as input we can use the
existing generic_cmd_complete() helper for this.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:46:10 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
d8b7b1e49a Bluetooth: Convert Unpair Device to use cmd_complete callback
This patch updates the Unpair Device code to take advantage of the
cmd_complete callback of struct pending_cmd.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:46:10 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
04ab2749ea Bluetooth: Convert Pair Device to use cmd_complete callback
This patch converts the Pair Device mgmt command to use the new
cmd_complete callback for pending mgmt commands. The already existing
pairing_complete() function is exactly what's needed and doesn't need
changing.

In addition to getting the return parameters always right this patch
actually fixes a reference counting bug and memory leak with the
hci_conn that's attached to the pending mgmt command - something that
would occur when powering off or unplugging the adapter while pairing is
in progress.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:46:10 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
7776d1d805 Bluetooth: Use cmd_complete callback for authentication mgmt commands
This patch converts the user confirmation & PIN code mgmt commands to
take advantage of the new cmd_complete callback for pending mgmt
commands. The patch also adds a new generic addr_cmd_complete() helper
function to be used with commands that send a mgmt_addr_info response
based on a mgmt_addr_info in the beginning of the command parameters.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:46:09 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
f5818c2241 Bluetooth: Convert Disconnect mgmt command to use cmd_complete callback
This patch converts the Disconnect mgmt command to take advantage of the
new cmd_complete callback that's part of the pending_cmd struct. There
are many commands whose response parameters map 1:1 to the command
parameters and Disconnect is one of them. This patch adds a
generic_cmd_complete() function for such commands that can be reused in
subsequent patches.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:46:09 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
323b0b885b Bluetooth: Store parameter length with pending mgmt commands
As preparation for making generic cmd_complete responses possible we'll
need to track the parameter length in addition to just a pointer to
them. This patch adds the necessary variable to the pending_cmd struct.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:46:09 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
1b9b5ee530 Bluetooth: Add callback to create proper cmd_complete events
We've got a couple of generic scenarios where all pending mgmt commands
are processed and responses are sent to them. These scenarios are
powering off the adapter and removing the adapter. So far the code has
been generating cmd_status responses with NOT_POWERED and INVALID_INDEX
resposes respectively, but this violates the mgmt specification for
commands that should always generate a cmd_complete.

This patch adds support for specifying a callback for the pending_cmd
context that each command handler can use for command-specific
cmd_complete event generation. The actual per-command event generators
will come in subsequent patches.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:46:09 +01:00
Stefan Schmidt
1db9960452 net/mac802154: No need for an extra space when casting
Coding style cleanup.

Signed-off-by: Stefan Schmidt <s.schmidt@samsung.com>
Acked-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:43:05 +01:00
Stefan Schmidt
a4dc132196 net/mac802154: Remove extra blank lines.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Schmidt <s.schmidt@samsung.com>
Acked-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:43:05 +01:00
Stefan Schmidt
6c10dc05b8 net/ieee802154: Remove and add extra blank lines as needed.
Some have been missing and some have been needed. Just cosmetics.

Signed-off-by: Stefan Schmidt <s.schmidt@samsung.com>
Acked-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:43:05 +01:00
Stefan Schmidt
cad865dc4b net/ieee802154: Make sure alignment matches parenthesis..
Follow coding style of the kernel.

Signed-off-by: Stefan Schmidt <s.schmidt@samsung.com>
Acked-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:43:04 +01:00
Stefan Schmidt
a413e3fd4b net/6lowpan: Remove FSF address from GPL statement.
This might change and we already deliver a copy of the license with
the kernel. This was already removed form the ieee802154 code but
missed here.

Signed-off-by: Stefan Schmidt <s.schmidt@samsung.com>
Acked-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Jukka Rissanen <jukka.rissanen@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-05 12:43:04 +01:00
Marcel Holtmann
ee3c3ca5ba Bluetooth: Clear discovery filter before starting background scan
Currently the discovery filter information are only cleared when the
actual discovery procedure has been stopped. To make sure that none
of the filters interfere with the background scanning and its device
found event reporting, clear the filter before starting background
scanning.

This means that the discovery filter is now cleared before either
Start Discovery, Start Service Discovery or background scanning.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 13:13:01 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
22078800c3 Bluetooth: Fix memory leaks from discovery filter UUID list
In case of failure or when unplugging a controller, the allocated
memory for the UUID list of the discovery filter is not freed. Use
the newly introduced helper for reset the discovery filter and with
that also freeing existing memory.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 13:13:00 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
0256325ed6 Bluetooth: Add helper function for clearing the discovery filter
The discovery filter allocates memory for its UUID list. So use
a helper function to free it and reset it to default states.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 13:12:58 +02:00
Jakub Pawlowski
66ea9427e0 Bluetooth: Add support for Start Service Discovery command
This patch adds support for the Start Service Discovery command. It
does all the checks for command parameters and configured the discovery
filter settings correctly. However the actual support for filtering
will be added with another patch.

Signed-off-by: Jakub Pawlowski <jpawlowski@google.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 12:37:37 +02:00
Jakub Pawlowski
799ce93df0 Bluetooth: Add logic for UUID filter handling
The previous patch provided the framework for integrating the UUID
filtering into the service discovery. This patch now provides the
actual filter logic.

Signed-off-by: Jakub Pawlowski <jpawlowski@google.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 12:37:36 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
b487b9ce93 Bluetooth: Add framework for device found filtering based on UUID
Using Start Service Discovery provides the option to specifiy a list
of UUID that are used to filter out device found events. This patch
provides the framework for hooking up the UUID filter.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 12:37:35 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
bda157a400 Bluetooth: Filter device found events based on RSSI threshold
Using Start Service Discovery allows to provide a RSSI threshold. This
patch implements support for filtering out device found events based
on the provided value.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 12:37:34 +02:00
Jakub Pawlowski
37eab042be Bluetooth: Add extra discovery fields for storing filter information
With the upcoming addition of support for Start Service Discovery, the
discovery handling needs to filter on RSSI and UUID values. For that
they need to be stored in the discovery handling. This patch adds the
appropiate fields and also make sure they are reset when discovery
has been stopped.

Signed-off-by: Jakub Pawlowski <jpawlowski@google.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-05 12:37:33 +02:00
Al Viro
f77c80142e bury struct proc_ns in fs/proc
a) make get_proc_ns() return a pointer to struct ns_common
b) mirror ns_ops in dentry->d_fsdata of ns dentries, so that
is_mnt_ns_file() could get away with fewer dereferences.

That way struct proc_ns becomes invisible outside of fs/proc/*.c

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-04 14:34:54 -05:00
Al Viro
33c429405a copy address of proc_ns_ops into ns_common
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-04 14:34:47 -05:00
Al Viro
6344c433a4 new helpers: ns_alloc_inum/ns_free_inum
take struct ns_common *, for now simply wrappers around proc_{alloc,free}_inum()

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-04 14:34:36 -05:00
Al Viro
64964528b2 make proc_ns_operations work with struct ns_common * instead of void *
We can do that now.  And kill ->inum(), while we are at it - all instances
are identical.

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-04 14:34:17 -05:00
Al Viro
ff24870f46 netns: switch ->get()/->put()/->install()/->inum() to working with &net->ns
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-04 14:34:04 -05:00
Al Viro
435d5f4bb2 common object embedded into various struct ....ns
for now - just move corresponding ->proc_inum instances over there

Acked-by: "Eric W. Biederman" <ebiederm@xmission.com>
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-12-04 14:31:00 -05:00
John W. Linville
de51f1649a Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/jberg/mac80211-next
Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> says:

"This time I have Felix's no-status rate control work, which will allow
drivers to work better with rate control even if they don't have perfect
status reporting. In addition to this, a small hwsim fix from Patrik,
one of the regulatory patches from Arik, and a number of cleanups and
fixes I did myself.

Of note is a patch where I disable CFG80211_WEXT so that compatibility
is no longer selectable - this is intended as a wake-up call for anyone
who's still using it, and is still easily worked around (it's a one-line
patch) before we fully remove the code as well in the future."

Signed-off-by: John W. Linville <linville@tuxdriver.com>
2014-12-04 11:29:10 -05:00
John W. Linville
04bb7ecf88 NFC: 3.19 pull request
This is the NFC pull request for 3.19.
 
 With this one we get:
 
 - NFC digital improvements for DEP support: Chaining, NACK and ATN
   support added.
 
 - NCI improvements: Support for p2p target, SE IO operand addition,
   SE operands extensions to support proprietary implementations, and
   a few fixes.
 
 - NFC HCI improvements: OPEN_PIPE and NOTIFY_ALL_CLEARED support,
   and SE IO operand addition.
 
 - A bunch of minor improvements and fixes for STMicro st21nfcb and
   st21nfca
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 Version: GnuPG v1
 
 iQIcBAABAgAGBQJUfjvWAAoJEIqAPN1PVmxK46MP/1QFb093QmAK3AfMS7XBZdwg
 vgJkZIyFmTeRlDTonRJpv1MXZhPL+JHYK0wGANts1Ba04nZIgK9jzdcqjvd1niD1
 Hk9ggHpfxsIl35FfRVcWAUpyb71Ykug2V396gJH2iiHvt2jHr8IsRWOWCVaItWMO
 ZpVpV58xkROEu115wjKdrmKijL0xf7/F70RlReV4tOLGip3E/bP7EhutF2s5D8Lt
 A5hfauQS3lUJIhlJ1IT59XtdnBSIS5D8OuNYjuJuFkPfIcXAHacEUBrta3KahQPy
 kFGYYjj+V0vZA9JQG/j6vomP4AI0pP4DPkwWqgmioaPshkOOktwf1l21IKQrC7aw
 h7EFEG6q5AxnL5JFbm4y+b5IEp8ALeVi5rv1xdRZ7/AW/n6FWGrkBHatsJceQgX+
 wFhZ52USGHQUzWoJ6SC0O82U831/dgxWm5M42CV5/Bl9d69XX7Om9MWytdjQ94yB
 ERoSJcivc+Q30bAiZmvb44ghv3qMGNArlBVVlcN7+3rbz4XOWLhduqCJaUs12fgY
 lyGdNHxVVmEeEY9ByOjr6RD1pYpSDgEQSYvn5pbKadX+DqpXHQuGC4JHtbBkzKn0
 Se9c442HRBjts0VprJ7wjLgbf5VfqFjtgsfqubD/mcTn61B4/t9zyGgV1VuI7UgL
 QxK0m0rB1nOxpdWFesl1
 =WHHp
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'nfc-next-3.19-1' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/sameo/nfc-next

Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com> says:

"NFC: 3.19 pull request

This is the NFC pull request for 3.19.

With this one we get:

- NFC digital improvements for DEP support: Chaining, NACK and ATN
  support added.

- NCI improvements: Support for p2p target, SE IO operand addition,
  SE operands extensions to support proprietary implementations, and
  a few fixes.

- NFC HCI improvements: OPEN_PIPE and NOTIFY_ALL_CLEARED support,
  and SE IO operand addition.

- A bunch of minor improvements and fixes for STMicro st21nfcb and
  st21nfca"

Signed-off-by: John W. Linville <linville@tuxdriver.com>
2014-12-04 11:27:40 -05:00
Marcel Holtmann
8019044dcb Bluetooth: Split triggering of discovery commands into separate function
The actual process of compiling the correct HCI commands for triggering
discovery is something that should be generic. So instead of mixing it
into the Start Discover operation handling, split it out into its own
function utilizing HCI request handling and just providing status in
case of errors or invalid parameters.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-04 12:52:29 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
11e6e25d05 Bluetooth: Use {start,stop}_discovery_complete handler for cmd_complete
Sending the required cmd_complete for the management commands should be
done in one place and not in multiple places. Especially for Start and
Stop Discovery commands this is split into to sending it in case of
failure from the complete handler, but in case of success from the
event state update function triggering mgmt_discovering. This is way
too convoluted and since hci_request serializes the HCI command
processing, send the cmd_complete response from the complete handler
for all cases.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-04 12:50:34 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
f5a969f23b Bluetooth: Simplify the error handling of Start Discovery command
The Start Discovery command has some complicated code when it comes
to error handling. With the future introduction of Start Service
Discovery simplifying this makes it easier to read.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-04 12:50:21 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
854bda1982 Bluetooth: Increment management interface revision
This patch increments the management interface revision due to the
addition of support for LE Secure Connection feature.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-03 21:58:27 +02:00
Marcel Holtmann
8ab9731d8c Bluetooth: Increase minor version of core module
With the addition of support for Bluetooth Low Energy Secure Connections
feature, it makes sense to increase the minor version of the Bluetooth
core module.

The module version is not used anywhere, but it gives a nice extra
hint for debugging purposes.

Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-12-03 21:58:25 +02:00
Johan Hedberg
580039e838 Bluetooth: Fix false-positive "uninitialized" compiler warning
Some gcc versions don't seem to be able to properly track the flow of
the smp_cmd_pairing_random() function and end up causing the following
types of (false-positive) warnings:

 smp.c:1995:6: warning: ‘nb’ may be used uninitialized in this function [-Wmaybe-uninitialized]
   err = smp_g2(smp->tfm_cmac, pkax, pkbx, na, nb, &passkey);
 smp.c:1995:6: warning: ‘na’ may be used uninitialized in this function [-Wmaybe-uninitialized]
   err = smp_g2(smp->tfm_cmac, pkax, pkbx, na, nb, &passkey);
       ^
 smp.c:1995:6: warning: ‘pkbx’ may be used uninitialized in this function [-Wmaybe-uninitialized]
   err = smp_g2(smp->tfm_cmac, pkax, pkbx, na, nb, &passkey);
       ^
 smp.c:1995:6: warning: ‘pkax’ may be used uninitialized in this function [-Wmaybe-uninitialized]
   err = smp_g2(smp->tfm_cmac, pkax, pkbx, na, nb, &passkey);

This patch fixes the issue by moving the pkax/pkbx and na/nb
initialization earlier in the function.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:22 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
7f376cd6dc Bluetooth: Fix minor coding style issue in smp.c
The convention for checking for NULL pointers is !ptr and not
ptr == NULL. This patch fixes such an occurrence in smp.c.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:22 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
923e24143e Bluetooth: Fix SMP debug key handling
We need to keep debug keys around at least until the point that they are
used - otherwise e.g. slave role behavior wouldn't work as there'd be no
key to be looked up. The correct behavior should therefore be to return
any stored keys but when we clean up the SMP context to remove the key
from the hdev list if keeping debug keys around hasn't been requestsed.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:22 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
06edf8deb5 Bluetooth: Organize SMP crypto functions to logical sections
This patch organizes the various SMP crypto functions so that the LE SC
functions appear in one section and the legacy SMP functions in a
separate one.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:22 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
cd08279762 Bluetooth: Fix missing const declarations in SMP functions
Several SMP functions take read-only data. This patch fixes the
declaration of these parameters to use the const specifier as
appropriate.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:21 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
c7a3d57db6 Bluetooth: Introduce SMP_DBG macro for low-level debuging
The various inputs & outputs of the crypto functions as well as the
values of the ECDH keys can be considered security sensitive. They
should therefore not end up in dmesg by mistake. This patch introduces a
new SMP_DBG macro which requires explicit compilation with -DDEBUG to be
enabled. All crypto related data logs now use this macro instead of
BT_DBG.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:21 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
a29b073351 Bluetooth: Add basic LE SC OOB support for remote OOB data
This patch adds basic OOB pairing support when we've received the remote
OOB data. This includes tracking the remote r value (in smp->rr) as well
as doing the appropriate f4() call when needed. Previously the OOB rand
would have been stored in smp->rrnd however these are actually two
independent values so we need separate variables for them. Na/Nb in the
spec maps to smp->prnd/rrnd and ra/rb maps to smp->rr with smp->pr to
come once local OOB data is supported.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:21 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
02b05bd8b0 Bluetooth: Set SMP OOB flag if OOB data is available
If we have OOB data available for the remote device in question we
should set the OOB flag appropriately in the SMP pairing request or
response.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:21 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
86df9200c7 Bluetooth: Add support for adding remote OOB data for LE
This patch adds proper support for passing LE OOB data to the
hci_add_remote_oob_data() function. For LE the 192-bit values are not
valid and should therefore be passed as NULL values.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:21 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
6928a9245f Bluetooth: Store address type with OOB data
To be able to support OOB data for LE pairing we need to store the
address type of the remote device. This patch extends the relevant
functions and data types with a bdaddr_type variable.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:21 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
81328d5cca Bluetooth: Unify remote OOB data functions
There's no need to duplicate code for the 192 vs 192+256 variants of the
OOB data functions. This is also helpful to pave the way to support LE
SC OOB data where only 256 bit data is provided.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:20 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
903b71c78d Bluetooth: Add SC-only mode support for SMP
When Secure Connections-only mode is enabled we should reject any
pairing command that does not have Secure Connections set in the
authentication requirements. This patch adds the appropriate logic for
this to the command handlers of Pairing Request/Response and Security
Request.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:20 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
b5ae344d4c Bluetooth: Add full SMP BR/EDR support
When doing SMP over BR/EDR some of the routines can be shared with the
LE functionality whereas others needs to be split into their own BR/EDR
specific branches. This patch implements the split of BR/EDR specific
SMP code from the LE-only code, making sure SMP over BR/EDR works as
specified.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:20 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
ef8efe4bf8 Bluetooth: Add skeleton for BR/EDR SMP channel
This patch adds the very basic code for creating and destroying SMP
L2CAP channels for BR/EDR connections.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:20 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
858cdc78be Bluetooth: Add debugfs switch for forcing SMP over BR/EDR
To make it possible to use LE SC functionality over BR/EDR with pre-4.1
controllers (that do not support BR/EDR SC links) it's useful to be able
to force LE SC operations even over a traditional SSP protected link.
This patch adds a debugfs switch to force a special debug flag which is
used to skip the checks for BR/EDR SC support.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:20 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
fe8bc5ac67 Bluetooth: Add hci_conn flag for new link key generation
For LE Secure Connections we want to trigger cross transport key
generation only if a new link key was actually created during the BR/EDR
connection. This patch adds a new flag to track this information.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:20 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
70157ef539 Bluetooth: Use debug keys for SMP when HCI_USE_DEBUG_KEYS is set
The HCI_USE_DEBUG_KEYS flag is intended to force our side to always use
debug keys for pairing. This means both BR/EDR SSP as well as SMP with
LE Secure Connections. This patch updates the SMP code to use the debug
keys instead of generating a random local key pair when the flag is set.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:19 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
1408bb6efb Bluetooth: Add dummy handler for LE SC keypress notification
Since we don not actively try to clear the keypress notification bit we
might get these PDUs. To avoid failing the pairing process add a simple
dummy handler for these for now.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:19 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
d3e54a876e Bluetooth: Fix DHKey Check sending order for slave role
According to the LE SC specification the initiating device sends its
DHKey check first and the non-initiating devices sends its DHKey check
as a response to this. It's also important that the non-initiating
device doesn't send the response if it's still waiting for user input.
In order to synchronize all this a new flag is added.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:19 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
38606f1418 Bluetooth: Add passkey entry support for LE SC
The passkey entry mechanism involves either both sides requesting the
user for a passkey, or one side requesting the passkey while the other
one displays it. The behavior as far as SMP PDUs are concerned are
considerably different from numeric comparison and therefore requires
several new functions to handle it.

In essence passkey entry involves both sides gradually committing to
each bit of the passkey which involves 20 rounds of pairing confirm and
pairing random PDUS being sent in both directions.

This patch adds a new smp->passkey_round variable to track the current
round of the passkey commitment and reuses the variables already present
in struct hci_conn for the passkey and entered key count.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:19 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
e3befab970 Bluetooth: Fix BR/EDR Link Key type when derived through LE SC
We need to set the correct Link Key type based on the properties of the
LE SC pairing that it was derived from. If debug keys were used the type
should be a debug key, and the authenticated vs unauthenticated
information should be set on what kind of security level was reached.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:19 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
dddd3059e3 Bluetooth: Add support for SC just-works pairing
If the just-works method was chosen we shouldn't send anything to user
space but simply proceed with sending the DHKey Check PDU. This patch
adds the necessary code for it.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:19 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
d378a2d776 Bluetooth: Set correct LTK type and authentication for SC
After generating the LTK we should set the correct type (normal SC or
debug) and authentication information for it.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:18 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
6c0dcc5014 Bluetooth: Add check for accidentally generating a debug key
It is very unlikely, but to have a 100% guarantee of the generated key
type we need to reject any keys which happen to match the debug key.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:18 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
aeb7d461f9 Bluetooth: Detect SMP SC debug keys
We need to be able to detect if the remote side used a debug key for the
pairing. This patch adds the debug key defines and sets a flag to
indicate that a debug key was used. The debug private key (debug_sk) is
also added in this patch but will only be used in a subsequent patch
when local debug key support is implemented.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:18 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
5e3d3d9b3c Bluetooth: Add selection of the SC authentication method
This patch adds code to select the authentication method for Secure
Connections based on the local and remote capabilities. A new
DSP_PASSKEY method is also added for displaying the passkey - something
that is not part of legacy SMP pairing.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:18 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
783e057462 Bluetooth: Track authentication method in SMP context
For Secure Connections we'll select the authentication method as soon as
we receive the public key, but only use it later (both when actually
triggering the method as well as when determining the quality of the
resulting LTK). Store the method therefore in the SMP context.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:18 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
6a77083af5 Bluetooth: Add support for LE SC key generation
As the last step of the LE SC pairing process it's time to generate and
distribute keys. The generation part is unique to LE SC and so this
patch adds a dedicated function for it. We also clear the distribution
bits for keys which are not distributed with LE SC, so that the code
shared with legacy SMP will not go ahead and try to distribute them.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:18 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
6433a9a2c4 Bluetooth: Add support for LE SC DHKey check PDU
Once we receive the DHKey check PDU it's time to first verify that the
value is correct and then proceed with encrypting the link.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:17 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
760b018b6c Bluetooth: Add support for handling LE SC user response
With LE SC, once the user has responded to the numeric comparison it's
time to send DHKey check values in both directions. The DHKey check
value is generated using new smp_f5 and smp_f6 cryptographic functions.
The smp_f5 function is responsible for generating the LTK and the MacKey
values whereas the smp_f6 function takes the MacKey as input and
generates the DHKey Check value.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:17 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
191dc7fe2d Bluetooth: Add support for LE SC numeric comparison
After the Pairing Confirm and Random PDUs have been exchanged in LE SC
it's time to generate a numeric comparison value using a new smp_g2
cryptographic function (which also builds on AES-CMAC). This patch adds
the smp_g2 implementation and updates the Pairing Random PDU handler to
proceed with the value genration and user confirmation.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:17 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
dcee2b3221 Bluetooth: Add LE SC support for responding to Pairing Confirm PDU
When LE SC is being used we should always respond to it by sending our
local random number. This patch adds a convenience function for it which
also contains a check for the pre-requisite public key exchange
completion

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:17 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
cbbbe3e242 Bluetooth: Add support for sending LE SC Confirm value
Once the public key exchange is complete the next step is for the
non-initiating device to send a SMP Pairing Confirm PDU to the
initiating device. This requires the use of a new smp_f4 confirm value
generation function which in turn builds on the AES-CMAC cryptographic
function.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:17 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
d8f8edbe93 Bluetooth: Add handler function for receiving LE SC public key
This patch adds a handler function for the LE SC SMP Public Key PDU.
When we receive the key we proceed with generating the shared DHKey
value from the remote public key and local private key.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:17 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
3b19146d23 Bluetooth: Add basic support for sending our LE SC public key
When the initial pairing request & response PDUs have been exchanged and
both have had the LE SC bit set the next step is to generate a ECDH
key pair and to send the public key to the remote side. This patch adds
basic support for generating the key pair and sending the public key
using the new Public Key SMP PDU. It is the initiating device that sends
the public key first and the non-initiating device responds by sending
its public key respectively (in a subsequent patch).

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:17 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
05ddb47a91 Bluetooth: Add ECC library for LE Secure Connections
This patch adds a simple ECC library that will act as a fundamental
building block for LE Secure Connections. The library has a simple API
consisting of two functions: one for generating a public/private key
pair and another one for generating a Diffie-Hellman key from a local
private key and a remote public key.

The code has been taken from https://github.com/kmackay/easy-ecc and
modified to conform with the kernel coding style.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:16 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
407cecf6c7 Bluetooth: Add basic support for AES-CMAC
Most of the LE Secure Connections SMP crypto functions build on top of
the AES-CMAC function. This patch adds access to AES-CMAC in the kernel
crypto subsystem by allocating a crypto_hash handle for it in a similar
way that we have one for AES-CBC.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:16 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
df8e1a4c73 Bluetooth: Set link key generation bit if necessary for LE SC
Depending on whether Secure Connections is enabled or not we may need to add
the link key generation bit to the key distribution. This patch does the
necessary modifications to the build_pairing_cmd() function.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:16 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
f3a73d97b3 Bluetooth: Rename hci_find_ltk_by_addr to hci_find_ltk
Now that hci_find_ltk_by_addr is the only LTK lookup function there's no
need to keep the long name anymore. This patch shortens the function
name to simply hci_find_ltk.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:16 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
0ac3dbf999 Bluetooth: Remove unused hci_find_ltk function
Now that LTKs are always looked up based on bdaddr (with EDiv/Rand
checks done after a successful lookup) the hci_find_ltk function is not
needed anymore. This patch removes the function.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:16 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
5378bc5622 Bluetooth: Update LTK lookup to correctly deal with SC LTKs
LTKs derived from Secure Connections based pairing are symmetric, i.e.
they should match both master and slave role. This patch updates the LTK
lookup functions to ignore the desired role when dealing with SC LTKs.

Furthermore, with Secure Connections the EDiv and Rand values are not
used and should always be set to zero. This patch updates the LTK lookup
to first use the bdaddr as key and then do the necessary verifications
of EDiv and Rand based on whether the found LTK is for SC or not.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:16 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
a3209694f8 Bluetooth: Add mgmt_set_secure_conn support for any LE adapter
Since LE Secure Connections is a purely host-side feature we should
offer the Secure Connections mgmt setting for any adapter with LE
support. This patch updates the supported settings value and the
set_secure_conn command handler accordingly.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:15 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
710f11c08e Bluetooth: Use custom macro for testing BR/EDR SC enabled
Since the HCI_SC_ENABLED flag will also be used for controllers without
BR/EDR Secure Connections support whenever we need to check specifically
for SC for BR/EDR we also need to check that the controller actually
supports it. This patch adds a convenience macro for check all the
necessary conditions and converts the places in the code that need it to
use it.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:15 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
8f5eeca321 Bluetooth: Set the correct security level for SC LTKs
When the looked-up LTK is one generated by Secure Connections pairing
the security level it gives is BT_SECURITY_FIPS. This patch updates the
LTK request event handler to correctly set this level.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:15 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
23fb8de376 Bluetooth: Add mgmt support for LE Secure Connections LTK types
We need a dedicated LTK type for LTK resulting from a Secure Connections
based SMP pairing. This patch adds a new define for it and ensures that
both the New LTK event as well as the Load LTKs command supports it.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:15 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
d2eb9e10f7 Bluetooth: Update SMP security level to/from auth_req for SC
This patch updates the functions which map the SMP authentication
request to a security level and vice-versa to take into account the
Secure Connections feature.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:15 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
6566877694 Bluetooth: Add SMP flag for SC and set it when necessary.
This patch adds a new SMP flag for tracking whether Secure Connections
is in use and sets the flag when both remote and local side have elected
to use Secure Connections.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:15 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
0edb14de56 Bluetooth: Make auth_req mask dependent on SC enabled or not
If we haven't enabled SC support on our side we should use the same mask
for the authentication requirement as we were using before SC support
was added, otherwise we should use the extended mask for SC.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:14 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
e65392e2cc Bluetooth: Add basic SMP defines for LE Secure Connections
This patch adds basic SMP defines for commands, error codes and PDU
definitions for the LE Secure Connections feature.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 16:51:14 +01:00
Jozsef Kadlecsik
cac3763967 netfilter: ipset: Explicitly add padding elements to hash:net, net and hash:net, port, net
The elements must be u32 sized for the used hash function.

Signed-off-by: Jozsef Kadlecsik <kadlec@blackhole.kfki.hu>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-03 12:43:36 +01:00
Jozsef Kadlecsik
77b4311d20 netfilter: ipset: Allocate the proper size of memory when /0 networks are supported
Signed-off-by: Jozsef Kadlecsik <kadlec@blackhole.kfki.hu>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-03 12:43:36 +01:00
Jozsef Kadlecsik
25a76f3463 netfilter: ipset: Simplify cidr handling for hash:*net* types
Signed-off-by: Jozsef Kadlecsik <kadlec@blackhole.kfki.hu>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-03 12:43:36 +01:00
Jozsef Kadlecsik
59de79cf57 netfilter: ipset: Indicate when /0 networks are supported
Signed-off-by: Jozsef Kadlecsik <kadlec@blackhole.kfki.hu>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-03 12:43:36 +01:00
Jozsef Kadlecsik
a51b9199b1 netfilter: ipset: Alignment problem between 64bit kernel 32bit userspace
Sven-Haegar Koch reported the issue:

sims:~# iptables -A OUTPUT -m set --match-set testset src -j ACCEPT
iptables: Invalid argument. Run `dmesg' for more information.

In syslog:
x_tables: ip_tables: set.3 match: invalid size 48 (kernel) != (user) 32

which was introduced by the counter extension in ipset.

The patch fixes the alignment issue with introducing a new set match
revision with the fixed underlying 'struct ip_set_counter_match'
structure.

Signed-off-by: Jozsef Kadlecsik <kadlec@blackhole.kfki.hu>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-03 12:43:35 +01:00
Jozsef Kadlecsik
86ac79c7be netfilter: ipset: Support updating extensions when the set is full
When the set was full (hash type and maxelem reached), it was not
possible to update the extension part of already existing elements.
The patch removes this limitation.

Fixes: https://bugzilla.netfilter.org/show_bug.cgi?id=880
Signed-off-by: Jozsef Kadlecsik <kadlec@blackhole.kfki.hu>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-12-03 12:43:34 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
82c13d42bb Bluetooth: Simplify Link Key Notification event handling logic
When we get a Link Key Notification HCI event we should already have a
hci_conn object. This should have been created either in the Connection
Request event handler, the hci_connect_acl() function or the
hci_cs_create_conn() function (if the request was not sent by the
kernel).

Since the only case that we'd end up not having a hci_conn in the Link
Key Notification event handler would be essentially broken hardware it's
safe to simply bail out from the function if this happens.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-03 10:39:43 +01:00
Scott Feldman
2c3c031c8f bridge: add brport flags to dflt bridge_getlink
To allow brport device to return current brport flags set on port.  Add
returned flags to nested IFLA_PROTINFO netlink msg built in dflt getlink.
With this change, netlink msg returned for bridge_getlink contains the port's
offloaded flag settings (the port's SELF settings).

Signed-off-by: Scott Feldman <sfeldma@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Andy Gospodarek <gospo@cumulusnetworks.com>
Acked-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Acked-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:24 -08:00
Scott Feldman
065c212a9e bridge: move private brport flags to if_bridge.h so port drivers can use flags
Signed-off-by: Scott Feldman <sfeldma@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Acked-by: Andy Gospodarek <gospo@cumulusnetworks.com>
Acked-by: Florian Fainelli <f.fainelli@gmail.com
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:22 -08:00
Scott Feldman
cf6b8e1eed bridge: add API to notify bridge driver of learned FBD on offloaded device
When the swdev device learns a new mac/vlan on a port, it sends some async
notification to the driver and the driver installs an FDB in the device.
To give a holistic system view, the learned mac/vlan should be reflected
in the bridge's FBD table, so the user, using normal iproute2 cmds, can view
what is currently learned by the device.  This API on the bridge driver gives
a way for the swdev driver to install an FBD entry in the bridge FBD table.
(And remove one).

This is equivalent to the device running these cmds:

  bridge fdb [add|del] <mac> dev <dev> vid <vlan id> master

This patch needs some extra eyeballs for review, in paricular around the
locking and contexts.

Signed-off-by: Scott Feldman <sfeldma@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:22 -08:00
Scott Feldman
38dcf357ae bridge: call netdev_sw_port_stp_update when bridge port STP status changes
To notify switch driver of change in STP state of bridge port, add new
.ndo op and provide switchdev wrapper func to call ndo op. Use it in bridge
code then.

Signed-off-by: Scott Feldman <sfeldma@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Signed-off-by: Andy Gospodarek <gospo@cumulusnetworks.com>
Acked-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Acked-by: Florian Fainelli <f.fainelli@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:22 -08:00
Jiri Pirko
aecbe01e74 net-sysfs: expose physical switch id for particular device
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Reviewed-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Acked-by: John Fastabend <john.r.fastabend@intel.com>
Acked-by: Andy Gospodarek <gospo@cumulusnetworks.com>
Acked-by: Florian Fainelli <f.fainelli@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:22 -08:00
Jiri Pirko
82f2841291 rtnl: expose physical switch id for particular device
The netdevice represents a port in a switch, it will expose
IFLA_PHYS_SWITCH_ID value via rtnl. Two netdevices with the same value
belong to one physical switch.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Reviewed-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Acked-by: John Fastabend <john.r.fastabend@intel.com>
Acked-by: Andy Gospodarek <gospo@cumulusnetworks.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:21 -08:00
Jiri Pirko
007f790c82 net: introduce generic switch devices support
The goal of this is to provide a possibility to support various switch
chips. Drivers should implement relevant ndos to do so. Now there is
only one ndo defined:
- for getting physical switch id is in place.

Note that user can use random port netdevice to access the switch.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Reviewed-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Acked-by: Andy Gospodarek <gospo@cumulusnetworks.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:20 -08:00
Jiri Pirko
02637fce3e net: rename netdev_phys_port_id to more generic name
So this can be reused for identification of other "items" as well.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Reviewed-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Acked-by: John Fastabend <john.r.fastabend@intel.com>
Acked-by: Andy Gospodarek <gospo@cumulusnetworks.com>
Acked-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:19 -08:00
Jiri Pirko
f6f6424ba7 net: make vid as a parameter for ndo_fdb_add/ndo_fdb_del
Do the work of parsing NDA_VLAN directly in rtnetlink code, pass simple
u16 vid to drivers from there.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Andy Gospodarek <gospo@cumulusnetworks.com>
Acked-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Acked-by: John Fastabend <john.r.fastabend@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:18 -08:00
Jiri Pirko
93859b13fa bridge: convert flags in fbd entry into bitfields
Suggested-by: Florian Fainelli <f.fainelli@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:17 -08:00
Jiri Pirko
020ec6ba2a bridge: rename fdb_*_hw to fdb_*_hw_addr to avoid confusion
The current name might seem that this actually offloads the fdb entry to
hw. So rename it to clearly present that this for hardware address
addition/removal.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Andy Gospodarek <gospo@cumulusnetworks.com>
Acked-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Acked-by: Florian Fainelli <f.fainelli@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-12-02 20:01:16 -08:00
Julien Lefrique
e479ce4797 NFC: NCI: Fix max length of General Bytes in ATR_RES
The maximum size of ATR_REQ and ATR_RES is 64 bytes.
The maximum number of General Bytes is calculated by
the maximum number of data bytes in the ATR_REQ/ATR_RES,
substracted by the number of mandatory data bytes.

ATR_REQ: 16 mandatory data bytes, giving a maximum of
48 General Bytes.
ATR_RES: 17 mandatory data bytes, giving a maximum of
47 General Bytes.

Regression introduced in commit a99903ec.

Signed-off-by: Julien Lefrique <lefrique@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 22:59:28 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
3ff24012dd NFC: nci: Fix warning: cast to restricted __le16
Fixing: net/nfc/nci/ntf.c:106:31: warning: cast to restricted __le16
message when building with make C=1 CF=-D__CHECK_ENDIAN__

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 22:49:17 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
e5b53c0a2e NFC: Fix warning "warning: incorrect type in assignment"
Fix warnings:
net/nfc/llcp_commands.c:421:14: warning: incorrect type in assignment (different base types)
net/nfc/llcp_commands.c:421:14:    expected unsigned short [unsigned] [usertype] miux
net/nfc/llcp_commands.c:421:14:    got restricted __be16
net/nfc/llcp_commands.c:477:14: warning: incorrect type in assignment (different base types)
net/nfc/llcp_commands.c:477:14:    expected unsigned short [unsigned] [usertype] miux
net/nfc/llcp_commands.c:477:14:    got restricted __be16

Procedure to reproduce:
make ARCH=x86_64 allmodconfig
make C=1 CF=-D__CHECK_ENDIAN__

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 22:49:15 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
b3a55b9c5d NFC: hci: Add specific hci macro to not create a pipe
Some pipe are only created by other host (different than the
Terminal Host).
The pipe values will for example be notified by
NFC_HCI_ADM_NOTIFY_PIPE_CREATED.

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 22:48:13 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
cd96db6fd0 NFC: Add se_io NFC operand
se_io allows to send apdu over the CLF to the embedded
Secure Element.

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 22:47:56 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
3682f49f32 NFC: netlink: Add new netlink command NFC_CMD_ACTIVATE_TARGET
Some tag might get deactivated after some read or write tentative.
This may happen for example with Mifare Ultralight C tag when trying
to read the last 4 blocks (starting block 0x2c) configured as write
only.
NFC_CMD_ACTIVATE_TARGET will try to reselect the tag in order to
detect if it got remove from the field or if it is still present.

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 22:47:37 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
9295b5b569 NFC: nci: Add support for different NCI_DEACTIVATE_TYPE
nci_rf_deactivate_req only support NCI_DEACTIVATE_TYPE_IDLE_MODE.
In some situation, it might be necessary to be able to support other
NCI_DEACTIVATE_TYPE such as NCI_DEACTIVATE_TYPE_SLEEP_MODE in order for
example to reactivate the selected target.

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 22:47:17 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
4391590c40 NFC: nci: Add management for NCI state for machine rf_deactivate_ntf
A notification for rf deaction can be IDLE_MODE, SLEEP_MODE,
SLEEP_AF_MODE and DISCOVERY. According to each type and the NCI
state machine is different (see figure 10 RF Communication State
Machine in NCI specification)

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 22:47:07 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
98ff416f97 NFC: nci: Add status byte management in case of error.
The nci status byte was ignored. In case of tag reading for example,
if the tag is removed from the antenna there is no way for the upper
layers (aka: stack) to get inform about such event.

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 22:46:47 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
0bd49fc75a Bluetooth: Track both local and remote L2CAP fixed channel mask
To pave the way for future fixed channels to be added easily we should
track both the local and remote mask on a per-L2CAP connection (struct
l2cap_conn) basis. So far the code has used a global variable in a racy
way which anyway needs fixing.

This patch renames the existing conn->fixed_chan_mask that tracked
the remote mask to conn->remote_fixed_chan and adds a new variable
conn->local_fixed_chan to track the local mask. Since the HS support
info is now available in the local mask we can remove the
conn->hs_enabled variable.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-12-02 09:26:50 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
a2ae218298 NFC: hci: Add support for NOTIFY_ALL_PIPE_CLEARED
When switching from UICC to another, the CLF may signals to the Terminal
Host that some existing pipe are cleared for future update.

This notification needs to be "acked" by the Terminal Host with a ANY_OK
message.

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 02:02:00 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
deff5aa469 NFC: hci: Add open pipe command handler
If our terminal connect with other host like UICC, it may create
a pipe with us, the host controller will notify us new pipe
created, after that UICC will open that pipe, if we don't handle
that request, UICC may failed to continue initialize which may
lead to card emulation feature failed to work

Signed-off-by: Arron Wang <arron.wang@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 02:02:00 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
a688bf55c5 NFC: nci: Add se_io NCI operand
se_io allows to send apdu over the CLF to the embedded Secure Element.

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 02:01:21 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
e9ef9431a3 NFC: nci: Update nci_disable_se to run proprietary commands to disable a secure element
Some NFC controller using NCI protocols may need a proprietary commands
flow to disable a secure element

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 02:01:21 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
93bca2bfa4 NFC: nci: Update nci_enable_se to run proprietary commands to enable a secure element
Some NFC controller using NCI protocols may need a proprietary commands
flow to enable a secure element

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 02:01:21 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
ba4db551bb NFC: nci: Update nci_discover_se to run proprietary commands to discover all available secure element
Some NFC controller using NCI protocols may need a proprietary commands
flow to discover all available secure element

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 02:01:21 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
c7dea2525b NFC: nci: Fix sparse: symbol 'nci_get_prop_rf_protocol' was not declared.
Fix sparse warning introduced by commit: 9e87f9a9c4

It was generating the following warning:
net/nfc/nci/ntf.c:170:7: sparse: symbol 'nci_get_prop_rf_protocol' was not declared. Should it be static?

Procedure to reproduce it:
# apt-get install sparse
  git checkout 9e87f9a9c4
  make ARCH=x86_64 allmodconfig
  make C=1 CF=-D__CHECK_ENDIAN__

Signed-off-by: Fengguang Wu <fengguang.wu@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 01:50:42 +01:00
Christophe Ricard
9b8d32b7ac NFC: hci: Add se_io HCI operand
se_io allows to send apdu over the CLF to the embedded Secure Element.

Signed-off-by: Christophe Ricard <christophe-h.ricard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-12-02 01:49:58 +01:00
John W. Linville
992066c8d3 Merge branch 'for-upstream' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/bluetooth/bluetooth-next 2014-12-01 15:49:58 -05:00
Jeff Layton
067f96ef17 sunrpc: release svc_pool_map reference when serv allocation fails
Currently, it leaks when the allocation fails.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-01 12:45:27 -07:00
Jeff Layton
8d65ef760d sunrpc: eliminate the XPT_DETACHED flag
All it does is indicate whether a xprt has already been deleted from
a list or not, which is unnecessary since we use list_del_init and it's
always set and checked under the sv_lock anyway.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-12-01 12:45:26 -07:00
Nicolas Dichtel
e0ebde0e13 rtnetlink: release net refcnt on error in do_setlink()
rtnl_link_get_net() holds a reference on the 'struct net', we need to release
it in case of error.

CC: Eric W. Biederman <ebiederm@xmission.com>
Fixes: b51642f6d7 ("net: Enable a userns root rtnl calls that are safe for unprivilged users")
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Dichtel <nicolas.dichtel@6wind.com>
Reviewed-by: "Eric W. Biederman" <ebiederm@xmission.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-29 21:05:43 -08:00
David S. Miller
60b7379dc5 Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net 2014-11-29 20:47:48 -08:00
Steven Noonan
4338c57259 netfilter: nf_log_ipv6: correct typo in module description
It incorrectly identifies itself as "IPv4" packet logging.

Signed-off-by: Steven Noonan <steven@uplinklabs.net>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-28 17:28:17 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
f027c2aca0 mac80211: add ieee80211_tx_status_noskb
This can be used by drivers that cannot reliably map tx status
information onto specific skbs.

Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 15:01:51 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
7e1cdcbb09 mac0211: add a helper function for fixing up tx status rates
Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 15:01:50 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
ad9dda6383 mac80211: pass tx info to ieee80211_lost_packet instead of an skb
Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 15:01:50 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
63558a650a mac80211: minstrel_ht: switch to .tx_status_noskb
Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 15:01:50 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
fb7acfb8e1 mac80211: minstrel: switch to .tx_status_noskb
Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 15:01:50 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
f684565e0a mac80211: add tx_status_noskb to rate_control_ops
This op works like .tx_status, except it does not need access to the
skb. This will be used by drivers that cannot match tx status
information to specific packets.

Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 15:01:50 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
95943425c0 mac80211: minstrel_ht: move aggregation check to .get_rate()
Preparation for adding a no-skb tx status path

Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 15:01:50 +01:00
Johannes Berg
ea372c5452 cfg80211: remove unneeded initialisations in nl80211_set_reg
Some variables are assigned unconditionally, remove their
initialisations to help avoid introducing errors later.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:54:31 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
ad932f046f cfg80211: leave invalid channels on regdomain change
When the regulatory settings change, some channels might become invalid.
Disconnect interfaces acting on these channels, after giving userspace
code a grace period to leave them.

This mode is currently opt-in, and not all interface operating modes are
supported for regulatory-enforcement checks. A wiphy that wishes to use
the new enforcement code must specify an appropriate regulatory flag,
and all its supported interface modes must be supported by the checking
code.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Luis R. Rodriguez <mcgrof@suse.com>
[fix some indentation, typos]
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:33:41 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
336004e291 mac80211: add more missing checks for VHT tx rates
Fixes a crash on attempting to calculate the frame duration for a VHT
packet (which needs to be handled by hw/driver instead).

Reported-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:24:23 +01:00
Julien Lefrique
d7979e130e NFC: NCI: Signal deactivation in Target mode
Before signaling the deactivation, send a deactivation request if in
RFST_DISCOVERY state because neard assumes polling is stopped and will
try to restart it.

Signed-off-by: Julien Lefrique <lefrique@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:07:51 +01:00
Julien Lefrique
6ff5462b67 NFC: NCI: Handle Discovery deactivation type
When the deactivation type reported by RF_DEACTIVATE_NTF is Discovery, go in
RFST_DISCOVERY state. The NFCC stays in Poll mode and/or Listen mode.

Signed-off-by: Julien Lefrique <lefrique@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:07:51 +01:00
Julien Lefrique
966efbfb0d NFC: Fix a memory leak
Signed-off-by: Julien Lefrique <lefrique@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:07:51 +01:00
Julien Lefrique
122c195872 NFC: NCI: Forward data received in Target mode to nfc core
Signed-off-by: Julien Lefrique <lefrique@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:07:51 +01:00
Julien Lefrique
485f442fd5 NFC: NCI: Implement Target mode send function
As specified in NCI 1.0 and NCI 1.1, when using the NFC-DEP RF Interface, the
DH and the NFCC shall only use the Static RF Connection for data communication
with a Remote NFC Endpoint.

Signed-off-by: Julien Lefrique <lefrique@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:07:51 +01:00
Julien Lefrique
529ee06682 NFC: NCI: Configure ATR_RES general bytes
The Target responds to the ATR_REQ with the ATR_RES. Configure the General
Bytes in ATR_RES with the first three octets equal to the NFC Forum LLCP
magic number, followed by some LLC Parameters TLVs described in section
4.5 of [LLCP].

Signed-off-by: Julien Lefrique <lefrique@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:07:51 +01:00
Julien Lefrique
a99903ec45 NFC: NCI: Handle Target mode activation
Changes:

 * Extract the Listen mode activation parameters from RF_INTF_ACTIVATED_NTF.

 * Store the General Bytes of ATR_REQ.

 * Signal that Target mode is activated in case of an activation in NFC-DEP.

 * Update the NCI state accordingly.

 * Use the various constants defined in nfc.h.

 * Fix the ATR_REQ and ATR_RES maximum size. As per NCI 1.0 and NCI 1.1, the
   Activation Parameters for both Poll and Listen mode contain all the bytes of
   ATR_REQ/ATR_RES starting and including Byte 3 as defined in [DIGITAL].
   In [DIGITAL], the maximum size of ATR_REQ/ATR_RES is 64 bytes and they are
   numbered starting from Byte 1.

Signed-off-by: Julien Lefrique <lefrique@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:07:51 +01:00
Julien Lefrique
90d78c1396 NFC: NCI: Enable NFC-DEP in Listen A and Listen F
Send LA_SEL_INFO and LF_PROTOCOL_TYPE with NFC-DEP protocol enabled.
Configure 212 Kbit/s and 412 Kbit/s bit rates for Listen F.

Signed-off-by: Julien Lefrique <lefrique@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:07:51 +01:00
Julien Lefrique
772dccf4a7 NFC: NCI: Add passive Listen modes in discover request
The Target mode protocols are given to the nci_start_poll() function
but were previously ignored.
To enable P2P Target, when NFC-DEP is requested as a Target mode protocol, add
NFC-A and NFC-F Passive Listen modes in RF_DISCOVER_CMD command.

Signed-off-by: Julien Lefrique <lefrique@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 14:07:51 +01:00
Axel Lin
413df10bbf NFC: llcp: Use list_for_each_entry in llcp_accept_poll
list_for_each_entry_safe() is necessary if list objects are deleted from
the list while traversing it. Not the case here, so we can use the base
list_for_each_entry variant.

Signed-off-by: Axel Lin <axel.lin@ingics.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 13:41:44 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
9b5ec0fd58 NFC: digital: Add NFC-DEP Target-side ATN Support
When an NFC-DEP target receives an ATN PDU, its
supposed to respond with a similar ATN PDU.
When the Target receives an I PDU with the PNI
one less than the current PNI and the last PDU
sent was an ATN PDU, the Target is to resend the
last non-ATN PDU that it has sent.  This is
described in section 14.12.3.4 of the NFC Digital
Protocol Spec.

The digital layer's NFC-DEP code doesn't implement
this so add that support.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:40:38 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
384ab1d174 NFC: digital: Add NFC-DEP Initiator-side ATN Support
When an NFC-DEP Initiator times out when waiting for
a DEP_RES from the Target, its supposed to send an
ATN to the Target.  The Target should respond to the
ATN with a similar ATN PDU and the Initiator can then
resend the last non-ATN PDU that it sent.  No more
than 'N(retry,atn)' are to be send where
2 <= 'N(retry,atn)' <= 5.  If the Initiator had just
sent a NACK PDU when the timeout occurred, it is to
continue sending NACKs until 'N(retry,nack)' NACKs
have been send.  This is described in section
14.12.5.6 of the NFC-DEP Digital Protocol Spec.

The digital layer's NFC-DEP code doesn't implement
this so add that support.

The value chosen for 'N(retry,atn)' is 2.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:39:55 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
49dbb14e30 NFC: digital: Add NFC-DEP Target-side NACK Support
When an NFC-DEP Target receives a NACK PDU with
a PNI equal to 1 less than the current PNI, it
is supposed to re-send the last PDU.  This is
implied in section 14.12.5.4 of the NFC Digital
Protocol Spec.

The digital layer's NFC-DEP code doesn't implement
Target-side NACK handing so add it.  The last PDU
that was sent is saved in the 'nfc_digital_dev'
structure's 'saved_skb' member.  The skb will have
an additional reference taken to ensure that the skb
isn't freed when the driver performs a kfree_skb()
on the skb.  The length of the skb/PDU is also saved
so the length can be restored when re-sending the PDU
in the skb (the driver will perform an skb_pull() so
an skb_push() needs to be done to restore the skb's
data pointer/length).

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:39:47 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
a80509c76b NFC: digital: Add NFC-DEP Initiator-side NACK Support
When an NFC-DEP Initiator receives a frame with
an incorrect CRC or with a parity error, and the
frame is at least 4 bytes long, its supposed to
send a NACK to the Target.  The Initiator can
send up to 'N(retry,nack)' consecutive NACKs
where 2 <= 'N(retry,nack)' <= 5.  When the limit
is exceeded, a PROTOCOL EXCEPTION is raised.
Any other type of transmission error is to be
ignored and the Initiator should continue
waiting for a new frame.  This is described
in section 14.12.5.4 of the NFC Digital Protocol
Spec.

The digital layer's NFC-DEP code doesn't implement
any of this so add it.  This support diverges from
the spec in two significant ways:

a) NACKs will be sent for ANY error reported by the
   driver except a timeout.  This is done because
   there is currently no way for the digital layer
   to distinguish a CRC or parity error from any
   other type of error reported by the driver.

b) All other errors will cause a PROTOCOL EXCEPTION
   even frames with CRC errors that are less than 4
   bytes.

The value chosen for 'N(retry,nack)' is 2.

Targets do not send NACK PDUs.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:39:33 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
c12715ab3f NFC: digital: Add NFC-DEP Receive Chaining Support
When the peer in an NFC-DEP exchange has a
packet to send that is larger than the local
maximum payload, it sets the 'MI' bit in the
'I' PDU.  This indicates that NFC-DEP chaining
is to occur.

When such a PDU is received, the local side
responds with an 'ACK' PDU and this continues
until the peer sends an 'I' PDU with the 'MI'
bit cleared.  This indicates that the chaining
sequence is complete and the entire packet has
been transferred.

Receiving chained PDUs is currently not supported
by the digital layer so add that support.  When a
chaining sequence is initiated by the peer, the
digital layer will allocate an skb large enough
to hold 8 maximum sized frame payloads.  The maximum
payload can range from 64 to 254 bytes so 8 * 254 =
2032 seems like a reasonable compromise between
potentially wasting memory and constantly reallocating
new, larger skbs.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:39:21 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
3bd2a5bcc6 NFC: digital: Add NFC-DEP Send Chaining Support
When the NFC-DEP code is given a packet to send
that is larger than the peer's maximum payload,
its supposed to set the 'MI' bit in the 'I' PDU's
Protocol Frame Byte (PFB).  Setting this bit
indicates that NFC-DEP chaining is to occur.

When NFC-DEP chaining is progress, sender 'I' PDUs
are acknowledged with 'ACK' PDUs until the last 'I'
PDU in the chain (which has the 'MI' bit cleared)
is responded to with a normal 'I' PDU.  This can
occur while in Initiator mode or in Target mode.

Sender NFC-DEP chaining is currently not implemented
in the digital layer so add that support.  Unfortunately,
since sending a frame may require writing the CRC to the
end of the data, the relevant data part of the original
skb must be copied for each intermediate frame.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:39:10 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
b08147cbc4 NFC: digital: Implement NFC-DEP max payload lengths
The maximum payload for NFC-DEP exchanges (i.e., the
number of bytes between SoD and EoD) is negotiated
using the ATR_REQ, ATR_RES, and PSL_REQ commands.
The valid maximum lengths are 64, 128, 192, and 254
bytes.

Currently, NFC-DEP code assumes that both sides are
always using 254 byte maximums and ignores attempts
by the peer to change it.  Instead, implement the
negotiation code, enforce the local maximum when
receiving data from the peer, and don't send payloads
that exceed the remote's maximum.  The default local
maximum is 254 bytes.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:38:59 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
485fdc9bb6 NFC: digital: Enforce NFC-DEP PNI sequencing
NFC-DEP DEP_REQ and DEP_RES exchanges using 'I'
and 'ACK/NACK' PDUs have a sequence number called
the Packet Number Information (PNI).  The PNI
is incremented (modulo 4) after every DEP_REQ/
DEP_RES pair and should be verified by the digital
layer code.  That verification isn't always done,
though, so add code to make sure that it is done.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:38:47 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
3e6b0de805 NFC: digital: Ensure no NAD byte in DEP_REQ and DEP_RES frames
According to chapter 14 of the NFC-DEP Digital
Protocol Spec., the NAD byte should never be
present in DEP_REQ or DEP_RES frames.  However,
this is not enforced so add that enforcement code.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:38:36 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
05afedcb89 NFC: digital: Add Target-mode NFC-DEP DID Support
When in Target mode, the Initiator specifies whether
subsequent DEP_REQ and DEP_RES frames will include
a DID byte by the value passed in the ATR_REQ.  If
the DID value in the ATR_REQ is '0' then no DID
byte will be included.  If the DID value is between
'1' and '14' then a DID byte containing the same
value must be included in subsequent DEP_REQ and
DEP_RES frames.  Any other DID value is invalid.
This is specified in sections 14.8.1.2 and 14.8.2.2
of the NFC Digital Protocol Spec.

Checking the DID value (if it should be there at all),
is not currently supported by the digital layer's
NFC-DEP code.  Add this support by remembering the
DID value in the ATR_REQ, checking the DID value of
received DEP_REQ frames (if it should be there at all),
and including the remembered DID value in DEP_RES
frames when appropriate.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:38:24 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
3bc3f88af5 NFC: digital: Ensure no DID in NFC-DEP responses
When in Initiator mode, the digital layer's
NFC-DEP code always sets the Device ID (DID)
value in the ATR_REQ to '0'.  This means that
subsequent DEP_REQ and DEP_RES frames must
never include a DID byte.  This is specified
in sections 14.8.1.1 and 14.8.2.1 of the NFC
Digital Protocol Spec.

Currently, the digital layer's NFC-DEP code
doesn't enforce this rule so add code to ensure
that there is no DID byte in DEP_RES frames.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:38:10 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
6ce306682f NFC: digital: Rearrange NFC-DEP DEP_REQ/DEP_RES Code
Rearrange some of the code in digital_in_recv_dep_res()
and digital_tg_recv_dep_req() so the initial code looks
similar.  The real reason is prepare the code for some
upcoming patches that require these changes.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:37:58 +01:00
Mark A. Greer
b15829ba5e NFC: digital: Fix potential skb leaks in NFC-DEP code
When digital_in_send_cmd() or digital_tg_send_cmd()
fail, they do not free the skb that was passed to
them so the routine that allocated the skb should
free it.  Currently, there are several routines in
the NFC-DEP code that don't do this so make them.

Reviewed-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Thierry Escande <thierry.escande@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark A. Greer <mgreer@animalcreek.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Ortiz <sameo@linux.intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:37:47 +01:00
Johannes Berg
24a0aa212e cfg80211: make WEXT compatibility unselectable
This option has been marked for deprecation and removal for
a little more than two years, but it's not been very clearly
signalled since it was always possible to just select it.

Make it unselectable now to signal anyone who's still using
it after all this time more clearly. They can still get it
back, but only by patching the kernel.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 12:21:34 +01:00
Linus Torvalds
8e8459719c Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net
Pull networking fixes from David Miller:
 "Several small fixes here:

   1) Don't crash in tg3 driver when the number of tx queues has been
      configured to be different from the number of rx queues.  From
      Thadeu Lima de Souza Cascardo.

   2) VLAN filter not disabled properly in promisc mode in ixgbe driver,
      from Vlad Yasevich.

   3) Fix OOPS on dellink op in VTI tunnel driver, from Xin Long.

   4) IPV6 GRE driver WCCP code checks skb->protocol for ETH_P_IP
      instead of ETH_P_IPV6, whoops.  From Yuri Chislov.

   5) Socket matching in ping driver is buggy when packet AF does not
      match socket's AF.  Fix from Jane Zhou.

   6) Fix checksum calculation errors in VXLAN due to where the
      udp_tunnel6_xmit_skb() helper gets it's saddr/daddr from.  From
      Alexander Duyck.

   7) Fix 5G detection problem in rtlwifi driver, from Larry Finger.

   8) Fix NULL deref in tcp_v{4,6}_send_reset, from Eric Dumazet.

   9) Various missing netlink attribute verifications in bridging code,
      from Thomas Graf.

  10) tcp_recvmsg() unconditionally calls ipv4 ip_recv_error even for
      ipv6 sockets, whoops.  Fix from Willem de Bruijn"

* git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net: (29 commits)
  net-timestamp: make tcp_recvmsg call ipv6_recv_error for AF_INET6 socks
  bridge: Sanitize IFLA_EXT_MASK for AF_BRIDGE:RTM_GETLINK
  bridge: Add missing policy entry for IFLA_BRPORT_FAST_LEAVE
  net: Check for presence of IFLA_AF_SPEC
  net: Validate IFLA_BRIDGE_MODE attribute length
  bridge: Validate IFLA_BRIDGE_FLAGS attribute length
  stmmac: platform: fix default values of the filter bins setting
  net/mlx4_core: Limit count field to 24 bits in qp_alloc_res
  net: dsa: bcm_sf2: reset switch prior to initialization
  net: dsa: bcm_sf2: fix unmapping registers in case of errors
  tg3: fix ring init when there are more TX than RX channels
  tcp: fix possible NULL dereference in tcp_vX_send_reset()
  rtlwifi: Change order in device startup
  rtlwifi: rtl8821ae: Fix 5G detection problem
  Revert "netfilter: conntrack: fix race in __nf_conntrack_confirm against get_next_corpse"
  vxlan: Fix boolean flip in VXLAN_F_UDP_ZERO_CSUM6_[TX|RX]
  ip6_udp_tunnel: Fix checksum calculation
  net-timestamp: Fix a documentation typo
  net/ping: handle protocol mismatching scenario
  af_packet: fix sparse warning
  ...
2014-11-27 18:05:05 -08:00
Jeff Layton
388f0c7767 sunrpc: add a debugfs rpc_xprt directory with an info file in it
Add a new directory heirarchy under the debugfs sunrpc/ directory:

    sunrpc/
        rpc_xprt/
            <xprt id>/

Within that directory, we can put files that give info about the
xprts. We do have the (minor) problem that there is no succinct,
unique identifier for rpc_xprts. So we generate them synthetically
with a static atomic_t counter.

For now, this directory just holds an "info" file, but we may add
other files to it in the future.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: Trond Myklebust <trond.myklebust@primarydata.com>
2014-11-27 13:14:52 -05:00
Jeff Layton
b4b9d2ccf0 sunrpc: add debugfs file for displaying client rpc_task queue
It's possible to get a dump of the RPC task queue by writing a value to
/proc/sys/sunrpc/rpc_debug. If you write any value to that file, you get
a dump of the RPC client task list into the log buffer. This is a rather
inconvenient interface however, and makes it hard to get immediate info
about the task queue.

Add a new directory hierarchy under debugfs:

    sunrpc/
        rpc_clnt/
            <clientid>/

Within each clientid directory we create a new "tasks" file that will
dump info similar to what shows up in the log buffer, but with a few
small differences -- we avoid printing raw kernel addresses in favor of
symbolic names and the XID is also displayed.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: Trond Myklebust <trond.myklebust@primarydata.com>
2014-11-27 13:14:51 -05:00
Felix Fietkau
2967e031d4 mac80211: copy chandef from AP vif to VLANs
Instead of keeping track of all those special cases where
VLAN interfaces have no bss_conf.chandef, just make sure
they have the same as the AP interface they belong to.

Among others, this fixes a crash getting a VLAN's channel
from userspace since a NULL channel is returned as a good
result (return value 0) for VLANs since the commit below.

Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org [3.18 only]
Fixes: c12bc4885f ("mac80211: return the vif's chandef in ieee80211_cfg_get_channel()")
Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
[rewrite commit log]
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-27 17:36:47 +01:00
Johannes Berg
601555cd75 nl80211: don't crash sending invalid chandef
One of the cases for an invalid channel definition is that
the channel pointer is NULL, in which case the warning is
a bit late since we'll dereference the pointer. Bail out
of the function upon warning about this.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-27 17:27:52 +01:00
Pablo Neira Ayuso
b59eaf9e28 netfilter: combine IPv4 and IPv6 nf_nat_redirect code in one module
This resolves linking problems with CONFIG_IPV6=n:

net/built-in.o: In function `redirect_tg6':
xt_REDIRECT.c:(.text+0x6d021): undefined reference to `nf_nat_redirect_ipv6'

Reported-by: Andreas Ruprecht <rupran@einserver.de>
Reported-by: Or Gerlitz <ogerlitz@mellanox.com>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-27 13:08:42 +01:00
Alvaro Neira
1b63d4b9b5 netfilter: nf_tables_bridge: set the pktinfo for IPv4/IPv6 traffic
This patch adds the missing bits to allow to match per meta l4proto from
the bridge. Example:

  nft add rule bridge filter input ether type {ip, ip6} meta l4proto udp counter

Signed-off-by: Alvaro Neira Ayuso <alvaroneay@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-27 13:08:29 +01:00
Alvaro Neira
68b0faa87d netfilter: nf_tables_bridge: export nft_reject_ip*hdr_validate functions
This patch exports the functions nft_reject_iphdr_validate and
nft_reject_ip6hdr_validate to use it in follow up patches.
These functions check if the IPv4/IPv6 header is correct.

Signed-off-by: Alvaro Neira Ayuso <alvaroneay@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-27 12:58:05 +01:00
Florian Westphal
c41884ce05 netfilter: conntrack: avoid zeroing timer
add a __nfct_init_offset annotation member to struct nf_conn to make
it clear which members are covered by the memset when the conntrack
is allocated.

This avoids zeroing timer_list and ct_net; both are already inited
explicitly.

Signed-off-by: Florian Westphal <fw@strlen.de>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-27 12:41:06 +01:00
Florian Westphal
abc86d0f99 netfilter: xt_recent: relax ip_pkt_list_tot restrictions
The maximum value for the hitcount parameter is given by
"ip_pkt_list_tot" parameter (default: 20).

Exceeding this value on the command line will cause the rule to be
rejected.  The parameter is also readonly, i.e. it cannot be changed
without module unload or reboot.

Store size per table, then base nstamps[] size on the hitcount instead.

The module parameter is retained for backwards compatibility.

Signed-off-by: Florian Westphal <fw@strlen.de>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-27 12:40:31 +01:00
Steven Walter
f6af675ef5 Bluetooth: Automatically flushable packets aren't allowed on LE links
The Bluetooth spec states that automatically flushable packets may not
be sent over a LE-U link.

Signed-off-by: Steven Walter <stevenrwalter@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
2014-11-27 12:12:27 +02:00
Trond Myklebust
ea5264138d NFS: Client side changes for RDMA
These patches various bugfixes and cleanups for using NFS over RDMA, including
 better error handling and performance improvements by using pad optimization.
 
 Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 Version: GnuPG v2
 
 iQIcBAABCAAGBQJUdPv2AAoJENfLVL+wpUDrJkMQAKjtPZHLMcj+eHm4f1ZKLJxy
 GSrUZV21TU9tL0NVE/5An8US6hoLwHpNXsW8o+gHTAeGRyiCmIaNXGd1Ql/4PYRH
 zfzdNXoaJAh1N5iXX11fF3gOWqx/SolqzO2xLDVETK/3lAvq0VwMYoMElBQB6qQW
 8sN3z8yVuz/9Ia9oGIFhqu1B6dcKPHkQDMtmsElGxeEX/+9yEg4HUKx+kZDtV0Uj
 8/JM8Jh1FKRCQT/P6INkRItdY5KaSJGFc43BkC/8lbugfxa5XCyu/m/qMr9FJsDV
 nM6rwaiVcmR/mvD3fL82+Jg/M+P9VUHQ1/Az0sV9G+fEoHH/1Mey3LfMzNpUmf9v
 bykrPRuzXkPPQgN1VnjSaF2RF+CWwV9Nme1VVXM/zj8gHX1mcmQF/wPRxDuLjCrt
 EObAFsvHOwDTZZmYp9bG5kc6IvwvT8aeeVQMJ4q4PSGD3w8AtoIyJDn+Ee0LFD1K
 Zw0oZpTJpI4t7DVxGBSdo2wZWuMU/UKqGqGtGJ+ljXfTRuuq968Q5j5ujaA9vf0v
 C9igYTU8hq4teMzhZrfR1jtTWoSS+5zamb1KtvAZy8gsht2PQVgE9xka2k/AV8uE
 ul/w5HU4OV+QIrHNbiu7BE8B2Ags6smpdHMqn9fqLBwvG+JEwbWqk1zeTsajxzq+
 hkvKkkMq6JjDbsDf96Yk
 =YIru
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'nfs-rdma-for-3.19' of git://git.linux-nfs.org/projects/anna/nfs-rdma into linux-next

Pull NFS client RDMA changes for 3.19 from Anna Schumaker:
 "NFS: Client side changes for RDMA

  These patches various bugfixes and cleanups for using NFS over RDMA, including
  better error handling and performance improvements by using pad optimization.

  Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>"

* tag 'nfs-rdma-for-3.19' of git://git.linux-nfs.org/projects/anna/nfs-rdma:
  xprtrdma: Display async errors
  xprtrdma: Enable pad optimization
  xprtrdma: Re-write rpcrdma_flush_cqs()
  xprtrdma: Refactor tasklet scheduling
  xprtrdma: unmap all FMRs during transport disconnect
  xprtrdma: Cap req_cqinit
  xprtrdma: Return an errno from rpcrdma_register_external()
2014-11-26 17:37:13 -05:00
Trond Myklebust
1702562db4 NFS: Generic client side changes from Chuck
These patches fixes for iostats and SETCLIENTID in addition to cleaning
 up the nfs4_init_callback() function.
 
 Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 Version: GnuPG v2
 
 iQIcBAABCAAGBQJUdfhQAAoJENfLVL+wpUDr9x4QANWmG6xjEU7RuIBLalOoxit6
 eXnEDNZlwYp6NCkYktHVWaTqXdwq7fdGX+3p4eiwNg3C3SrJHkpWvjeFd4KT/SyP
 B/w3vYG3o5H01i3Mb5kCD2uW0gbS9soZXpIg+uHHOl43yZzneC0vPTLhQ/h+9zPc
 B32XcgQhvLIHR3LWrC/+uolsa31lcyya0W45PX+iCpzHF7i9qRBrNLODkTlw1hNQ
 eEnYIvVy5oW00zlHJUYiTHP3e+0EJn5PAngdYbqiboJ9mK7DbB0QDwqyvJbIT7ql
 WAip6cNcJnSv1eiVYqDwlR1ok8drK5X7yQCT3lcLzAMDznLsSAL1Itu0h2Ay3z61
 f8XCyTwI0izq0DbdrMcPoqPSitqyM8nkPElnOuitXwzEroPaG40OF67yss3+ixbl
 JeQZ+u35pnpCkKUaZdCK3Pn83StxmUaBcFx8eg30NBc0SN13Eiz6aZcGEperClrR
 RwMLDUhUtAMcMRunRRxiN9lHafPqqeDeJre7uky0p0sU9CsH+1n5qIKLmk+Ber2d
 ZS29TobdR7ktfjQ52XazMAIFzI7r1v4Zn7ziH/WRbvKoKw9ICcyoUGNy9CS5LyWu
 BxWCZAJmby5H1i7V7ituJK8TImb81L4aPW06hHX9k+0SoTrgFjas//4jZYfysJ9N
 PvR0MRNfMFhuBlsTj7Gy
 =PMdS
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'nfs-cel-for-3.19' of git://git.linux-nfs.org/projects/anna/nfs-rdma into linux-next

Pull pull additional NFS client changes for 3.19 from Anna Schumaker:
  "NFS: Generic client side changes from Chuck

  These patches fixes for iostats and SETCLIENTID in addition to cleaning
  up the nfs4_init_callback() function.

  Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>"

* tag 'nfs-cel-for-3.19' of git://git.linux-nfs.org/projects/anna/nfs-rdma:
  NFS: Clean up nfs4_init_callback()
  NFS: SETCLIENTID XDR buffer sizes are incorrect
  SUNRPC: serialize iostats updates
2014-11-26 17:34:14 -05:00
Willem de Bruijn
f4713a3dfa net-timestamp: make tcp_recvmsg call ipv6_recv_error for AF_INET6 socks
TCP timestamping introduced MSG_ERRQUEUE handling for TCP sockets.
If the socket is of family AF_INET6, call ipv6_recv_error instead
of ip_recv_error.

This change is more complex than a single branch due to the loadable
ipv6 module. It reuses a pre-existing indirect function call from
ping. The ping code is safe to call, because it is part of the core
ipv6 module and always present when AF_INET6 sockets are active.

Fixes: 4ed2d765 (net-timestamp: TCP timestamping)
Signed-off-by: Willem de Bruijn <willemb@google.com>

----

It may also be worthwhile to add WARN_ON_ONCE(sk->family == AF_INET6)
to ip_recv_error.
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 15:45:04 -05:00
Thomas Graf
aa68c20ff3 bridge: Sanitize IFLA_EXT_MASK for AF_BRIDGE:RTM_GETLINK
Only search for IFLA_EXT_MASK if the message actually carries a
ifinfomsg header and validate minimal length requirements for
IFLA_EXT_MASK.

Fixes: 6cbdceeb ("bridge: Dump vlan information from a bridge port")
Cc: Vlad Yasevich <vyasevic@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 15:29:01 -05:00
Thomas Graf
6f705d8cfc bridge: Add missing policy entry for IFLA_BRPORT_FAST_LEAVE
Fixes: c2d3babf ("bridge: implement multicast fast leave")
Cc: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 15:29:01 -05:00
Thomas Graf
6e8d1c5545 bridge: Validate IFLA_BRIDGE_FLAGS attribute length
Payload is currently accessed blindly and may exceed valid message
boundaries.

Fixes: 407af3299 ("bridge: Add netlink interface to configure vlans on bridge ports")
Cc: Vlad Yasevich <vyasevic@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 15:29:00 -05:00
Johannes Berg
98f0334263 cfg80211: clean up beacon loss CQM event
Having it as a sub-event for RSSI thresholds is very ugly,
but luckily no userspace actually uses the events yet.

Move the event to its own function call internally and to
its own event attribute in nl80211.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-26 20:56:42 +01:00
Ying Xue
a6ca109443 tipc: use generic SKB list APIs to manage TIPC outgoing packet chains
Use standard SKB list APIs associated with struct sk_buff_head to
manage socket outgoing packet chain and name table outgoing packet
chain, having relevant code simpler and more readable.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:17 -05:00
Ying Xue
f03273f1e2 tipc: use generic SKB list APIs to manage link receive queue
Use standard SKB list APIs associated with struct sk_buff_head to
manage link's receive queue to simplify its relevant code cemplexity.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:17 -05:00
Ying Xue
bc6fecd409 tipc: use generic SKB list APIs to manage deferred queue of link
Use standard SKB list APIs associated with struct sk_buff_head to
manage link's deferred queue, simplifying relevant code.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:17 -05:00
Ying Xue
58dc55f256 tipc: use generic SKB list APIs to manage link transmission queue
Use standard SKB list APIs associated with struct sk_buff_head to
manage link transmission queue, having relevant code more clean.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:17 -05:00
Ying Xue
58d78b328a tipc: use skb_queue_walk_safe marco to simplify link_prepare_wakeup routine
Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:17 -05:00
Ying Xue
99315ad43d tipc: remove unused between routine
Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:17 -05:00
Ying Xue
58311d1690 tipc: eliminate two pseudo message types of BUNDLE_OPEN and BUNDLE_CLOSED
The pseudo message types of BUNDLE_CLOSED as well as BUNDLE_OPEN are
used to flag whether or not more messages can be bundled into a data
packet in the outgoing transmission queue. Obviously, no more messages
can be appended after the packet has been sent and is waiting to be
acknowledged and deleted. These message types do in reality represent
a send-side local implementation flag, and are not defined as part of
the protocol. It is therefore safe to move it to to where it belongs,
that is, the control area (TIPC_SKB_CB) of the buffer.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:17 -05:00
Ying Xue
47b4c9a82f tipc: clean up the process of link pushing packets
In original tipc_link_push_packet(), it pushes messages from protocol
message queue, retransmission queue and next_out queue. But as the two
first queues are removed, we can simplify its relevant code through
deleting tipc_link_push_queue().

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:16 -05:00
Ying Xue
7b6f087f98 tipc: remove retransmission queue
TIPC retransmission queue is intended to record which messages
should be retransmitted when bearer is not congested. However,
as the retransmission queue becomes useless with the removal of
bearer congestion mechanism, it should be removed.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:16 -05:00
Ying Xue
8965d250c2 tipc: remove protocol message queue
TIPC protocol message queue is intended to save one protocol message
when bearer is congested so that the message stored in the queue can
be immediately transmitted when bearer congestion is released. However,
as now the protocol queue has no mission any more with the removal of
bearer congestion mechanism, it should be removed.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:16 -05:00
Ying Xue
a8f48af587 tipc: remove node subscription infrastructure
The node subscribe infrastructure represents a virtual base class, so
its users, such as struct tipc_port and struct publication, can derive
its implemented functionalities. However, after the removal of struct
tipc_port, struct publication is left as its only single user now. So
defining an abstract infrastructure for one user becomes no longer
reasonable. If corresponding new functions associated with the
infrastructure are moved to name_table.c file, the node subscription
infrastructure can be removed as well.

Signed-off-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:30:16 -05:00
zhuyj
73cf0e923d ipv6: Remove unnecessary test
The "init_net" test in function addrconf_exit_net is introduced
in commit 44a6bd29 [Create ipv6 devconf-s for namespaces] to avoid freeing
init_net. In commit c900a800 [ipv6: fix bad free of addrconf_init_net],
function addrconf_init_net will allocate memory for every net regardless of
init_net. In this case, it is unnecessary to make "init_net" test.

CC: Hong Zhiguo <honkiko@gmail.com>
CC: Octavian Purdila <opurdila@ixiacom.com>
CC: Pavel Emelyanov <xemul@openvz.org>
CC: Cong Wang <cwang@twopensource.com>
Suggested-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
Signed-off-by: Zhu Yanjun <Yanjun.Zhu@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:27:04 -05:00
Tom Herbert
4fd671ded1 gue: Call remcsum_adjust
Change remote checksum offload to call remcsum_adjust. This also
eliminates the optimization to skip an IP header as part of the
adjustment (really does not seem to be much of a win).

Signed-off-by: Tom Herbert <therbert@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:25:44 -05:00
Eric Dumazet
ced7a04e39 pkt_sched: fq: increase max delay from 125 ms to one second
FQ/pacing has a clamp of delay of 125 ms, to avoid some possible harm.

It turns out this delay is too small to allow pacing low rates :
Some ISP setup very aggressive policers as low as 16kbit.

Now TCP stack has spurious rtx prevention, it seems safe to increase
this fixed parameter, without adding a qdisc attribute.

Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Cc: Yang Yingliang <yangyingliang@huawei.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-26 12:08:04 -05:00
Johannes Berg
5b97f49d65 cfg80211: refactor the various CQM event sending code
Much of the code can be shared by moving it into helper functions
for the CQM event sending.

Also move the code closer together, even in the header file.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-26 12:47:38 +01:00
Varka Bhadram
473f3766b5 mac802154: remove unnecessary if statement
Removes unnecessary if statement check for net device. Error check performed
after alloc_netdev().

	ndev = alloc_netdev(sizeof(*sdata) + local->hw.vif_data_size, name,
			    NET_NAME_UNKNOWN, ieee802154_if_setup);
        if (!ndev)
                return ERR_PTR(-ENOMEM);
	..

Signed-off-by: Varka Bhadram <varkab@cdac.in>
Acked-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-26 06:00:13 +01:00
Varka Bhadram
69bb631ef9 ieee802154: fix spelling mistakes
Signed-off-by: Varka Bhadram <varkab@cdac.in>
Acked-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-26 06:00:13 +01:00
Linus Torvalds
b914c5b213 Merge branch 'for-3.18' of git://linux-nfs.org/~bfields/linux
Pull nfsd bugfixes from Bruce Fields:
 "These fix one mishandling of the case when security labels are
  configured out, and two races in the 4.1 backchannel code"

* 'for-3.18' of git://linux-nfs.org/~bfields/linux:
  nfsd: Fix slot wake up race in the nfsv4.1 callback code
  SUNRPC: Fix locking around callback channel reply receive
  nfsd: correctly define v4.2 support attributes
2014-11-25 19:05:41 -08:00
David S. Miller
d3fc6b3fdd Merge branch 'for-davem' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/viro/vfs
More work from Al Viro to move away from modifying iovecs
by using iov_iter instead.

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-25 20:02:51 -05:00
Chuck Lever
edef1297f3 SUNRPC: serialize iostats updates
Occasionally mountstats reports a negative retransmission rate.
Ensure that two RPCs completing concurrently don't confuse the sums
in the transport's op_metrics array.

Since pNFS filelayout can invoke rpc_count_iostats() on another
transport from xprt_release(), we can't rely on simply holding the
transport_lock in xprt_release(). There's nothing for it but hard
serialization. One spin lock per RPC operation should make this as
painless as it can be.

Signed-off-by: Chuck Lever <chuck.lever@oracle.com>
Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>
2014-11-25 16:22:15 -05:00
Eric Dumazet
c3658e8d0f tcp: fix possible NULL dereference in tcp_vX_send_reset()
After commit ca777eff51 ("tcp: remove dst refcount false sharing for
prequeue mode") we have to relax check against skb dst in
tcp_v[46]_send_reset() if prequeue dropped the dst.

If a socket is provided, a full lookup was done to find this socket,
so the dst test can be skipped.

Bugzilla: https://bugzilla.kernel.org/show_bug.cgi?id=88191
Reported-by: Jaša Bartelj <jasa.bartelj@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Reported-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Fixes: ca777eff51 ("tcp: remove dst refcount false sharing for prequeue mode")
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-25 14:29:18 -05:00
Pablo Neira
43612d7c04 Revert "netfilter: conntrack: fix race in __nf_conntrack_confirm against get_next_corpse"
This reverts commit 5195c14c8b.

If the conntrack clashes with an existing one, it is left out of
the unconfirmed list, thus, crashing when dropping the packet and
releasing the conntrack since golden rule is that conntracks are
always placed in any of the existing lists for traceability reasons.

Reported-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Fixes: https://bugzilla.kernel.org/show_bug.cgi?id=88841
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-25 14:14:51 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
f3750817a9 ip6_udp_tunnel: Fix checksum calculation
The UDP checksum calculation for VXLAN tunnels is currently using the
socket addresses instead of the actual packet source and destination
addresses.  As a result the checksum calculated is incorrect in some
cases.

Also uh->check was being set twice, first it was set to 0, and then it is
set again in udp6_set_csum.  This change removes the redundant assignment
to 0.

Fixes: acbf74a7 ("vxlan: Refactor vxlan driver to make use of the common UDP tunnel functions.")

Cc: Andy Zhou <azhou@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-25 14:12:12 -05:00
Chuck Lever
7ff11de1ba xprtrdma: Display async errors
An async error upcall is a hard error, and should be reported in
the system log.

Signed-off-by: Chuck Lever <chuck.lever@oracle.com>
Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>
2014-11-25 13:39:20 -05:00
Chuck Lever
d5440e27d3 xprtrdma: Enable pad optimization
The Linux NFS/RDMA server used to reject NFSv3 WRITE requests when
pad optimization was enabled. That bug was fixed by commit
e560e3b510 ("svcrdma: Add zero padding if the client doesn't send
it").

We can now enable pad optimization on the client, which helps
performance and is supported now by both Linux and Solaris servers.

Signed-off-by: Chuck Lever <chuck.lever@oracle.com>
Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>
2014-11-25 13:39:20 -05:00
Chuck Lever
5c166bef4f xprtrdma: Re-write rpcrdma_flush_cqs()
Currently rpcrdma_flush_cqs() attempts to avoid code duplication,
and simply invokes rpcrdma_recvcq_upcall and rpcrdma_sendcq_upcall.

1. rpcrdma_flush_cqs() can run concurrently with provider upcalls.
   Both flush_cqs() and the upcalls were invoking ib_poll_cq() in
   different threads using the same wc buffers (ep->rep_recv_wcs
   and ep->rep_send_wcs), added by commit 1c00dd0776 ("xprtrmda:
   Reduce calls to ib_poll_cq() in completion handlers").

   During transport disconnect processing, this sometimes resulted
   in the same reply getting added to the rpcrdma_tasklets_g list
   more than once, which corrupted the list.

2. The upcall functions drain only a limited number of CQEs,
   thanks to the poll budget added by commit 8301a2c047
   ("xprtrdma: Limit work done by completion handler").

Fixes: a7bc211ac9 ("xprtrdma: On disconnect, don't ignore ... ")
BugLink: https://bugzilla.linux-nfs.org/show_bug.cgi?id=276
Signed-off-by: Chuck Lever <chuck.lever@oracle.com>
Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>
2014-11-25 13:39:20 -05:00
Chuck Lever
f1a03b76fe xprtrdma: Refactor tasklet scheduling
Restore the separate function that schedules the reply handling
tasklet. I need to call it from two different paths.

Signed-off-by: Chuck Lever <chuck.lever@oracle.com>
Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>
2014-11-25 13:39:20 -05:00
Chuck Lever
467c9674bc xprtrdma: unmap all FMRs during transport disconnect
When using RPCRDMA_MTHCAFMR memory registration, after a few
transport disconnect / reconnect cycles, ib_map_phys_fmr() starts to
return EINVAL because the provider has exhausted its map pool.

Make sure that all FMRs are unmapped during transport disconnect,
and that ->send_request remarshals them during an RPC retransmit.
This resets the transport's MRs to ensure that none are leaked
during a disconnect.

Signed-off-by: Chuck Lever <chuck.lever@oracle.com>
Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>
2014-11-25 13:39:20 -05:00
Chuck Lever
e7104a2a96 xprtrdma: Cap req_cqinit
Recent work made FRMR registration and invalidation completions
unsignaled. This greatly reduces the adapter interrupt rate.

Every so often, however, a posted send Work Request is allowed to
signal. Otherwise, the provider's Work Queue will wrap and the
workload will hang.

The number of Work Requests that are allowed to remain unsignaled is
determined by the value of req_cqinit. Currently, this is set to the
size of the send Work Queue divided by two, minus 1.

For FRMR, the send Work Queue is the maximum number of concurrent
RPCs (currently 32) times the maximum number of Work Requests an
RPC might use (currently 7, though some adapters may need more).

For mlx4, this is 224 entries. This leaves completion signaling
disabled for 111 send Work Requests.

Some providers hold back dispatching Work Requests until a CQE is
generated.  If completions are disabled, then no CQEs are generated
for quite some time, and that can stall the Work Queue.

I've seen this occur running xfstests generic/113 over NFSv4, where
eventually, posting a FAST_REG_MR Work Request fails with -ENOMEM
because the Work Queue has overflowed. The connection is dropped
and re-established.

Cap the rep_cqinit setting so completions are not left turned off
for too long.

BugLink: https://bugzilla.linux-nfs.org/show_bug.cgi?id=269
Signed-off-by: Chuck Lever <chuck.lever@oracle.com>
Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>
2014-11-25 13:39:20 -05:00
Chuck Lever
92b98361f1 xprtrdma: Return an errno from rpcrdma_register_external()
The RPC/RDMA send_request method and the chunk registration code
expects an errno from the registration function. This allows
the upper layers to distinguish between a recoverable failure
(for example, temporary memory exhaustion) and a hard failure
(for example, a bug in the registration logic).

Signed-off-by: Chuck Lever <chuck.lever@oracle.com>
Signed-off-by: Anna Schumaker <Anna.Schumaker@Netapp.com>
2014-11-25 13:39:20 -05:00
Daniel Borkmann
79e886599e crypto: algif - add and use sock_kzfree_s() instead of memzero_explicit()
Commit e1bd95bf7c ("crypto: algif - zeroize IV buffer") and
2a6af25bef ("crypto: algif - zeroize message digest buffer")
added memzero_explicit() calls on buffers that are later on
passed back to sock_kfree_s().

This is a discussed follow-up that, instead, extends the sock
API and adds sock_kzfree_s(), which internally uses kzfree()
instead of kfree() for passing the buffers back to slab.

Having sock_kzfree_s() allows to keep the changes more minimal
by just having a drop-in replacement instead of adding
memzero_explicit() calls everywhere before sock_kfree_s().

In kzfree(), the compiler is not allowed to optimize the memset()
away and thus there's no need for memzero_explicit(). Both,
sock_kfree_s() and sock_kzfree_s() are wrappers for
__sock_kfree_s() and call into kfree() resp. kzfree(); here,
__sock_kfree_s() needs to be explicitly inlined as we want the
compiler to optimize the call and condition away and thus it
produces e.g. on x86_64 the _same_ assembler output for
sock_kfree_s() before and after, and thus also allows for
avoiding code duplication.

Cc: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
Signed-off-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>
2014-11-25 22:50:39 +08:00
Johannes Berg
40a11ca83d mac80211: check if channels allow 80 MHz for VHT probe requests
If there are no channels allowing 80 MHz to be used, then the
station isn't really VHT capable even if the driver and device
support it in general. In this case, exclude the VHT capability
IE from probe request frames.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-25 11:05:33 +01:00
Johannes Berg
ea9eba6a8b cfg80211: remove pointless channel lookup in survey code
We have a channel pointer, and we use its center frequency
to look up a channel pointer - which will thus be exactly
the same as the original pointer.

Remove that pointless lookup and just use the pointer.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-25 09:57:27 +01:00
Jeff Layton
1306729b0d sunrpc: eliminate RPC_TRACEPOINTS
It's always set to the same value as CONFIG_TRACEPOINTS, so we can just
use that instead.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: Trond Myklebust <trond.myklebust@primarydata.com>
2014-11-24 17:33:12 -05:00
Jeff Layton
f895b252d4 sunrpc: eliminate RPC_DEBUG
It's always set to whatever CONFIG_SUNRPC_DEBUG is, so just use that.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: Trond Myklebust <trond.myklebust@primarydata.com>
2014-11-24 17:31:46 -05:00
Jane Zhou
91a0b60346 net/ping: handle protocol mismatching scenario
ping_lookup() may return a wrong sock if sk_buff's and sock's protocols
dont' match. For example, sk_buff's protocol is ETH_P_IPV6, but sock's
sk_family is AF_INET, in that case, if sk->sk_bound_dev_if is zero, a wrong
sock will be returned.
the fix is to "continue" the searching, if no matching, return NULL.

Cc: "David S. Miller" <davem@davemloft.net>
Cc: Alexey Kuznetsov <kuznet@ms2.inr.ac.ru>
Cc: James Morris <jmorris@namei.org>
Cc: Hideaki YOSHIFUJI <yoshfuji@linux-ipv6.org>
Cc: Patrick McHardy <kaber@trash.net>
Cc: netdev@vger.kernel.org
Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org
Signed-off-by: Jane Zhou <a17711@motorola.com>
Signed-off-by: Yiwei Zhao <gbjc64@motorola.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-24 16:48:20 -05:00
Michael S. Tsirkin
6e58040b84 af_packet: fix sparse warning
af_packet produces lots of these:
	net/packet/af_packet.c:384:39: warning: incorrect type in return expression (different modifiers)
	net/packet/af_packet.c:384:39:    expected struct page [pure] *
	net/packet/af_packet.c:384:39:    got struct page *

this seems to be because sparse does not realize that _pure
refers to function, not the returned pointer.

Tweak code slightly to avoid the warning.

Signed-off-by: Michael S. Tsirkin <mst@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-24 16:15:36 -05:00
Yuri Chislov
be6572fdb1 ipv6: gre: fix wrong skb->protocol in WCCP
When using GRE redirection in WCCP, it sets the wrong skb->protocol,
that is, ETH_P_IP instead of ETH_P_IPV6 for the encapuslated traffic.

Fixes: c12b395a46 ("gre: Support GRE over IPv6")
Cc: Dmitry Kozlov <xeb@mail.ru>
Signed-off-by: Yuri Chislov <yuri.chislov@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Yuri Chislov <yuri.chislov@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-24 16:11:05 -05:00
Richard Alpe
d8182804cf tipc: fix sparse warnings in new nl api
Fix sparse warnings about non-static declaration of static functions
in the new tipc netlink API.

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-24 16:10:23 -05:00
David S. Miller
958d03b016 Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/pablo/nf-next
Pablo Neira Ayuso says:

====================
netfilter/ipvs updates for net-next

The following patchset contains Netfilter updates for your net-next
tree, this includes the NAT redirection support for nf_tables, the
cgroup support for nft meta and conntrack zone support for the connlimit
match. Coming after those, a bunch of sparse warning fixes, missing
netns bits and cleanups. More specifically, they are:

1) Prepare IPv4 and IPv6 NAT redirect code to use it from nf_tables,
   patches from Arturo Borrero.

2) Introduce the nf_tables redir expression, from Arturo Borrero.

3) Remove an unnecessary assignment in ip_vs_xmit/__ip_vs_get_out_rt().
   Patch from Alex Gartrell.

4) Add nft_log_dereference() macro to the nf_log infrastructure, patch
   from Marcelo Leitner.

5) Add some extra validation when registering logger families, also
   from Marcelo.

6) Some spelling cleanups from stephen hemminger.

7) Fix sparse warning in nf_logger_find_get().

8) Add cgroup support to nf_tables meta, patch from Ana Rey.

9) A Kconfig fix for the new redir expression and fix sparse warnings in
   the new redir expression.

10) Fix several sparse warnings in the netfilter tree, from
    Florian Westphal.

11) Reduce verbosity when OOM in nfnetlink_log. User can basically do
    nothing when this situation occurs.

12) Add conntrack zone support to xt_connlimit, again from Florian.

13) Add netnamespace support to the h323 conntrack helper, contributed
    by Vasily Averin.

14) Remove unnecessary nul-pointer checks before free_percpu() and
    module_put(), from Markus Elfring.

15) Use pr_fmt in nfnetlink_log, again patch from Marcelo Leitner.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-24 16:00:58 -05:00
Jeff Layton
1a867a0898 sunrpc: add tracepoints in xs_tcp_data_recv
Add tracepoints inside the main loop on xs_tcp_data_recv that allow
us to keep an eye on what's happening during each phase of it.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: Trond Myklebust <trond.myklebust@primarydata.com>
2014-11-24 12:53:35 -05:00
Jeff Layton
3705ad64f1 sunrpc: add new tracepoints in xprt handling code
...so we can keep track of when calls are sent and replies received.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: Trond Myklebust <trond.myklebust@primarydata.com>
2014-11-24 12:53:35 -05:00
Jeff Layton
860a0d9e51 sunrpc: add some tracepoints in svc_rqst handling functions
...just around svc_send, svc_recv and svc_process for now.

Signed-off-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: Trond Myklebust <trond.myklebust@primarydata.com>
2014-11-24 12:53:34 -05:00
Johannes Berg
575f05302e mac80211: disable 80+80/160 in VHT correctly
The supported bandwidth field is a two-bit field, not a bitmap,
so treat it accordingly when disabling 80+80 or 160 MHz.

Note that we can only advertise "80+80 and 160" or "160", not
"80+80" by itself, so disabling 160 also disables 80+80.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-24 16:55:28 +01:00
Al Viro
083735f4b0 rds: switch rds_message_copy_from_user() to iov_iter
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 05:16:43 -05:00
Al Viro
c310e72c89 rds: switch ->inc_copy_to_user() to passing iov_iter
instances get considerably simpler from that...

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 05:16:43 -05:00
Al Viro
7424ce6506 [atm] switch vcc_sendmsg() to copy_from_iter()
... and make it handle multi-segment iovecs - deals with that
"fix this later" issue for free.  A bit of shame, really - it
had been there since 2.3.15pre3 when the whole thing went into the
tree, practically a historical artefact by now...

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 05:16:42 -05:00
Al Viro
0f7db23a07 vmci_transport: switch ->enqeue_dgram, ->enqueue_stream and ->dequeue_stream to msghdr
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 05:16:42 -05:00
Al Viro
45dcc687f7 tipc_msg_build(): pass msghdr instead of its ->msg_iov
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 05:16:41 -05:00
Al Viro
562640f3c3 tipc_sendmsg(): pass msghdr instead of its ->msg_iov
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 05:16:40 -05:00
Al Viro
e0eb093e79 switch sctp_user_addto_chunk() and sctp_datamsg_from_user() to passing iov_iter
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 05:16:40 -05:00
Al Viro
8feb2fb2bb switch AF_PACKET and AF_UNIX to skb_copy_datagram_from_iter()
... and kill skb_copy_datagram_iovec()

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 05:16:39 -05:00
Al Viro
195e952d03 kill zerocopy_sg_from_iovec()
no users left

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 05:16:39 -05:00
Al Viro
3a654f975b new helpers: skb_copy_datagram_from_iter() and zerocopy_sg_from_iter()
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 05:03:08 -05:00
Al Viro
7eab8d9e8a new helper: memcpy_to_msg()
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 04:28:51 -05:00
Al Viro
e169371823 switch ipxrtr_route_packet() from iovec to msghdr
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 04:28:49 -05:00
Al Viro
6ce8e9ce59 new helper: memcpy_from_msg()
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 04:28:48 -05:00
Al Viro
227158db16 new helper: skb_copy_and_csum_datagram_msg()
Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-24 04:28:44 -05:00
lucien
20ea60ca99 ip_tunnel: the lack of vti_link_ops' dellink() cause kernel panic
Now the vti_link_ops do not point the .dellink, for fb tunnel device
(ip_vti0), the net_device will be removed as the default .dellink is
unregister_netdevice_queue,but the tunnel still in the tunnel list,
then if we add a new vti tunnel, in ip_tunnel_find():

        hlist_for_each_entry_rcu(t, head, hash_node) {
                if (local == t->parms.iph.saddr &&
                    remote == t->parms.iph.daddr &&
                    link == t->parms.link &&
==>                 type == t->dev->type &&
                    ip_tunnel_key_match(&t->parms, flags, key))
                        break;
        }

the panic will happen, cause dev of ip_tunnel *t is null:
[ 3835.072977] IP: [<ffffffffa04103fd>] ip_tunnel_find+0x9d/0xc0 [ip_tunnel]
[ 3835.073008] PGD b2c21067 PUD b7277067 PMD 0
[ 3835.073008] Oops: 0000 [#1] SMP
.....
[ 3835.073008] Stack:
[ 3835.073008]  ffff8800b72d77f0 ffffffffa0411924 ffff8800bb956000 ffff8800b72d78e0
[ 3835.073008]  ffff8800b72d78a0 0000000000000000 ffffffffa040d100 ffff8800b72d7858
[ 3835.073008]  ffffffffa040b2e3 0000000000000000 0000000000000000 0000000000000000
[ 3835.073008] Call Trace:
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffffa0411924>] ip_tunnel_newlink+0x64/0x160 [ip_tunnel]
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffffa040b2e3>] vti_newlink+0x43/0x70 [ip_vti]
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffff8150d4da>] rtnl_newlink+0x4fa/0x5f0
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffff812f68bb>] ? nla_strlcpy+0x5b/0x70
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffff81508fb0>] ? rtnl_link_ops_get+0x40/0x60
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffff8150d11f>] ? rtnl_newlink+0x13f/0x5f0
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffff81509cf4>] rtnetlink_rcv_msg+0xa4/0x270
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffff8126adf5>] ? sock_has_perm+0x75/0x90
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffff81509c50>] ? rtnetlink_rcv+0x30/0x30
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffff81529e39>] netlink_rcv_skb+0xa9/0xc0
[ 3835.073008]  [<ffffffff81509c48>] rtnetlink_rcv+0x28/0x30
....

modprobe ip_vti
ip link del ip_vti0 type vti
ip link add ip_vti0 type vti
rmmod ip_vti

do that one or more times, kernel will panic.

fix it by assigning ip_tunnel_dellink to vti_link_ops' dellink, in
which we skip the unregister of fb tunnel device. do the same on ip6_vti.

Signed-off-by: Xin Long <lucien.xin@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Cong Wang <cwang@twopensource.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-23 21:11:17 -05:00
Ian Morris
e5d08d718a ipv6: coding style improvements (remove assignment in if statements)
This change has no functional impact and simply addresses some coding
style issues detected by checkpatch. Specifically this change
adjusts "if" statements which also include the assignment of a
variable.

No changes to the resultant object files result as determined by objdiff.

Signed-off-by: Ian Morris <ipm@chirality.org.uk>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-23 21:00:56 -05:00
Alexander Duyck
b6fef4c6b8 ipv6: Do not treat a GSO_TCPV4 request from UDP tunnel over IPv6 as invalid
This patch adds SKB_GSO_TCPV4 to the list of supported GSO types handled by
the IPv6 GSO offloads.  Without this change VXLAN tunnels running over IPv6
do not currently handle IPv4 TCP TSO requests correctly and end up handing
the non-segmented frame off to the device.

Below is the before and after for a simple netperf TCP_STREAM test between
two endpoints tunneling IPv4 over a VXLAN tunnel running on IPv6 on top of
a 1Gb/s network adapter.

Recv   Send    Send
Socket Socket  Message  Elapsed
Size   Size    Size     Time     Throughput
bytes  bytes   bytes    secs.    10^6bits/sec

 87380  16384  16384    10.29       0.88      Before
 87380  16384  16384    10.03     895.69      After

Signed-off-by: Alexander Duyck <alexander.h.duyck@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-23 14:18:11 -05:00
David S. Miller
1459143386 Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net
Conflicts:
	drivers/net/ieee802154/fakehard.c

A bug fix went into 'net' for ieee802154/fakehard.c, which is removed
in 'net-next'.

Add build fix into the merge from Stephen Rothwell in openvswitch, the
logging macros take a new initial 'log' argument, a new call was added
in 'net' so when we merge that in here we have to explicitly add the
new 'log' arg to it else the build fails.

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 22:28:24 -05:00
Linus Torvalds
8a84e01e14 Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net
Pull networking fixes from David Miller:

 1) Fix BUG when decrypting empty packets in mac80211, from Ronald Wahl.

 2) nf_nat_range is not fully initialized and this is copied back to
    userspace, from Daniel Borkmann.

 3) Fix read past end of b uffer in netfilter ipset, also from Dan
    Carpenter.

 4) Signed integer overflow in ipv4 address mask creation helper
    inet_make_mask(), from Vincent BENAYOUN.

 5) VXLAN, be2net, mlx4_en, and qlcnic need ->ndo_gso_check() methods to
    properly describe the device's capabilities, from Joe Stringer.

 6) Fix memory leaks and checksum miscalculations in openvswitch, from
    Pravin B SHelar and Jesse Gross.

 7) FIB rules passes back ambiguous error code for unreachable routes,
    making behavior confusing for userspace.  Fix from Panu Matilainen.

 8) ieee802154fake_probe() doesn't release resources properly on error,
    from Alexey Khoroshilov.

 9) Fix skb_over_panic in add_grhead(), from Daniel Borkmann.

10) Fix access of stale slave pointers in bonding code, from Nikolay
    Aleksandrov.

11) Fix stack info leak in PPP pptp code, from Mathias Krause.

12) Cure locking bug in IPX stack, from Jiri Bohac.

13) Revert SKB fclone memory freeing optimization that is racey and can
    allow accesses to freed up memory, from Eric Dumazet.

* git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net: (71 commits)
  tcp: Restore RFC5961-compliant behavior for SYN packets
  net: Revert "net: avoid one atomic operation in skb_clone()"
  virtio-net: validate features during probe
  cxgb4 : Fix DCB priority groups being returned in wrong order
  ipx: fix locking regression in ipx_sendmsg and ipx_recvmsg
  openvswitch: Don't validate IPv6 label masks.
  pptp: fix stack info leak in pptp_getname()
  brcmfmac: don't include linux/unaligned/access_ok.h
  cxgb4i : Don't block unload/cxgb4 unload when remote closes TCP connection
  ipv6: delete protocol and unregister rtnetlink when cleanup
  net/mlx4_en: Add VXLAN ndo calls to the PF net device ops too
  bonding: fix curr_active_slave/carrier with loadbalance arp monitoring
  mac80211: minstrel_ht: fix a crash in rate sorting
  vxlan: Inline vxlan_gso_check().
  can: m_can: update to support CAN FD features
  can: m_can: fix incorrect error messages
  can: m_can: add missing delay after setting CCCR_INIT bit
  can: m_can: fix not set can_dlc for remote frame
  can: m_can: fix possible sleep in napi poll
  can: m_can: add missing message RAM initialization
  ...
2014-11-21 17:20:36 -08:00
David S. Miller
53b15ef3c2 Merge tag 'master-2014-11-20' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/linville/wireless-next
John W. Linville says:

====================
pull request: wireless-next 2014-11-21

Please pull this batch of updates intended for the 3.19 stream...

For the mac80211 bits, Johannes says:

"It has been a while since my last pull request, so we accumulated
another relatively large set of changes:
 * TDLS off-channel support set from Arik/Liad, with some support
   patches I did
 * custom regulatory fixes from Arik
 * minstrel VHT fix (and a small optimisation) from Felix
 * add back radiotap vendor namespace support (myself)
 * random MAC address scanning for cfg80211/mac80211/hwsim (myself)
 * CSA improvements (Luca)
 * WoWLAN Net Detect (wake on network found) support (Luca)
 * and lots of other smaller changes from many people"

For the Bluetooth bits, Johan says:

"Here's another set of patches for 3.19. Most of it is again fixes and
cleanups to ieee802154 related code from Alexander Aring. We've also got
better handling of hardware error events along with a proper API for HCI
drivers to notify the HCI core of such situations. There's also a minor
fix for mgmt events as well as a sparse warning fix. The code for
sending HCI commands synchronously also gets a fix where we might loose
the completion event in the case of very fast HW (particularly easily
reproducible with an emulated HCI device)."

And...

"Here's another bluetooth-next pull request for 3.19. We've got:

 - Various fixes, cleanups and improvements to ieee802154/mac802154
 - Support for a Broadcom BCM20702A1 variant
 - Lots of lockdep fixes
 - Fixed handling of LE CoC errors that should trigger SMP"

For the Atheros bits, Kalle says:

"One ath6kl patch and rest for ath10k, but nothing really major which
stands out. Most notable:

o fix resume (Bartosz)

o firmware restart is now faster and more reliable (Michal)

o it's now possible to test hardware restart functionality without
  crashing the firmware using hw-restart parameter with
  simulate_fw_crash debugfs file (Michal)"

On top of that...both ath9k and mwifiex get their usual level of
updates.  Of note is the ath9k spectral scan work from Oleksij Rempel.

I also pulled from the wireless tree in order to avoid some merge issues.

Please let me know if there are problems!
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 16:39:45 -05:00
Richard Cochran
37dd9255b2 vlan: Pass ethtool get_ts_info queries to real device.
Commit a6111d3c "vlan: Pass SIOC[SG]HWTSTAMP ioctls to real device"
intended to enable hardware time stamping on VLAN interfaces, but
passing SIOCSHWTSTAMP is only half of the story. This patch adds
the second half, by letting user space find out the time stamping
capabilities of the device backing a VLAN interface.

Signed-off-by: Richard Cochran <richardcochran@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:35:53 -05:00
Calvin Owens
0c228e833c tcp: Restore RFC5961-compliant behavior for SYN packets
Commit c3ae62af8e ("tcp: should drop incoming frames without ACK
flag set") was created to mitigate a security vulnerability in which a
local attacker is able to inject data into locally-opened sockets by
using TCP protocol statistics in procfs to quickly find the correct
sequence number.

This broke the RFC5961 requirement to send a challenge ACK in response
to spurious RST packets, which was subsequently fixed by commit
7b514a886b ("tcp: accept RST without ACK flag").

Unfortunately, the RFC5961 requirement that spurious SYN packets be
handled in a similar manner remains broken.

RFC5961 section 4 states that:

   ... the handling of the SYN in the synchronized state SHOULD be
   performed as follows:

   1) If the SYN bit is set, irrespective of the sequence number, TCP
      MUST send an ACK (also referred to as challenge ACK) to the remote
      peer:

      <SEQ=SND.NXT><ACK=RCV.NXT><CTL=ACK>

      After sending the acknowledgment, TCP MUST drop the unacceptable
      segment and stop processing further.

   By sending an ACK, the remote peer is challenged to confirm the loss
   of the previous connection and the request to start a new connection.
   A legitimate peer, after restart, would not have a TCB in the
   synchronized state.  Thus, when the ACK arrives, the peer should send
   a RST segment back with the sequence number derived from the ACK
   field that caused the RST.

   This RST will confirm that the remote peer has indeed closed the
   previous connection.  Upon receipt of a valid RST, the local TCP
   endpoint MUST terminate its connection.  The local TCP endpoint
   should then rely on SYN retransmission from the remote end to
   re-establish the connection.

This patch lets SYN packets through the discard added in c3ae62af8e,
so that spurious SYN packets are properly dealt with as per the RFC.

The challenge ACK is sent unconditionally and is rate-limited, so the
original vulnerability is not reintroduced by this patch.

Signed-off-by: Calvin Owens <calvinowens@fb.com>
Acked-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Acked-by: Neal Cardwell <ncardwell@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:33:50 -05:00
Eric Dumazet
e7820e39b7 net: Revert "net: avoid one atomic operation in skb_clone()"
Not sure what I was thinking, but doing anything after
releasing a refcount is suicidal or/and embarrassing.

By the time we set skb->fclone to SKB_FCLONE_FREE, another cpu
could have released last reference and freed whole skb.

We potentially corrupt memory or trap if CONFIG_DEBUG_PAGEALLOC is set.

Reported-by: Chris Mason <clm@fb.com>
Fixes: ce1a4ea3f1 ("net: avoid one atomic operation in skb_clone()")
Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Cc: Sabrina Dubroca <sd@queasysnail.net>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:26:32 -05:00
Richard Alpe
1593123a6a tipc: add name table dump to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_NAME_TABLE_GET command to the new tipc netlink API.

This command supports dumping the name table of all nodes.

Netlink logical layout of name table response message:
-> name table
    -> publication
        -> type
        -> lower
        -> upper
        -> scope
        -> node
        -> ref
        -> key

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:32 -05:00
Richard Alpe
27c2141672 tipc: add net set to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_NET_SET command to the new tipc netlink API.

This command can set the network id and network (tipc) address.

Netlink logical layout of network set message:
-> net
     [ -> id ]
     [ -> address ]

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:31 -05:00
Richard Alpe
fd3cf2ad51 tipc: add net dump to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_NET_GET command to the new tipc netlink API.

This command dumps the network id of the node.

Netlink logical layout of returned network data:
-> net
    -> id

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:31 -05:00
Richard Alpe
3e4b6ab58d tipc: add node get/dump to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_NODE_GET to the new tipc netlink API.

This command can dump the address and node status of all nodes in the
tipc cluster.

Netlink logical layout of returned node/address data:
-> node
    -> address
    -> up flag

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:31 -05:00
Richard Alpe
1e55417d8f tipc: add media set to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_MEDIA_SET command to the new tipc netlink API.

This command can set one or more link properties for a particular
media.

Netlink logical layout of bearer set message:
-> media
    -> name
    -> link properties
        [ -> tolerance ]
        [ -> priority ]
        [ -> window ]

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:31 -05:00
Richard Alpe
46f15c6794 tipc: add media get/dump to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_MEDIA_GET command to the new tipc netlink API.

This command supports dumping all information about all defined
media as well as getting all information about a specific media.

The information about a media includes name and link properties.

Netlink logical layout of media get response message:
-> media
    -> name
    -> link properties
        -> tolerance
        -> priority
        -> window

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:31 -05:00
Richard Alpe
ae36342b50 tipc: add link stat reset to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_LINK_RESET_STATS command to the new netlink API.

This command resets the link statistics for a particular link.

Netlink logical layout of link reset message:
-> link
    -> name

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:31 -05:00
Richard Alpe
f96ce7a20d tipc: add link set to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_LINK_SET to the new tipc netlink API.

This command can set one or more link properties for a particular
link.

Netlink logical layout of link set message:
-> link
    -> name
    -> properties
        [ -> tolerance ]
        [ -> priority ]
        [ -> window ]

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:30 -05:00
Richard Alpe
7be57fc691 tipc: add link get/dump to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_LINK_GET command to the new tipc netlink API.

This command supports dumping all information about all links
(including the broadcast link) or getting all information about a
specific link (not the broadcast link).

The information about a link includes name, transmission info,
properties and link statistics.

As the tipc broadcast link is special we unfortunately have to treat
it specially. It is a deliberate decision not to abstract the
broadcast link on this (API) level.

Netlink logical layout of link response message:
    -> port
        -> name
        -> MTU
        -> RX
        -> TX
        -> up flag
        -> active flag
        -> properties
           -> priority
           -> tolerance
           -> window
        -> statistics
            -> rx_info
            -> rx_fragments
            -> rx_fragmented
            -> rx_bundles
            -> rx_bundled
            -> tx_info
            -> tx_fragments
            -> tx_fragmented
            -> tx_bundles
            -> tx_bundled
            -> msg_prof_tot
            -> msg_len_cnt
            -> msg_len_tot
            -> msg_len_p0
            -> msg_len_p1
            -> msg_len_p2
            -> msg_len_p3
            -> msg_len_p4
            -> msg_len_p5
            -> msg_len_p6
            -> rx_states
            -> rx_probes
            -> rx_nacks
            -> rx_deferred
            -> tx_states
            -> tx_probes
            -> tx_nacks
            -> tx_acks
            -> retransmitted
            -> duplicates
            -> link_congs
            -> max_queue
            -> avg_queue

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:30 -05:00
Richard Alpe
1a1a143daf tipc: add publication dump to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_PUBL_GET command to the new tipc netlink API.

This command supports dumping of all publications for a specific
socket.

Netlink logical layout of request message:
    -> socket
        -> reference

Netlink logical layout of response message:
    -> publication
        -> type
        -> lower
        -> upper

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:30 -05:00
Richard Alpe
34b78a127c tipc: add sock dump to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_SOCK_GET command to the new tipc netlink API.

This command supports dumping of all available sockets with their
associated connection or publication(s). It could be extended to reply
with a single socket if the NLM_F_DUMP isn't set.

The information about a socket includes reference, address, connection
information / publication information.

Netlink logical layout of response message:
-> socket
    -> reference
    -> address
    [
    -> connection
        -> node
        -> socket
        [
        -> connected flag
        -> type
        -> instance
        ]
    ]
    [
    -> publication flag
    ]

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:30 -05:00
Richard Alpe
315c00bc9f tipc: add bearer set to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_BEARER_SET command to the new tipc netlink API.

This command can set one or more link properties for a particular
bearer.

Netlink logical layout of bearer set message:
-> bearer
    -> name
    -> link properties
        [ -> tolerance ]
        [ -> priority ]
        [ -> window ]

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:30 -05:00
Richard Alpe
35b9dd7607 tipc: add bearer get/dump to new netlink api
Add TIPC_NL_BEARER_GET command to the new tipc netlink API.

This command supports dumping all data about all bearers or getting
all information about a specific bearer.

The information about a bearer includes name, link priorities and
domain.

Netlink logical layout of bearer get message:
-> bearer
    -> name

Netlink logical layout of returned bearer information:
-> bearer
    -> name
    -> link properties
        -> priority
        -> tolerance
        -> window
    -> domain

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:29 -05:00
Richard Alpe
0655f6a863 tipc: add bearer disable/enable to new netlink api
A new netlink API for tipc that can disable or enable a tipc bearer.

The new API is separated from the old API because of a bug in the
user space client (tipc-config). The problem is that older versions
of tipc-config has a very low receive limit and adding commands to
the legacy genl_opts struct causes the ctrl_getfamily() response
message to grow, subsequently breaking the tool.

The new API utilizes netlink policies for input validation. Where the
top-level netlink attributes are tipc-logical entities, like bearer.
The top level entities then contain nested attributes. In this case
a name, nested link properties and a domain.

Netlink commands implemented in this patch:
TIPC_NL_BEARER_ENABLE
TIPC_NL_BEARER_DISABLE

Netlink logical layout of bearer enable message:
-> bearer
    -> name
    [ -> domain ]
    [
    -> properties
        -> priority
    ]

Netlink logical layout of bearer disable message:
-> bearer
    -> name

Signed-off-by: Richard Alpe <richard.alpe@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
Reviewed-by: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
Acked-by: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 15:01:29 -05:00
Daniel Borkmann
f869c91286 net: sctp: keep owned chunk in destructor_arg instead of skb->cb
It's just silly to hold the skb destructor argument around inside
skb->cb[] as we currently do in SCTP.

Nowadays, we're sort of cheating on data accounting in the sense
that due to commit 4c3a5bdae2 ("sctp: Don't charge for data in
sndbuf again when transmitting packet"), we orphan the skb already
in the SCTP output path, i.e. giving back charged data memory, and
use a different destructor only to make sure the sk doesn't vanish
on skb destruction time. Thus, cb[] is still valid here as we
operate within the SCTP layer. (It's generally actually a big
candidate for future rework, imho.)

However, storing the destructor in the cb[] can easily cause issues
should an non sctp_packet_set_owner_w()'ed skb ever escape the SCTP
layer, since cb[] may get overwritten by lower layers and thus can
corrupt the chunk pointer. There are no such issues at present,
but lets keep the chunk in destructor_arg, as this is the actual
purpose for it.

Signed-off-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Acked-by: Vlad Yasevich <vyasevich@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Neil Horman <nhorman@tuxdriver.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 14:46:12 -05:00
Willem de Bruijn
9c7077622d packet: make packet_snd fail on len smaller than l2 header
When sending packets out with PF_PACKET, SOCK_RAW, ensure that the
packet is at least as long as the device's expected link layer header.
This check already exists in tpacket_snd, but not in packet_snd.
Also rate limit the warning in tpacket_snd.

Signed-off-by: Willem de Bruijn <willemb@google.com>
Acked-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Acked-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 14:43:07 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
c7e2b9689e sched: introduce vlan action
This tc action allows to work with vlan tagged skbs. Two supported
sub-actions are header pop and header push.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Signed-off-by: Jamal Hadi Salim <jhs@mojatatu.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 14:20:18 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
93515d53b1 net: move vlan pop/push functions into common code
So it can be used from out of openvswitch code.
Did couple of cosmetic changes on the way, namely variable naming and
adding support for 8021AD proto.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 14:20:18 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
e21951212f net: move make_writable helper into common code
note that skb_make_writable already exists in net/netfilter/core.c
but does something slightly different.

Suggested-by: Eric Dumazet <eric.dumazet@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 14:20:17 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
5968250c86 vlan: introduce *vlan_hwaccel_push_inside helpers
Use them to push skb->vlan_tci into the payload and avoid code
duplication.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 14:20:17 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
62749e2cb3 vlan: rename __vlan_put_tag to vlan_insert_tag_set_proto
Name fits better. Plus there's going to be introduced
__vlan_insert_tag later on.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 14:20:17 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
b960a0ac69 vlan: make __vlan_hwaccel_put_tag return void
Always returns the same skb it gets, so change to void.

Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 14:20:16 -05:00
Jiri Pirko
1abcd82c20 openvswitch: actions: use skb_postpull_rcsum when possible
Replace duplicated code by calling skb_postpull_rcsum

Suggested-by: Eric Dumazet <eric.dumazet@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jiri Pirko <jiri@resnulli.us>
Acked-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Acked-by: Simon Horman <simon.horman@netronome.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 14:20:16 -05:00
Alexander Couzens
fe1591224a l2tp_eth: allow to set a specific mac address
Signed-off-by: Alexander Couzens <lynxis@fe80.eu>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 14:16:38 -05:00
David S. Miller
7e09dccd07 Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/pablo/nf
Pablo Neira Ayuso says:

====================
Netfilter fixes for net

The following patchset contains two bugfixes for your net tree, they are:

1) Validate netlink group from nfnetlink to avoid an out of bound array
   access. This should only happen with superuser priviledges though.
   Discovered by Andrey Ryabinin using trinity.

2) Don't push ethernet header before calling the netfilter output hook
   for multicast traffic, this breaks ebtables since it expects to see
   skb->data pointing to the network header, patch from Linus Luessing.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 00:12:39 -05:00
David S. Miller
c857781900 Merge tag 'master-2014-11-20' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/linville/wireless
John W. Linville says:

====================
pull request: wireless 2014-11-20

Please full this little batch of fixes intended for the 3.18 stream!

For the mac80211 patch, Johannes says:

"Here's another last minute fix, for minstrel HT crashing
depending on the value of some uninitialised stack."

On top of that...

Ben Greear fixes an ath9k regression in which a BSSID mask is
miscalculated.

Dmitry Torokhov corrects an error handling routing in brcmfmac which
was checking an unsigned variable for a negative value.

Johannes Berg avoids a build problem in brcmfmac for arches where
linux/unaligned/access_ok.h and asm/unaligned.h conflict.

Mathy Vanhoef addresses another brcmfmac issue so as to eliminate a
use-after-free of the URB transfer buffer if a timeout occurs.

Please let me know if there are problems!
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-21 00:07:51 -05:00
Jiri Bohac
01462405f0 ipx: fix locking regression in ipx_sendmsg and ipx_recvmsg
This fixes an old regression introduced by commit
b0d0d915 (ipx: remove the BKL).

When a recvmsg syscall blocks waiting for new data, no data can be sent on the
same socket with sendmsg because ipx_recvmsg() sleeps with the socket locked.

This breaks mars-nwe (NetWare emulator):
- the ncpserv process reads the request using recvmsg
- ncpserv forks and spawns nwconn
- ncpserv calls a (blocking) recvmsg and waits for new requests
- nwconn deadlocks in sendmsg on the same socket

Commit b0d0d915 has simply replaced BKL locking with
lock_sock/release_sock. Unlike now, BKL got unlocked while
sleeping, so a blocking recvmsg did not block a concurrent
sendmsg.

Only keep the socket locked while actually working with the socket data and
release it prior to calling skb_recv_datagram().

Signed-off-by: Jiri Bohac <jbohac@suse.cz>
Reviewed-by: Arnd Bergmann <arnd@arndb.de>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-20 22:57:03 -05:00
Joe Stringer
d3052bb5d3 openvswitch: Don't validate IPv6 label masks.
When userspace doesn't provide a mask, OVS datapath generates a fully
unwildcarded mask for the flow by copying the flow and setting all bits
in all fields. For IPv6 label, this creates a mask that matches on the
upper 12 bits, causing the following error:

openvswitch: netlink: Invalid IPv6 flow label value (value=ffffffff, max=fffff)

This patch ignores the label validation check for masks, avoiding this
error.

Signed-off-by: Joe Stringer <joestringer@nicira.com>
Acked-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-20 22:56:13 -05:00
John W. Linville
9a638ddfb0 It has been a while since my last pull request, so we accumulated
another relatively large set of changes:
  * TDLS off-channel support set from Arik/Liad, with some support
    patches I did
  * custom regulatory fixes from Arik
  * minstrel VHT fix (and a small optimisation) from Felix
  * add back radiotap vendor namespace support (myself)
  * random MAC address scanning for cfg80211/mac80211/hwsim (myself)
  * CSA improvements (Luca)
  * WoWLAN Net Detect (wake on network found) support (Luca)
  * and lots of other smaller changes from many people
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 
 iQIcBAABCAAGBQJUbghkAAoJEDBSmw7B7bqroosP/RABYXUMua+k3Ccq7T4eU4jV
 AEO2p2gt5nHBzEl1NCJtdUTJkZ6ftT7ehvAkV2zboB0FBoAoBTbZ8YDtcBBiWaY6
 wJ5TYuOl6LFo7csAxWxpCzUxW3M+iq26itpyW9Zt9WWxP4QLSNPFyXEXV3SEh45n
 HcDW9A0SE+mgdaTQ2LEMBJ5XWxG/Ic7i9Xn6Py3o4x7NsTB4EqFNOD0WXcPCq7M0
 H8xlsIYIBYoGNMsV/2Nu7CEgcSXfDLqWcs9uPHQMCvWPjx/vIoEyOgTwJlE9bQHh
 2tloc1LBP6XKQ6g2bJ/pBaQVnZGugcOJhD6KUq3ckNm9qIP1ZtRmJslH4V6pUSCS
 eGl3TcAKSSE4BWIa7AaETWXeoH4X68dO7PM7pnflQRCQLzCJRbDWCdqjBst/AxBT
 6hvAFAvExEcWBkNVSTJ2egRk/C9cDFKRaCWQ1h4wX9yvh+8efe1D0DDWLW9a9qv1
 LsoGJE72BZdXn2CaQEME+CjTd3fWmn6u729d/c863cq2kspCSOof0QD0X9uWhBUx
 BvqtgbQjGZzAvHFcjBd7yRd5hz0aDfLyBL59bq2IBzaU1QmyekNPqzSMSD+5ZlCp
 uxEeE5AY2+pcNZV1KRtkvgAByfUgAVd0FHZcVb8SIM6QZ3IhqiOuzxuXtxv6hrYP
 V/76B+ath4Sv1IPF56ex
 =q4e6
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'mac80211-next-for-john-2014-11-20' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/jberg/mac80211-next

Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> says:

"It has been a while since my last pull request, so we accumulated
another relatively large set of changes:
 * TDLS off-channel support set from Arik/Liad, with some support
   patches I did
 * custom regulatory fixes from Arik
 * minstrel VHT fix (and a small optimisation) from Felix
 * add back radiotap vendor namespace support (myself)
 * random MAC address scanning for cfg80211/mac80211/hwsim (myself)
 * CSA improvements (Luca)
 * WoWLAN Net Detect (wake on network found) support (Luca)
 * and lots of other smaller changes from many people"

Signed-off-by: John W. Linville <linville@tuxdriver.com>
2014-11-20 16:09:30 -05:00
Marcelo Leitner
beacd3e8ef netfilter: nfnetlink_log: Make use of pr_fmt where applicable
Signed-off-by: Marcelo Ricardo Leitner <mleitner@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-20 14:09:01 +01:00
Markus Elfring
982f405136 netfilter: Deletion of unnecessary checks before two function calls
The functions free_percpu() and module_put() test whether their argument
is NULL and then return immediately. Thus the test around the call is
not needed.

This issue was detected by using the Coccinelle software.

Signed-off-by: Markus Elfring <elfring@users.sourceforge.net>
Acked-by: Julian Anastasov <ja@ssi.bg>
Acked-by: Simon Horman <horms@verge.net.au>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-20 13:08:43 +01:00
Steffen Klassert
fbe68ee875 vti6: Add a lookup method for tunnels with wildcard endpoints.
Currently we can't lookup tunnels with wildcard endpoints.
This patch adds a method to lookup these tunnels in the
receive path.

Signed-off-by: Steffen Klassert <steffen.klassert@secunet.com>
2014-11-20 10:03:07 +01:00
Duan Jiong
ffb1388a36 ipv6: delete protocol and unregister rtnetlink when cleanup
pim6_protocol was added when initiation, but it not deleted.
Similarly, unregister RTNL_FAMILY_IP6MR rtnetlink.

Signed-off-by: Duan Jiong <duanj.fnst@cn.fujitsu.com>
Reviewed-by: Cong Wang <cwang@twopensource.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-19 16:56:17 -05:00
Al Viro
08adb7dabd fold verify_iovec() into copy_msghdr_from_user()
... and do the same on the compat side of things.

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-19 16:23:49 -05:00
Al Viro
0844932009 {compat_,}verify_iovec(): switch to generic copying of iovecs
use {compat_,}rw_copy_check_uvector().  As the result, we are
guaranteed that all iovecs seen in ->msg_iov by ->sendmsg()
and ->recvmsg() will pass access_ok().

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-19 16:23:16 -05:00
Al Viro
666547ff59 separate kernel- and userland-side msghdr
Kernel-side struct msghdr is (currently) using the same layout as
userland one, but it's not a one-to-one copy - even without considering
32bit compat issues, we have msg_iov, msg_name and msg_control copied
to kernel[1].  It's fairly localized, so we get away with a few functions
where that knowledge is needed (and we could shrink that set even
more).  Pretty much everything deals with the kernel-side variant and
the few places that want userland one just use a bunch of force-casts
to paper over the differences.

The thing is, kernel-side definition of struct msghdr is *not* exposed
in include/uapi - libc doesn't see it, etc.  So we can add struct user_msghdr,
with proper annotations and let the few places that ever deal with those
beasts use it for userland pointers.  Saner typechecking aside, that will
allow to change the layout of kernel-side msghdr - e.g. replace
msg_iov/msg_iovlen there with struct iov_iter, getting rid of the need
to modify the iovec as we copy data to/from it, etc.

We could introduce kernel_msghdr instead, but that would create much more
noise - the absolute majority of the instances would need to have the
type switched to kernel_msghdr and definition of struct msghdr in
include/linux/socket.h is not going to be seen by userland anyway.

This commit just introduces user_msghdr and switches the few places that
are dealing with userland-side msghdr to it.

[1] actually, it's even trickier than that - we copy msg_control for
sendmsg, but keep the userland address on recvmsg.

Signed-off-by: Al Viro <viro@zeniv.linux.org.uk>
2014-11-19 16:22:59 -05:00
John W. Linville
6158fb37d1 Here's another last minute fix, for minstrel HT crashing
depending on the value of some uninitialised stack.
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 
 iQIcBAABCAAGBQJUa70EAAoJEDBSmw7B7bqr40gQAMgNUKILuYTyHZaKR7teV8aG
 uVFzrMdmNjCZIsxAuH1X8VNOJZEAB+Ro+lTybNjC/tTPyA+Yu3lDCQjSYiE8UOFk
 mDrNFG0tjZHGn3axceLIhujfPqXEks/wQ98tDEJU2eMLxS0nClwyTXjhc1IxzUBO
 /L2HlhGWADRZ6FIV7yhRO33KN1l3Q8oxW79ybJq/5JCcclfGBt3OpYvi7AW6M4iK
 qfgTfS6GbpcRRc4+HVA/cgYOFaRmMI71bvqMgvh8MgmqfQeRw+WSOaUiLx795CsR
 OKrIQgdpVp2JHwHkFXIgBy+EBBbXtCozvxKX3u+YKPabj4GC/6dkT370nuvv9hkz
 IzTxt+yNBTqJawum7vM6WypgT4wCZOR0JbY0vDW5jYLJnDfGJkYFbny7WtRtCVf7
 xWzIixkyWLNFs6swbRdIKoU5GNw2fNe7az4fRoUqNtZGSPHiK7oD5sEkr81hWUV5
 5XsifngqekfdVvIGTckpy2SAikxgkrtHOQFIGJz+PN1CjvDT++66Opr3AHnwWeSP
 IAjmoVOCiyIBzXlcsZJmAfPa4Hvk+NAPRKCx6N25q/+ESpOZRARWFRV3VuPeGzQW
 +SiC4V9VYWHvW9VPJ37WkAFYv5tPaLLyURdU7p6MSwuc0RCPgtcvXty2QFbjQLdf
 k0apC9DZydQPF2kre6Pv
 =L2Jb
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'mac80211-for-john-2014-11-18' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/jberg/mac80211

Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> says:

"Here's another last minute fix, for minstrel HT crashing
depending on the value of some uninitialised stack."

Signed-off-by: John W. Linville <linville@tuxdriver.com>
2014-11-19 15:44:40 -05:00
John W. Linville
ab1f5a532c Merge commit '4e6ce4dc7ce71d0886908d55129d5d6482a27ff9' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/linville/wireless 2014-11-19 15:38:48 -05:00
Markus Elfring
fcd4d35ecc netlink: Deletion of an unnecessary check before the function call "__module_get"
The __module_get() function tests whether its argument is NULL and then
returns immediately. Thus the test around the call is not needed.

This issue was detected by using the Coccinelle software.

Signed-off-by: Markus Elfring <elfring@users.sourceforge.net>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-19 15:27:40 -05:00
Markus Elfring
ef87c5d6a1 net: pktgen: Deletion of an unnecessary check before the function call "proc_remove"
The proc_remove() function tests whether its argument is NULL and then
returns immediately. Thus the test around the call is not needed.

This issue was detected by using the Coccinelle software.

Signed-off-by: Markus Elfring <elfring@users.sourceforge.net>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-19 15:20:15 -05:00
Eric Dumazet
355a901e6c tcp: make connect() mem charging friendly
While working on sk_forward_alloc problems reported by Denys
Fedoryshchenko, we found that tcp connect() (and fastopen) do not call
sk_wmem_schedule() for SYN packet (and/or SYN/DATA packet), so
sk_forward_alloc is negative while connect is in progress.

We can fix this by calling regular sk_stream_alloc_skb() both for the
SYN packet (in tcp_connect()) and the syn_data packet in
tcp_send_syn_data()

Then, tcp_send_syn_data() can avoid copying syn_data as we simply
can manipulate syn_data->cb[] to remove SYN flag (and increment seq)

Instead of open coding memcpy_fromiovecend(), simply use this helper.

This leaves in socket write queue clean fast clone skbs.

This was tested against our fastopen packetdrill tests.

Reported-by: Denys Fedoryshchenko <nuclearcat@nuclearcat.com>
Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Acked-by: Yuchung Cheng <ycheng@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-19 14:57:01 -05:00
Felix Fietkau
75769c80e3 mac80211: minstrel_ht: add a small optimization to minstrel_aggr_check
Check the queue mapping earlier, skb->queue_mapping is more likely than
skb->data to still be in d-cache.

Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 19:31:07 +01:00
Johannes Berg
f815e2b3c0 mac80211: notify drivers on sta rate table changes
This allows drivers with a firmware or chip-based rate lookup table to
use the most recent default rate selection without having to get it from
per-packet data or explicit ieee80211_get_tx_rate calls

Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 19:15:50 +01:00
Tomasz Bursztyka
8f894be2df nl80211: Broadcast CMD_NEW_INTERFACE and CMD_DEL_INTERFACE
Let the other listeners being notified when a new or del interface
command has been issued, thus reducing later necessary request to be in
sync with current context.

Signed-off-by: Tomasz Bursztyka <tomasz.bursztyka@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 19:02:42 +01:00
Jukka Rissanen
18e5ca65e5 nl80211: Replace interface socket owner attribute with more generic one
Replace NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER attribute with more generic
NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER that can be used with other commands
that interface creation.

Signed-off-by: Jukka Rissanen <jukka.rissanen@linux.intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:54:40 +01:00
Rafał Miłecki
d687cbb703 cfg80211: protect fools returning NULL in add_virtual_intf
Callback add_virtual_intf is supposed to return ERR_PTR and trying to
return NULL results in some "Unable to handle kernel paging request",
etc. As it may be complicated to debug & trace, let's catch it (WARN).

Signed-off-by: Rafał Miłecki <zajec5@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:50:34 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
c7ab508190 cfg80211: explicitly initialize some fields in custom reg path
Explicitly initialize the DFS state and beacon found state when handling
channels in the custom regulatory path.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Acked-by: Luis R. Rodriguez <mcgrof@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:49:33 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
2e18b38fc8 cfg80211: update missing fields in custom regulatory path
Some channels fields were not being updated in the custom regulatory
path. Update them according to the code in handle_channel().

Signed-off-by: Jonathan Doron <jonathanx.doron@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Acked-by: Luis R. Rodriguez <mcgrof@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:49:33 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
628c010f1f mac80211: skip legacy rate mask handling for VHT rates
The rate mask code currently assumes that a rate is legacy if
IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS is not set. This might be the cause of bogus VHT
rates being reported with minstrel_ht.

Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:46:35 +01:00
Eliad Peller
8b1956f041 mac80211: don't allow 40MHz tx rates in case of 20MHz chandef
When 20MHz chandef is used, 40MHz rates shouldn't be
used (by the rate-control algorithm), even if the sta
ht capabilities indicate support for it.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
Singed-off-by: Emmanuel Grumbach <emmanuel.grumbach@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:46:30 +01:00
Johannes Berg
a344d6778a mac80211: allow drivers to support NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR
Allow drivers to support NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR with software
based scanning and generate a random MAC address for them for every
scan request with the flag.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:46:09 +01:00
Johannes Berg
6ea0a69ca2 mac80211: rcu-ify scan and scheduled scan request pointers
In order to use the scan and scheduled scan request pointers during
RX to check for randomisation, make them accessible using RCU.

Reviewed-by: Emmanuel Grumbach <emmanuel.grumbach@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:58 +01:00
Johannes Berg
ad2b26abc1 cfg80211: allow drivers to support random MAC addresses for scan
Add the necessary feature flags and a scan flag to support using
random MAC addresses for scan while unassociated.

The configuration for this supports an arbitrary MAC address
value and mask, so that any kind of configuration (e.g. fixed
OUI or full 46-bit random) can be requested. Full 46-bit random
is the default when no other configuration is passed.

Also add a small helper function to use the addr/mask correctly.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:52 +01:00
Eliad Peller
ff5db4392c mac80211: remove redundant check
local->scan_req was tested in the previous line, so it
can't be NULL.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:48 +01:00
Luciano Coelho
8cd4d4563e cfg80211: add wowlan net-detect support
Add a new WoWLAN API to enable net-detect as a wake up trigger.
Net-detect allows the device to scan in the background while the
host is asleep to wake up the host system when a matching network
is found.

Reuse the scheduled scan attributes to specify how the scan is
performed while suspended and the matches that will trigger a
wake event.

Signed-off-by: Luciano Coelho <luciano.coelho@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:45 +01:00
Luciano Coelho
256da02d18 cfg80211: refactor nl80211_start_sched_scan so it can be reused
For net detect, we will need to reuse most of the scheduled scan
parsing function, but not all, so split out the attributes parsing
part out of the main start sched_scan function.

Signed-off-by: Luciano Coelho <luciano.coelho@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:42 +01:00
Liad Kaufman
b6da911b3c mac80211: synchronously reserve TID per station
In TDLS (e.g., TDLS off-channel) there is a requirement for
some drivers to supply an unused TID between the AP and the
device to the FW, to allow sending PTI requests and to allow
the FW to aggregate on a specific TID for better throughput.

To ensure that the allocated TID is indeed unused, this patch
introduces an API for blocking the driver from TXing on that
TID.

Signed-off-by: Liad Kaufman <liad.kaufman@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:36 +01:00
Liad Kaufman
4f9610d528 mac80211: add specific-queue flushing support
If the HW supports IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL, allow
flushing only specific queues rather than all of them.

Signed-off-by: Liad Kaufman <liad.kaufman@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:30 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
8a4d32f30d mac80211: add TDLS channel-switch Rx flow
When receiving a TDLS channel switch request or response, parse the frame
and call a new tdls_recv_channel_switch op in the low level driver with
the parsed data.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:26 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
a7a6bdd067 mac80211: introduce TDLS channel switch ops
Implement the cfg80211 TDLS channel switch ops and introduce new mac80211
ones for low-level drivers.
Verify low-level driver support for the new ops when using the relevant
wiphy feature bit. Also verify the peer supports channel switching before
passing the command down.

Add a new STA flag to track the off-channel state with the TDLS peer and
make sure to cancel the channel-switch if the peer STA is unexpectedly
removed.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:21 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
5383758443 mac80211: add parsing of TDLS specific IEs
These are used in TDLS channel switching code.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:16 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
1057d35ede cfg80211: introduce TDLS channel switch commands
Introduce commands to initiate and cancel TDLS channel-switching. Once
TDLS channel-switching is started, the lower level driver is responsible
for continually initiating channel-switch operations and returning to
the base (AP) channel to listen for beacons from time to time.

Upon cancellation of the channel-switch all communication between the
relevant TDLS peers will continue on the base channel.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:12 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
c273390569 mac80211: prepare TDLS mgmt code for channel-switch templates
Split the data-generating from the Tx-sending functionality, as we do
not want to send templates to the lower driver. Also add an optional
chandef argument to the data-generating portion. It will be used for
channel-switch templates.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:07 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
9041c1fa57 mac80211: track AP and peer STA TDLS chan-switch support
The AP or peer can prohibit TDLS channel switch via a bit in the
extended capabilities IE. Parse the IE and track this bit. Set an
appropriate STA flag if both the AP and peer STA support TDLS
channel-switching.

Add the new STA flag and the missing TDLS_INITIATOR to debugfs.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:45:04 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
78632a17ea cfg/mac80211: define TDLS channel switch feature bit
Define some related TDLS protocol constants and advertise channel switch
support in the extended-capabilities IE when the feature bit is defined.

Actually supporting TDLS channel-switching also requires support for
some new nl80211 commands, to be introduced by future patches.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:44:58 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
2cedd87960 mac80211: add BSS coex IE to TDLS setup frames
Add the BSS coex IE in case we support HT40 channels, as mandated by
section 8.5.13 in IEEE802.11 2012.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:44:52 +01:00
Arik Nemtsov
f0d29cb979 mac80211: add supported channels IE during TDLS setup
This information element is mandatory in case TDLS channel-switching is to
be supported. The channels given are ones supported and allowed to be
active in the current regulatory setting.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:44:47 +01:00
Johannes Berg
7528ec5776 mac80211: add function to create data frame template including key
For some TDLS channel switch implementations data frames need to be
sent by the firmware based on a template. This template should be
created by mac80211, and thus needs to properly be built from an
802.3 frame into an 802.11 frame. In addition, the device will need
the key information so the select_key handler needs to be run.
However, the driver/device will be responsible for all of the crypto
encapsulation, as the sequence numbers etc. cannot be built by the
host anyway in this case since it's a template to be used multiple
times.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:44:43 +01:00
Johannes Berg
4c9451ed94 mac80211: factor out 802.11 header building code
Factor out the 802.11 header building code from the xmit function
to be able to use it separately in a later commit.

While at it, fix up some documentation.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:44:38 +01:00
Johannes Berg
73c4e195e6 mac80211: move skb info band assignment out
Instead of passing the band as a parameter to ieee80211_xmit()
and ieee80211_tx(), move it outside of the two functions while
making sure info->band is set up before calling them.

This removes the parameter and simplifies the follow commit.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:44:35 +01:00
Liad Kaufman
1277b4a9f5 mac80211: retransmit TDLS teardown packet through AP if not ACKed
Since the TDLS peer station might not receive the teardown
packet (e.g., when in PS), this makes sure the packet is
retransmitted - this time through the AP - if the TDLS peer
didn't ACK the packet.

Signed-off-by: Liad Kaufman <liad.kaufman@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:44:29 +01:00
Liad Kaufman
24d342c514 mac80211: add option for setting skb flags before xmit
Allows setting of an skb's flags - if needed - when calling
ieee80211_subif_start_xmit().

Signed-off-by: Liad Kaufman <liad.kaufman@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arik@wizery.com>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-19 18:44:19 +01:00
J. Bruce Fields
56429e9b3b merge nfs bugfixes into nfsd for-3.19 branch
In addition to nfsd bugfixes, there are some fixes in -rc5 for client
bugs that can interfere with my testing.
2014-11-19 12:06:30 -05:00
Trond Myklebust
093a1468b6 SUNRPC: Fix locking around callback channel reply receive
Both xprt_lookup_rqst() and xprt_complete_rqst() require that you
take the transport lock in order to avoid races with xprt_transmit().

Signed-off-by: Trond Myklebust <trond.myklebust@primarydata.com>
Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org
Reviewed-by: Jeff Layton <jlayton@primarydata.com>
Signed-off-by: J. Bruce Fields <bfields@redhat.com>
2014-11-19 12:03:20 -05:00
Johan Hedberg
0378b59770 Bluetooth: Convert link keys list to use RCU
This patch converts the hdev->link_keys list to be protected through
RCU, thereby eliminating the need to hold the hdev lock while accessing
the list.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-19 16:19:47 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
cb6f3f7ace Bluetooth: Fix setting conn->pending_sec_level value from link key
When a connection is requested the conn->pending_sec_level value gets
set to whatever level the user requested the connection to be. During
the pairing process there are various sanity checks to try to ensure
that the right length PIN or right IO Capability is used to satisfy the
target security level. However, when we finally get hold of the link key
that is to be used we should still set the actual final security level
from the key type.

This way when we eventually get an Encrypt Change event the correct
value gets copied to conn->sec_level.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-19 16:17:32 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
22a3ceabf1 Bluetooth: Fix setting state back to TASK_RUNNING
In __hci_cmd_sync_ev() and __hci_req_sync() if the hci_req_run() call
fails and we return from the functions we should ensure that the state
doesn't remain in TASK_INTERRUPTIBLE that we just set it to. This patch
fixes missing calls to set_current_state(TASK_RUNNING) in both places.

Reported-by: Kirill A. Shutemov <kirill@shutemov.name>
Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Tested-by: Kirill A. Shutemov <kirill@shutemov.name>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-19 16:15:55 +01:00
Felix Fietkau
280ba51d60 mac80211: minstrel_ht: fix a crash in rate sorting
The commit 5935839ad7
"mac80211: improve minstrel_ht rate sorting by throughput & probability"

introduced a crash on rate sorting that occurs when the rate added to
the sorting array is faster than all the previous rates. Due to an
off-by-one error, it reads the rate index from tp_list[-1], which
contains uninitialized stack garbage, and then uses the resulting index
for accessing the group rate stats, leading to a crash if the garbage
value is big enough.

Cc: Thomas Huehn <thomas@net.t-labs.tu-berlin.de>
Reported-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-18 22:39:16 +01:00
Rick Jones
e3e3217029 icmp: Remove some spurious dropped packet profile hits from the ICMP path
If icmp_rcv() has successfully processed the incoming ICMP datagram, we
should use consume_skb() rather than kfree_skb() because a hit on the likes
of perf -e skb:kfree_skb is not called-for.

Signed-off-by: Rick Jones <rick.jones2@hp.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-18 15:28:28 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
54aeba7f06 dev_ioctl: use sizeof(x) instead of sizeof x
Also remove spaces after cast.

Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-18 15:27:32 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
e56f735913 net/core: include linux/types.h instead of asm/types.h
Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-18 15:26:32 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
1d2398dc7c net: fix spelling for synchronized
Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-18 15:26:32 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
a77b634367 dccp: spelling s/reseting/resetting
Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-18 15:26:32 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
02c31d2e56 dccp: replace min/casting by min_t
Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-18 15:26:32 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
54da7996b8 dccp: remove blank lines between function/EXPORT_SYMBOL
See Documentation/CodingStyle chapter 6.

Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-18 15:26:32 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
6d80c4732b dccp: kerneldoc warning fixes
Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-18 15:26:31 -05:00
John W. Linville
f48ecb19bc Merge branch 'for-upstream' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/bluetooth/bluetooth-next
Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@gmail.com> says:

"Here's another bluetooth-next pull request for 3.19. We've got:

 - Various fixes, cleanups and improvements to ieee802154/mac802154
 - Support for a Broadcom BCM20702A1 variant
 - Lots of lockdep fixes
 - Fixed handling of LE CoC errors that should trigger SMP"

Signed-off-by: John W. Linville <linville@tuxdriver.com>
2014-11-18 15:13:26 -05:00
Johannes Berg
760a52e80f Merge remote-tracking branch 'wireless-next/master' into mac80211-next
This brings in some mwifiex changes that further patches will
need to work on top to not cause merge conflicts.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-18 09:32:44 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
76727c02c1 Bluetooth: Call drain_workqueue() before resetting state
Doing things like hci_conn_hash_flush() while holding the hdev lock is
risky since its synchronous pending work cancellation could cause the
L2CAP layer to try to reacquire the hdev lock. Right now there doesn't
seem to be any obvious places where this would for certain happen but
it's already enough to cause lockdep to start warning against the hdev
and the work struct locks being taken in the "wrong" order:

[  +0.000373] mgmt-tester/1603 is trying to acquire lock:
[  +0.000292]  ((&conn->pending_rx_work)){+.+.+.}, at: [<c104266d>] flush_work+0x0/0x181
[  +0.000270]
but task is already holding lock:
[  +0.000000]  (&hdev->lock){+.+.+.}, at: [<c13b9a80>] hci_dev_do_close+0x166/0x359
[  +0.000000]
which lock already depends on the new lock.

[  +0.000000]
the existing dependency chain (in reverse order) is:
[  +0.000000]
-> #1 (&hdev->lock){+.+.+.}:
[  +0.000000]        [<c105ea8f>] lock_acquire+0xe3/0x156
[  +0.000000]        [<c140c663>] mutex_lock_nested+0x54/0x375
[  +0.000000]        [<c13d644b>] l2cap_recv_frame+0x293/0x1a9c
[  +0.000000]        [<c13d7ca4>] process_pending_rx+0x50/0x5e
[  +0.000000]        [<c1041a3f>] process_one_work+0x21c/0x436
[  +0.000000]        [<c1041e3d>] worker_thread+0x1be/0x251
[  +0.000000]        [<c1045a22>] kthread+0x94/0x99
[  +0.000000]        [<c140f801>] ret_from_kernel_thread+0x21/0x30
[  +0.000000]
-> #0 ((&conn->pending_rx_work)){+.+.+.}:
[  +0.000000]        [<c105e158>] __lock_acquire+0xa07/0xc89
[  +0.000000]        [<c105ea8f>] lock_acquire+0xe3/0x156
[  +0.000000]        [<c1042696>] flush_work+0x29/0x181
[  +0.000000]        [<c1042864>] __cancel_work_timer+0x76/0x8f
[  +0.000000]        [<c104288c>] cancel_work_sync+0xf/0x11
[  +0.000000]        [<c13d4c18>] l2cap_conn_del+0x72/0x183
[  +0.000000]        [<c13d8953>] l2cap_disconn_cfm+0x49/0x55
[  +0.000000]        [<c13be37a>] hci_conn_hash_flush+0x7a/0xc3
[  +0.000000]        [<c13b9af6>] hci_dev_do_close+0x1dc/0x359
[  +0.012038]        [<c13bbe38>] hci_unregister_dev+0x6e/0x1a3
[  +0.000000]        [<c12d33c1>] vhci_release+0x28/0x47
[  +0.000000]        [<c10dd6a9>] __fput+0xd6/0x154
[  +0.000000]        [<c10dd757>] ____fput+0xd/0xf
[  +0.000000]        [<c1044bb2>] task_work_run+0x6b/0x8d
[  +0.000000]        [<c1001bd2>] do_notify_resume+0x3c/0x3f
[  +0.000000]        [<c140fa70>] work_notifysig+0x29/0x31
[  +0.000000]
other info that might help us debug this:

[  +0.000000]  Possible unsafe locking scenario:

[  +0.000000]        CPU0                    CPU1
[  +0.000000]        ----                    ----
[  +0.000000]   lock(&hdev->lock);
[  +0.000000]                                lock((&conn->pending_rx_work));
[  +0.000000]                                lock(&hdev->lock);
[  +0.000000]   lock((&conn->pending_rx_work));
[  +0.000000]
 *** DEADLOCK ***

Fully fixing this would require some quite heavy refactoring to change
how the hdev lock and hci_conn instances are handled together. A simpler
solution for now which this patch takes is to try ensure that the hdev
workqueue is empty before proceeding with the various cleanup calls,
including hci_conn_hash_flush().

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-18 08:32:08 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
38da170306 Bluetooth: Use shorter "rand" name for "randomizer"
The common short form of "randomizer" is "rand" in many places
(including the Bluetooth specification). The shorter version also makes
for easier to read code with less forced line breaks. This patch renames
all occurences of "randomizer" to "rand" in the Bluetooth subsystem
code.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-18 01:53:15 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
c19a495c8b Bluetooth: Fix BR/EDR-only address checks for remote OOB data
For now the mgmt commands dealing with remote OOB data are strictly
BR/EDR-only. This patch fixes missing checks for the passed address type
so that any non-BR/EDR value triggers the appropriate error response.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-18 01:53:15 +01:00
Vasily Averin
2c7b5d5dac netfilter: nf_conntrack_h323: lookup route from proper net namespace
Signed-off-by: Vasily Averin <vvs@parallels.com>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-17 12:47:14 +01:00
Florian Westphal
e59ea3df3f netfilter: xt_connlimit: honor conntrack zone if available
Currently all the conntrack lookups are done using default zone.
In case the skb has a ct attached (e.g. template) we should use this zone
for lookups instead.  This makes connlimit work with connections assigned
to other zones.

Signed-off-by: Florian Westphal <fw@strlen.de>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-17 12:44:20 +01:00
Linus Lüssing
f0b4eeced5 bridge: fix netfilter/NF_BR_LOCAL_OUT for own, locally generated queries
Ebtables on the OUTPUT chain (NF_BR_LOCAL_OUT) would not work as expected
for both locally generated IGMP and MLD queries. The IP header specific
filter options are off by 14 Bytes for netfilter (actual output on
interfaces is fine).

NF_HOOK() expects the skb->data to point to the IP header, not the
ethernet one (while dev_queue_xmit() does not). Luckily there is an
br_dev_queue_push_xmit() helper function already - let's just use that.

Introduced by eb1d164143
("bridge: Add core IGMP snooping support")

Ebtables example:

$ ebtables -I OUTPUT -p IPv6 -o eth1 --logical-out br0 \
	--log --log-level 6 --log-ip6 --log-prefix="~EBT: " -j DROP

before (broken):

~EBT:  IN= OUT=eth1 MAC source = 02:04:64:a4:39:c2 \
	MAC dest = 33:33:00:00:00:01 proto = 0x86dd IPv6 \
	SRC=64a4:39c2:86dd:6000:0000:0020:0001:fe80 IPv6 \
	DST=0000:0000:0000:0004:64ff:fea4:39c2:ff02, \
	IPv6 priority=0x3, Next Header=2

after (working):

~EBT:  IN= OUT=eth1 MAC source = 02:04:64:a4:39:c2 \
	MAC dest = 33:33:00:00:00:01 proto = 0x86dd IPv6 \
	SRC=fe80:0000:0000:0000:0004:64ff:fea4:39c2 IPv6 \
	DST=ff02:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0001, \
	IPv6 priority=0x0, Next Header=0

Signed-off-by: Linus Lüssing <linus.luessing@web.de>
Acked-by: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-17 12:38:02 +01:00
Pablo Neira Ayuso
97840cb67f netfilter: nfnetlink: fix insufficient validation in nfnetlink_bind
Make sure the netlink group exists, otherwise you can trigger an out
of bound array memory access from the netlink_bind() path. This splat
can only be triggered only by superuser.

[  180.203600] UBSan: Undefined behaviour in ../net/netfilter/nfnetlink.c:467:28
[  180.204249] index 9 is out of range for type 'int [9]'
[  180.204697] CPU: 0 PID: 1771 Comm: trinity-main Not tainted 3.18.0-rc4-mm1+ #122
[  180.205365] Hardware name: QEMU Standard PC (i440FX + PIIX, 1996), BIOS rel-1.7.5-0-ge51488c-20140602_164612-nilsson.home.kraxel.org
+04/01/2014
[  180.206498]  0000000000000018 0000000000000000 0000000000000009 ffff88007bdf7da8
[  180.207220]  ffffffff82b0ef5f 0000000000000092 ffffffff845ae2e0 ffff88007bdf7db8
[  180.207887]  ffffffff8199e489 ffff88007bdf7e18 ffffffff8199ea22 0000003900000000
[  180.208639] Call Trace:
[  180.208857] dump_stack (lib/dump_stack.c:52)
[  180.209370] ubsan_epilogue (lib/ubsan.c:174)
[  180.209849] __ubsan_handle_out_of_bounds (lib/ubsan.c:400)
[  180.210512] nfnetlink_bind (net/netfilter/nfnetlink.c:467)
[  180.210986] netlink_bind (net/netlink/af_netlink.c:1483)
[  180.211495] SYSC_bind (net/socket.c:1541)

Moreover, define the missing nf_tables and nf_acct multicast groups too.

Reported-by: Andrey Ryabinin <a.ryabinin@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-17 12:01:13 +01:00
Alexander Aring
ee7b9053bd ieee802154: fix byteorder for short address and panid
This patch changes the byteorder handling for short and panid handling.
We now except to get little endian in nl802154 for these attributes.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:17 +01:00
Alexander Aring
cb41c8dd01 ieee802154: rename and move WPAN_NUM_ defines
This patch moves the 802.15.4 constraints WPAN_NUM_ defines into
"net/ieee802154.h" which should contain all necessary 802.15.4 related
information. Also rename these defines to a common name which is
IEEE802154_MAX_CHANNEL and IEEE802154_MAX_PAGE.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:17 +01:00
Alexander Aring
b821ecd4c8 ieee802154: add del interface command
This patch adds support for deleting a wpan interface via nl802154.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:17 +01:00
Alexander Aring
0e57547eb7 ieee802154: setting extended address while iface add
This patch adds support for setting an extended address while
registration a new interface. If ieee802154_is_valid_extended_addr
getting as parameter and invalid extended address then the perm address
is fallback. This is useful to make some default handling while for
example default registration of a wpan interface while phy registration.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:16 +01:00
Alexander Aring
f3ea5e4423 ieee802154: add new interface command
This patch adds a new nl802154 command for adding a new interface
according to a wpan phy via nl802154.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:16 +01:00
Alexander Aring
133d3f3172 mac802154: remove wpan_dev parameter in if_add
This parameter was grabbed from wireless implementation with the
identically wireless dev struct. We don't need this right now and so we
remove it. Maybe we will add it later again if we found any real reason
to have such parameter.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:16 +01:00
Alexander Aring
944742a36d mac802154: use new nl802154 iftype types
This patch replace the depracted IEEE802154_DEV to the new introduced
NL802154_IFTYPE_NODE types. There is a backwards compatibility to have
the identical types for both enum definitions. Also remove some inlcude
issue with "linux/nl802154.h", because the export nl_policy inside this
header it was always necessary to have an include of "net/rtnetlink.h"
before. The reason for this is more complicated. Nevertheless we removed
this now, because "linux/nl802154.h" is the depracted netlink interface.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:15 +01:00
Alexander Aring
cd11d935f2 mac802154: remove deprecated linux-zigbee info
We don't and we can't name it zigbee anymore. This patch removes
deprecated information for project website.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:15 +01:00
Alexander Aring
628b1e1136 mac802154: remove const for non pointer in rdev-ops
This patches removes the const keyword in variables which are non
pointers. There is no sense to declare call by value parameters as
const.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Reported-by: Marc Kleine-Budde <mkl@pengutronix.de>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:15 +01:00
Alexander Aring
6d5fb87745 mac802154: remove const for non pointer in cfg ops
This patches removes the const keyword in variables which are non
pointers. There is no sense to declare call by value parameters as
const.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Reported-by: Marc Kleine-Budde <mkl@pengutronix.de>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:15 +01:00
Alexander Aring
29cd54b9bf mac802154: remove const for non pointer in driver-ops
This patches removes the const keyword in variables which are non
pointers. There is no sense to declare call by value parameters as const.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Reported-by: Marc Kleine-Budde <mkl@pengutronix.de>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:14 +01:00
Alexander Aring
197304b7a5 mac802154: remove unused prototypes
This patch removes some prototypes which are not used anymore.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Aring <alex.aring@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-17 09:49:14 +01:00
Daniel Borkmann
feb91a02cc ipv6: mld: fix add_grhead skb_over_panic for devs with large MTUs
It has been reported that generating an MLD listener report on
devices with large MTUs (e.g. 9000) and a high number of IPv6
addresses can trigger a skb_over_panic():

skbuff: skb_over_panic: text:ffffffff80612a5d len:3776 put:20
head:ffff88046d751000 data:ffff88046d751010 tail:0xed0 end:0xec0
dev:port1
 ------------[ cut here ]------------
kernel BUG at net/core/skbuff.c:100!
invalid opcode: 0000 [#1] SMP
Modules linked in: ixgbe(O)
CPU: 3 PID: 0 Comm: swapper/3 Tainted: G O 3.14.23+ #4
[...]
Call Trace:
 <IRQ>
 [<ffffffff80578226>] ? skb_put+0x3a/0x3b
 [<ffffffff80612a5d>] ? add_grhead+0x45/0x8e
 [<ffffffff80612e3a>] ? add_grec+0x394/0x3d4
 [<ffffffff80613222>] ? mld_ifc_timer_expire+0x195/0x20d
 [<ffffffff8061308d>] ? mld_dad_timer_expire+0x45/0x45
 [<ffffffff80255b5d>] ? call_timer_fn.isra.29+0x12/0x68
 [<ffffffff80255d16>] ? run_timer_softirq+0x163/0x182
 [<ffffffff80250e6f>] ? __do_softirq+0xe0/0x21d
 [<ffffffff8025112b>] ? irq_exit+0x4e/0xd3
 [<ffffffff802214bb>] ? smp_apic_timer_interrupt+0x3b/0x46
 [<ffffffff8063f10a>] ? apic_timer_interrupt+0x6a/0x70

mld_newpack() skb allocations are usually requested with dev->mtu
in size, since commit 72e09ad107 ("ipv6: avoid high order allocations")
we have changed the limit in order to be less likely to fail.

However, in MLD/IGMP code, we have some rather ugly AVAILABLE(skb)
macros, which determine if we may end up doing an skb_put() for
adding another record. To avoid possible fragmentation, we check
the skb's tailroom as skb->dev->mtu - skb->len, which is a wrong
assumption as the actual max allocation size can be much smaller.

The IGMP case doesn't have this issue as commit 57e1ab6ead
("igmp: refine skb allocations") stores the allocation size in
the cb[].

Set a reserved_tailroom to make it fit into the MTU and use
skb_availroom() helper instead. This also allows to get rid of
igmp_skb_size().

Reported-by: Wei Liu <lw1a2.jing@gmail.com>
Fixes: 72e09ad107 ("ipv6: avoid high order allocations")
Signed-off-by: Daniel Borkmann <dborkman@redhat.com>
Cc: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Cc: Hannes Frederic Sowa <hannes@stressinduktion.org>
Cc: David L Stevens <david.stevens@oracle.com>
Acked-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Acked-by: Hannes Frederic Sowa <hannes@stressinduktion.org>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-16 16:55:06 -05:00
Eric Dumazet
960fb622f8 net: provide a per host RSS key generic infrastructure
RSS (Receive Side Scaling) typically uses Toeplitz hash and a 40 or 52 bytes
RSS key.

Some drivers use a constant (and well known key), some drivers use a random
key per port, making bonding setups hard to tune. Well known keys increase
attack surface, considering that number of queues is usually a power of two.

This patch provides infrastructure to help drivers doing the right thing.

netdev_rss_key_fill() should be used by drivers to initialize their RSS key,
even if they provide ethtool -X support to let user redefine the key later.

A new /proc/sys/net/core/netdev_rss_key file can be used to get the host
RSS key even for drivers not providing ethtool -x support, in case some
applications want to precisely setup flows to match some RX queues.

Tested:

myhost:~# cat /proc/sys/net/core/netdev_rss_key
11:63:99:bb:79:fb:a5:a7:07:45:b2:20:bf:02:42:2d:08:1a:dd:19:2b:6b:23:ac:56:28:9d:70:c3:ac:e8:16:4b:b7:c1:10:53:a4:78:41:36:40:74:b6:15:ca:27:44:aa:b3:4d:72

myhost:~# ethtool -x eth0
RX flow hash indirection table for eth0 with 8 RX ring(s):
    0:      0     1     2     3     4     5     6     7
RSS hash key:
11:63:99:bb:79:fb:a5:a7:07:45:b2:20:bf:02:42:2d:08:1a:dd:19:2b:6b:23:ac:56:28:9d:70:c3:ac:e8:16:4b:b7:c1:10:53:a4:78:41

Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-16 15:59:11 -05:00
David S. Miller
c6ab766e81 Merge branch 'net_ovs' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/pshelar/openvswitch
Pravin B Shelar says:

====================
Open vSwitch

Following fixes are accumulated in ovs-repo.
Three of them are related to protocol processing, one is
related to memory leak in case of error and one is to
fix race.
Patch "Validate IPv6 flow key and mask values" has conflicts
with net-next, Let me know if you want me to send the patch
for net-next.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-16 14:59:01 -05:00
Anish Bhatt
52cff74eef dcbnl : Disable software interrupts before taking dcb_lock
Solves possible lockup issues that can be seen from firmware DCB agents calling
into the DCB app api.

DCB firmware event queues can be tied in with NAPI so that dcb events are
generated in softIRQ context. This can results in calls to dcb_*app()
functions which try to take the dcb_lock.

If the the event triggers while we also have the dcb_lock because lldpad or
some other agent happened to be issuing a  get/set command we could see a cpu
lockup.

This code was not originally written with firmware agents in mind, hence
grabbing dcb_lock from softIRQ context was not considered.

Signed-off-by: Anish Bhatt <anish@chelsio.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-16 14:50:52 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
6f2aed6ad7 net: dsa: replace count*size kzalloc by kcalloc
kcalloc manages count*sizeof overflow.

Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-16 14:41:39 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
5bc4b46a70 net: dsa: replace count*size kmalloc by kmalloc_array
kmalloc_array manages count*sizeof overflow.

Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-16 14:41:39 -05:00
Fabian Frederick
f35423c137 openvswitch: use PTR_ERR_OR_ZERO
Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Acked-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-16 14:41:39 -05:00
Holger Brunck
0372bf5c09 tipc: allow one link per bearer to neighboring nodes
There is no reason to limit the amount of possible links to a
neighboring node to 2. If we have more then two bearers we can also
establish more links.

Signed-off-by: Holger Brunck <holger.brunck@keymile.com>
Reviewed-By: Jon Maloy <jon.maloy@ericsson.com>
cc: Ying Xue <ying.xue@windriver.com>
cc: Erik Hugne <erik.hugne@ericsson.com>
cc: netdev@vger.kernel.org
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-16 14:27:17 -05:00
David S. Miller
f1227c5c1b Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/pablo/nf
Pablo Neira Ayuso says:

====================
Netfilter/IPVS fixes for net

The following patchset contains Netfilter updates for your net tree,
they are:

1) Fix missing initialization of the range structure (allocated in the
   stack) in nft_masq_{ipv4, ipv6}_eval, from Daniel Borkmann.

2) Make sure the data we receive from userspace contains the req_version
   structure, otherwise return an error incomplete on truncated input.
   From Dan Carpenter.

3) Fix handling og skb->sk which may cause incorrect handling
   of connections from a local process. Via Simon Horman, patch from
   Calvin Owens.

4) Fix wrong netns in nft_compat when setting target and match params
   structure.

5) Relax chain type validation in nft_compat that was recently included,
   this broke the matches that need to be run from the route chain type.
   Now iptables-test.py automated regression tests report success again
   and we avoid the only possible problematic case, which is the use of
   nat targets out of nat chain type.

6) Use match->table to validate the tablename, instead of the match->name.
   Again patch for nft_compat.

7) Restore the synchronous release of objects from the commit and abort
   path in nf_tables. This is causing two major problems: splats when using
   nft_compat, given that matches and targets may sleep and call_rcu is
   invoked from softirq context. Moreover Patrick reported possible event
   notification reordering when rules refer to anonymous sets.

8) Fix race condition in between packets that are being confirmed by
   conntrack and the ctnetlink flush operation. This happens since the
   removal of the central spinlock. Thanks to Jesper D. Brouer to looking
   into this.
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-16 14:23:56 -05:00
Panu Matilainen
49dd18ba46 ipv4: Fix incorrect error code when adding an unreachable route
Trying to add an unreachable route incorrectly returns -ESRCH if
if custom FIB rules are present:

[root@localhost ~]# ip route add 74.125.31.199 dev eth0 via 1.2.3.4
RTNETLINK answers: Network is unreachable
[root@localhost ~]# ip rule add to 55.66.77.88 table 200
[root@localhost ~]# ip route add 74.125.31.199 dev eth0 via 1.2.3.4
RTNETLINK answers: No such process
[root@localhost ~]#

Commit 83886b6b63 ("[NET]: Change "not found"
return value for rule lookup") changed fib_rules_lookup()
to use -ESRCH as a "not found" code internally, but for user space it
should be translated into -ENETUNREACH. Handle the translation centrally in
ipv4-specific fib_lookup(), leaving the DECnet case alone.

On a related note, commit b7a71b51ee
("ipv4: removed redundant conditional") removed a similar translation from
ip_route_input_slow() prematurely AIUI.

Fixes: b7a71b51ee ("ipv4: removed redundant conditional")
Signed-off-by: Panu Matilainen <pmatilai@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-16 14:11:45 -05:00
Ingo Molnar
e9ac5f0fa8 Merge branch 'sched/urgent' into sched/core, to pick up fixes before applying more changes
Signed-off-by: Ingo Molnar <mingo@kernel.org>
2014-11-16 10:50:25 +01:00
Linus Torvalds
1afcb6ed0d NFS client bugfixes for Linux 3.18
Highlights include:
 
 - Stable patches to fix NFSv4.x delegation reclaim error paths
 - Fix a bug whereby we were advertising NFSv4.1 but using NFSv4.2 features
 - Fix a use-after-free problem with pNFS block layouts
 - Fix a memory leak in the pNFS files O_DIRECT code
 - Replace an intrusive and Oops-prone performance fix in the NFSv4 atomic
   open code with a safer one-line version and revert the two original patches.
 -----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----
 Version: GnuPG v1
 
 iQIcBAABAgAGBQJUZol9AAoJEGcL54qWCgDyNQQQALnngvpPR51BoO/iTz9ruXol
 fGZy0SRIlTUKm1ArsQsQ+HGbV5K0hgP3Tg+z2AtEEZ8u/2Fi2Bqdl6+eNY12tKHd
 uUctDdM5TXLrETAn1UULrnd2eX1cvPMBfOlXlAdNHHsGEgC7w7YQ+rzGwnls+HDy
 LYXzY7Y3jYGdTMaRgZc5YRdtd8JBpCxciRvPEQLDIobwP0JnZC1afTLe1XInqB2I
 TZ4NTHT+DEWA+Ou1P2deL7+RuJNEAeWWBvULJy76n4BqKvN/HNedOO5HyBYXrwSd
 3UX3wbx9CWRxN1F0EqNKxjxZ/597JwqBeNoTDRcofLsqumUfAOtlbym1EahcD3Ls
 pykopNfgUhGuhxolStmuHdS6CnyQPERpR5lFZcDp7XtcwSq4FcwD8DRzLJMZW5dg
 N1lkfFlwQN3rqdk/NEHL+IxS41Hlk4HXjMoP6MNbRtqzIN6tW9tvC4MtAWd1aYxO
 YuUW281pbWxXQ731s0kTIrMUdQ9vGSRBMcbnO9rL3o+xkh8y5SPVkx9lhdhJN0UD
 VbQ5Ws/xZ54bD1PfyYb+Yx659lI8MSFOsDuMuLmDtfYnVicHwCA3H63StvQ3ihf/
 q0gu8Iex9YbNNjf7IfYGuWPmPn3gwPBoURPC0bcZvMPdY6DXodU6Oj4BRTQ5VCie
 9N0pt2wp2eRjaSzD7r5A
 =8YN6
 -----END PGP SIGNATURE-----

Merge tag 'nfs-for-3.18-3' of git://git.linux-nfs.org/projects/trondmy/linux-nfs

Pull NFS client bugfixes from Trond Myklebust:
 "Highlights include:

   - stable patches to fix NFSv4.x delegation reclaim error paths
   - fix a bug whereby we were advertising NFSv4.1 but using NFSv4.2
     features
   - fix a use-after-free problem with pNFS block layouts
   - fix a memory leak in the pNFS files O_DIRECT code
   - replace an intrusive and Oops-prone performance fix in the NFSv4
     atomic open code with a safer one-line version and revert the two
     original patches"

* tag 'nfs-for-3.18-3' of git://git.linux-nfs.org/projects/trondmy/linux-nfs:
  sunrpc: fix sleeping under rcu_read_lock in gss_stringify_acceptor
  NFS: Don't try to reclaim delegation open state if recovery failed
  NFSv4: Ensure that we call FREE_STATEID when NFSv4.x stateids are revoked
  NFSv4: Fix races between nfs_remove_bad_delegation() and delegation return
  NFSv4.1: nfs41_clear_delegation_stateid shouldn't trust NFS_DELEGATED_STATE
  NFSv4: Ensure that we remove NFSv4.0 delegations when state has expired
  NFS: SEEK is an NFS v4.2 feature
  nfs: Fix use of uninitialized variable in nfs_getattr()
  nfs: Remove bogus assignment
  nfs: remove spurious WARN_ON_ONCE in write path
  pnfs/blocklayout: serialize GETDEVICEINFO calls
  nfs: fix pnfs direct write memory leak
  Revert "NFS: nfs4_do_open should add negative results to the dcache."
  Revert "NFS: remove BUG possibility in nfs4_open_and_get_state"
  NFSv4: Ensure nfs_atomic_open set the dentry verifier on ENOENT
2014-11-15 14:15:16 -08:00
Johan Hedberg
eedbd5812c Bluetooth: Fix clearing remote OOB data through mgmt
When passed BDADDR_ANY the Remove Remote OOB Data comand is specified to
clear all entries. This patch adds the necessary check and calls
hci_remote_oob_data_clear() when necessary.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-15 09:00:29 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
49d1174130 Bluetooth: Add debug logs to help track locking issues
This patch adds some extra debug logs to L2CAP related code. These are
mainly to help track locking issues but will probably be useful for
debugging other types of issues as well.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-15 01:53:27 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
d88b5bbf1a Bluetooth: Remove unnecessary hdev locking in smp.c
Now that the SMP related key lists are converted to RCU there is nothing
in smp_cmd_sign_info() or smp_cmd_ident_addr_info() that would require
taking the hdev lock (including the smp_distribute_keys call). This
patch removes this unnecessary locking.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-15 01:53:27 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
adae20cb2d Bluetooth: Convert IRK list to RCU
This patch set converts the hdev->identity_resolving_keys list to use
RCU to eliminate the need to use hci_dev_lock/unlock.

An additional change that must be done is to remove use of
CRYPTO_ALG_ASYNC for the hdev-specific AES crypto context. The reason is
that this context is used for matching RPAs and the loop that does the
matching is under the RCU read lock, i.e. is an atomic section which
cannot sleep.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-15 01:53:27 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
970d0f1b28 Bluetooth: Convert LTK list to RCU
This patch set converts the hdev->long_term_keys list to use RCU to
eliminate the need to use hci_dev_lock/unlock.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-15 01:53:27 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
3e64b7bd82 Bluetooth: Trigger SMP for the appropriate LE CoC errors
The insufficient authentication/encryption errors indicate to the L2CAP
client that it should try to elevate the security level. Since there
really isn't any exception to this rule it makes sense to fully handle
it on the kernel side instead of pushing the responsibility to user
space.

This patch adds special handling of these two error codes and calls
smp_conn_security() with the elevated security level if necessary.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-15 01:46:50 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
35dc6f834c Bluetooth: Add key preference parameter to smp_sufficient_security
So far smp_sufficient_security() has returned false if we're encrypted
with an STK but do have an LTK available. However, for the sake of LE
CoC servers we do want to let the incoming connection through even
though we're only encrypted with the STK.

This patch adds a key preference parameter to smp_sufficient_security()
with two possible values (enum used instead of bool for readability).

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-15 01:46:49 +01:00
Johan Hedberg
fa37c1aa30 Bluetooth: Fix sending incorrect LE CoC PDU in BT_CONNECT2 state
For LE CoC L2CAP servers we don't do security level elevation during the
BT_CONNECT2 state (instead LE CoC simply sends an immediate error
response if the security level isn't high enough). Therefore if we get a
security level change while an LE CoC channel is in the BT_CONNECT2
state we should simply do nothing.

Signed-off-by: Johan Hedberg <johan.hedberg@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-15 01:46:49 +01:00
Fabian Frederick
a809eff11f Bluetooth: hidp: replace kzalloc/copy_from_user by memdup_user
use memdup_user for rd_data import.

Signed-off-by: Fabian Frederick <fabf@skynet.be>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Holtmann <marcel@holtmann.org>
2014-11-15 01:30:16 +01:00
Jarno Rajahalme
fecaef85f7 openvswitch: Validate IPv6 flow key and mask values.
Reject flow label key and mask values with invalid bits set.
Introduced by commit 3fdbd1ce11 ("openvswitch: add ipv6 'set'
action").

Signed-off-by: Jarno Rajahalme <jrajahalme@nicira.com>
Acked-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
2014-11-14 15:13:26 -08:00
Pravin B Shelar
8ec609d8b5 openvswitch: Convert dp rcu read operation to locked operations
dp read operations depends on ovs_dp_cmd_fill_info(). This API
needs to looup vport to find dp name, but vport lookup can
fail. Therefore to keep vport reference alive we need to
take ovs lock.

Introduced by commit 6093ae9aba ("openvswitch: Minimize
dp and vport critical sections").

Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Acked-by: Andy Zhou <azhou@nicira.com>
2014-11-14 15:13:26 -08:00
Daniele Di Proietto
19e7a3df72 openvswitch: Fix NDP flow mask validation
match_validate() enforce that a mask matching on NDP attributes has also an
exact match on ICMPv6 type.
The ICMPv6 type, which is 8-bit wide, is stored in the 'tp.src' field of
'struct sw_flow_key', which is 16-bit wide.
Therefore, an exact match on ICMPv6 type should only check the first 8 bits.

This commit fixes a bug that prevented flows with an exact match on NDP field
from being installed
Introduced by commit 03f0d916aa ("openvswitch: Mega flow implementation").

Signed-off-by: Daniele Di Proietto <ddiproietto@vmware.com>
Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
2014-11-14 15:13:26 -08:00
Jesse Gross
856447d020 openvswitch: Fix checksum calculation when modifying ICMPv6 packets.
The checksum of ICMPv6 packets uses the IP pseudoheader as part of
the calculation, unlike ICMP in IPv4. This was not implemented,
which means that modifying the IP addresses of an ICMPv6 packet
would cause the checksum to no longer be correct as the psuedoheader
did not match.
Introduced by commit 3fdbd1ce11 ("openvswitch: add ipv6 'set' action").

Reported-by: Neal Shrader <icosahedral@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jesse Gross <jesse@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
2014-11-14 15:13:26 -08:00
Pravin B Shelar
ab64f16ff2 openvswitch: Fix memory leak.
Need to free memory in case of sample action error.

Introduced by commit 651887b0c2 ("openvswitch: Sample
action without side effects").

Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
2014-11-14 15:13:26 -08:00
David S. Miller
8a5809e0dd Merge tag 'master-2014-11-11' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/linville/wireless
John W. Linville says:

====================
pull request: wireless 2014-11-13

Please pull this set of a few more wireless fixes intended for the
3.18 stream...

For the mac80211 bits, Johannes says:

"This has just one fix, for an issue with the CCMP decryption
that can cause a kernel crash. I'm not sure it's remotely
exploitable, but it's an important fix nonetheless."

For the iwlwifi bits, Emmanuel says:

"Two fixes here - we weren't updating mac80211 if a scan
was cut short by RFKILL which confused cfg80211. As a
result, the latter wouldn't allow to run another scan.
Liad fixes a small bug in the firmware dump."

On top of that...

Arend van Spriel corrects a channel width conversion that caused a
WARNING in brcmfmac.

Hauke Mehrtens avoids a NULL pointer dereference in b43.

Larry Finger hits a trio of rtlwifi bugs left over from recent
backporting from the Realtek vendor driver.

Miaoqing Pan fixes a clocking problem in ath9k that could affect
packet timestamps and such.

Stanislaw Gruszka addresses an payload alignment issue that has been
plaguing rt2x00.

Please let me know if there are problems!
====================

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-14 17:10:35 -05:00
bill bonaparte
5195c14c8b netfilter: conntrack: fix race in __nf_conntrack_confirm against get_next_corpse
After removal of the central spinlock nf_conntrack_lock, in
commit 93bb0ceb75 ("netfilter: conntrack: remove central
spinlock nf_conntrack_lock"), it is possible to race against
get_next_corpse().

The race is against the get_next_corpse() cleanup on
the "unconfirmed" list (a per-cpu list with seperate locking),
which set the DYING bit.

Fix this race, in __nf_conntrack_confirm(), by removing the CT
from unconfirmed list before checking the DYING bit.  In case
race occured, re-add the CT to the dying list.

While at this, fix coding style of the comment that has been
updated.

Fixes: 93bb0ceb75 ("netfilter: conntrack: remove central spinlock nf_conntrack_lock")
Reported-by: bill bonaparte <programme110@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: bill bonaparte <programme110@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jesper Dangaard Brouer <brouer@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: Pablo Neira Ayuso <pablo@netfilter.org>
2014-11-14 17:43:05 +01:00
Pravin B Shelar
8cd4313aa7 openvswitch: Fix build failure.
Add dependency on INET to fix following build error. I have also
fixed MPLS dependency.

ERROR: "ip_route_output_flow" [net/openvswitch/openvswitch.ko]
undefined!
make[1]: *** [__modpost] Error 1

Reported-by: Jim Davis <jim.epost@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Pravin B Shelar <pshelar@nicira.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-14 01:24:27 -05:00
David S. Miller
076ce44825 Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net
Conflicts:
	drivers/net/ethernet/chelsio/cxgb4vf/sge.c
	drivers/net/ethernet/intel/ixgbe/ixgbe_phy.c

sge.c was overlapping two changes, one to use the new
__dev_alloc_page() in net-next, and one to use s->fl_pg_order in net.

ixgbe_phy.c was a set of overlapping whitespace changes.

Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-14 01:01:12 -05:00
Linus Torvalds
5cf5203704 Merge git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net
Pull networking fixes from David Miller:

 1) sunhme driver lacks DMA mapping error checks, based upon a report by
    Meelis Roos.

 2) Fix memory leak in mvpp2 driver, from Sudip Mukherjee.

 3) DMA memory allocation sizes are wrong in systemport ethernet driver,
    fix from Florian Fainelli.

 4) Fix use after free in mac80211 defragmentation code, from Johannes
    Berg.

 5) Some networking uapi headers missing from Kbuild file, from Stephen
    Hemminger.

 6) TUN driver gets csum_start offset wrong when VLAN accel is enabled,
    and macvtap has a similar bug, from Herbert Xu.

 7) Adjust several tunneling drivers to set dev->iflink after registry,
    because registry sets that to -1 overwriting whatever we did.  From
    Steffen Klassert.

 8) Geneve forgets to set inner tunneling type, causing GSO segmentation
    to fail on some NICs.  From Jesse Gross.

 9) Fix several locking bugs in stmmac driver, from Fabrice Gasnier and
    Giuseppe CAVALLARO.

10) Fix spurious timeouts with NewReno on low traffic connections, from
    Marcelo Leitner.

11) Fix descriptor updates in enic driver, from Govindarajulu
    Varadarajan.

12) PPP calls bpf_prog_create() with locks held, which isn't kosher.
    Fix from Takashi Iwai.

13) Fix NULL deref in SCTP with malformed INIT packets, from Daniel
    Borkmann.

14) psock_fanout selftest accesses past the end of the mmap ring, fix
    from Shuah Khan.

15) Fix PTP timestamping for VLAN packets, from Richard Cochran.

16) netlink_unbind() calls in netlink pass wrong initial argument, from
    Hiroaki SHIMODA.

17) vxlan socket reuse accidently reuses a socket when the address
    family is different, so we have to explicitly check this, from
    Marcelo Lietner.

18) Fix missing include in nft_reject_bridge.c breaking the build on ppc
    and other architectures, from Guenter Roeck.

* git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/net: (75 commits)
  vxlan: Do not reuse sockets for a different address family
  smsc911x: power-up phydev before doing a software reset.
  lib: rhashtable - Remove weird non-ASCII characters from comments
  net/smsc911x: Fix delays in the PHY enable/disable routines
  net/smsc911x: Fix rare soft reset timeout issue due to PHY power-down mode
  netlink: Properly unbind in error conditions.
  net: ptp: fix time stamp matching logic for VLAN packets.
  cxgb4 : dcb open-lldp interop fixes
  selftests/net: psock_fanout seg faults in sock_fanout_read_ring()
  net: bcmgenet: apply MII configuration in bcmgenet_open()
  net: bcmgenet: connect and disconnect from the PHY state machine
  net: qualcomm: Fix dependency
  ixgbe: phy: fix uninitialized status in ixgbe_setup_phy_link_tnx
  net: phy: Correctly handle MII ioctl which changes autonegotiation.
  ipv6: fix IPV6_PKTINFO with v4 mapped
  net: sctp: fix memory leak in auth key management
  net: sctp: fix NULL pointer dereference in af->from_addr_param on malformed packet
  net: ppp: Don't call bpf_prog_create() in ppp_lock
  net/mlx4_en: Advertize encapsulation offloads features only when VXLAN tunnel is set
  cxgb4 : Fix bug in DCB app deletion
  ...
2014-11-13 17:54:08 -08:00
Eric Dumazet
d649a7a81f tcp: limit GSO packets to half cwnd
In DC world, GSO packets initially cooked by tcp_sendmsg() are usually
big, as sk_pacing_rate is high.

When network is congested, cwnd can be smaller than the GSO packets
found in socket write queue. tcp_write_xmit() splits GSO packets
using the available cwnd, and we end up sending a single GSO packet,
consuming all available cwnd.

With GRO aggregation on the receiver, we might handle a single GRO
packet, sending back a single ACK.

1) This single ACK might be lost
   TLP or RTO are forced to attempt a retransmit.
2) This ACK releases a full cwnd, sender sends another big GSO packet,
   in a ping pong mode.

This behavior does not fill the pipes in the best way, because of
scheduling artifacts.

Make sure we always have at least two GSO packets in flight.

This allows us to safely increase GRO efficiency without risking
spurious retransmits.

Signed-off-by: Eric Dumazet <edumazet@google.com>
Acked-by: Neal Cardwell <ncardwell@google.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-13 15:21:44 -05:00
Thomas Graf
6eba82248e rhashtable: Drop gfp_flags arg in insert/remove functions
Reallocation is only required for shrinking and expanding and both rely
on a mutex for synchronization and callers of rhashtable_init() are in
non atomic context. Therefore, no reason to continue passing allocation
hints through the API.

Instead, use GFP_KERNEL and add __GFP_NOWARN | __GFP_NORETRY to allow
for silent fall back to vzalloc() without the OOM killer jumping in as
pointed out by Eric Dumazet and Eric W. Biederman.

Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-13 15:18:40 -05:00
Herbert Xu
7b4ce23534 rhashtable: Add parent argument to mutex_is_held
Currently mutex_is_held can only test locks in the that are global
since it takes no arguments.  This prevents rhashtable from being
used in places where locks are lock, e.g., per-namespace locks.

This patch adds a parent field to mutex_is_held and rhashtable_params
so that local locks can be used (and tested).

Signed-off-by: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-13 15:13:05 -05:00
Herbert Xu
1f501d6252 netfilter: Move mutex_is_held under PROVE_LOCKING
The rhashtable function mutex_is_held is only used when PROVE_LOCKING
is enabled.  This patch modifies netfilter so that we can rhashtable.h
itself can later make mutex_is_held optional depending on PROVE_LOCKING.

Signed-off-by: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-13 15:13:05 -05:00
Herbert Xu
9712756620 netlink: Move mutex_is_held under PROVE_LOCKING
The rhashtable function mutex_is_held is only used when PROVE_LOCKING
is enabled.  This patch modifies netlink so that we can rhashtable.h
itself can later make mutex_is_held optional depending on PROVE_LOCKING.

Signed-off-by: Herbert Xu <herbert@gondor.apana.org.au>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-13 15:13:05 -05:00
Michal Kubeček
fbe168ba91 net: generic dev_disable_lro() stacked device handling
Large receive offloading is known to cause problems if received packets
are passed to other host. Therefore the kernel disables it by calling
dev_disable_lro() whenever a network device is enslaved in a bridge or
forwarding is enabled for it (or globally). For virtual devices we need
to disable LRO on the underlying physical device (which is actually
receiving the packets).

Current dev_disable_lro() code handles this  propagation for a vlan
(including 802.1ad nested vlan), macvlan or a vlan on top of a macvlan.
It doesn't handle other stacked devices and their combinations, in
particular propagation from a bond to its slaves which often causes
problems in virtualization setups.

As we now have generic data structures describing the upper-lower device
relationship, dev_disable_lro() can be generalized to disable LRO also
for all lower devices (if any) once it is disabled for the device
itself.

For bonding and teaming devices, it is necessary to disable LRO not only
on current slaves at the moment when dev_disable_lro() is called but
also on any slave (port) added later.

v2: use lower device links for all devices (including vlan and macvlan)

Signed-off-by: Michal Kubecek <mkubecek@suse.cz>
Acked-by: Veaceslav Falico <vfalico@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-13 14:48:56 -05:00
Thomas Graf
882288c05e FOU: Fix no return statement warning for !CONFIG_NET_FOU_IP_TUNNELS
net/ipv4/fou.c: In function ‘ip_tunnel_encap_del_fou_ops’:
net/ipv4/fou.c:861:1: warning: no return statement in function returning non-void [-Wreturn-type]

Fixes: a8c5f90fb5 ("ip_tunnel: Ops registration for secondary encap (fou, gue)")
Signed-off-by: Thomas Graf <tgraf@suug.ch>
Signed-off-by: David S. Miller <davem@davemloft.net>
2014-11-13 14:32:00 -05:00